-----BEGIN PRIVACY-ENHANCED MESSAGE-----
Proc-Type: 2001,MIC-CLEAR
Originator-Name: webmaster@www.sec.gov
Originator-Key-Asymmetric:
 MFgwCgYEVQgBAQICAf8DSgAwRwJAW2sNKK9AVtBzYZmr6aGjlWyK3XmZv3dTINen
 TWSM7vrzLADbmYQaionwg5sDW3P6oaM5D3tdezXMm7z1T+B+twIDAQAB
MIC-Info: RSA-MD5,RSA,
 SHxPL90tocANrCB9uigcV6xst5DVH4XnkPO2izS6e1Ngi0ahGlr0t7gGphpytsGs
 KKaRrIHvU5nOb8aFJR39WA==

<SEC-DOCUMENT>0000078890-03-000011.txt : 20030326
<SEC-HEADER>0000078890-03-000011.hdr.sgml : 20030325
<ACCEPTANCE-DATETIME>20030326172422
ACCESSION NUMBER:		0000078890-03-000011
CONFORMED SUBMISSION TYPE:	10-K
PUBLIC DOCUMENT COUNT:		12
CONFORMED PERIOD OF REPORT:	20021231
FILED AS OF DATE:		20030326

FILER:

	COMPANY DATA:	
		COMPANY CONFORMED NAME:			PITTSTON CO
		CENTRAL INDEX KEY:			0000078890
		STANDARD INDUSTRIAL CLASSIFICATION:	BITUMINOUS COAL & LIGNITE MINING [1220]
		IRS NUMBER:				541317776
		STATE OF INCORPORATION:			VA
		FISCAL YEAR END:			1231

	FILING VALUES:
		FORM TYPE:		10-K
		SEC ACT:		1934 Act
		SEC FILE NUMBER:	001-09148
		FILM NUMBER:		03619015

	BUSINESS ADDRESS:	
		STREET 1:		1801 BAYBERRY COURT
		STREET 2:		P O BOX 18100
		CITY:			RICHMOND
		STATE:			VA
		ZIP:			23058-4229
		BUSINESS PHONE:		8045533681

	MAIL ADDRESS:	
		STREET 1:		1801 BAYBERRY COURT
		STREET 2:		P O BOX 18100
		CITY:			RICHMOND
		STATE:			VA
		ZIP:			23226-8100
</SEC-HEADER>
<DOCUMENT>
<TYPE>10-K
<SEQUENCE>1
<FILENAME>form10k2002.txt
<DESCRIPTION>2002 FORM 10-K
<TEXT>
                                  UNITED STATES
                       SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
                              WASHINGTON, DC 20549

                                    FORM 10-K
   (MARK ONE)
      X      ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15 (d) OF THE
             SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934 FOR THE FISCAL YEAR ENDED
             DECEMBER 31, 2002

                                                    OR

             TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(D) OF THE SECURITIES
             EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
             FOR THE TRANSITION PERIOD FROM ____________ TO ____________

                        COMMISSION FILE NUMBER 1-9148

                            THE PITTSTON COMPANY
           (EXACT NAME OF REGISTRANT AS SPECIFIED IN ITS CHARTER)

          VIRGINIA                                     54-1317776
(STATE OR OTHER JURISDICTION OF                      (IRS EMPLOYER
INCORPORATION OR ORGANIZATION)                      IDENTIFICATION NO.)

   P.O. BOX 18100,
  1801 BAYBERRY COURT
  RICHMOND, VIRGINIA                                   23226-8100
(ADDRESS OF PRINCIPAL EXECUTIVE OFFICES)               (ZIP CODE)

REGISTRANT'S TELEPHONE NUMBER, INCLUDING AREA CODE    (804) 289-9600

SECURITIES REGISTERED PURSUANT TO SECTION 12(B) OF THE ACT:
                                                         NAME OF EXCHANGE ON
               TITLE OF EACH CLASS                         WHICH REGISTERED
PITTSTON BRINK'S GROUP COMMON STOCK, PAR VALUE $1       NEW YORK STOCK EXCHANGE
RIGHTS TO PURCHASE SERIES A PARTICIPATING               NEW YORK STOCK EXCHANGE
CUMULATIVE PREFERRED STOCK

   SECURITIES REGISTERED PURSUANT TO SECTION 12(G) OF THE ACT:  NONE

       Indicate by check mark whether the registrant: (1) has filed all
reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange
Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months and (2) has been subject to such
filing requirements for the past 90 days.
                                                       Yes  X       No
         Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to
Item 405 of Regulation S-K is not contained herein, and will not be contained,
to the best of registrant's knowledge, in definitive proxy or information
statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any
amendment to this Form 10-K. X
         Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is an accelerated filer
(as defined in Exchange Act Rule 12b-2).
                                                       Yes  X       No
         As of March 1, 2003, there were issued and outstanding 54,253,423
shares of common stock. The aggregate market value of shares of common stock
held by nonaffiliates, as of June 28, 2002, was $1,237,810,008.

         Documents incorporated by reference: Part I, Part II and Part IV
incorporate information by reference from the Annual Report of the Company for
the year ended December 31, 2002. Part III incorporates information by reference
from portions of the Registrant's definitive Proxy Statement to be filed
pursuant to Regulation 14A.


<PAGE>







PART I


ITEMS 1 AND 2. BUSINESS AND PROPERTIES
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

THE PITTSTON COMPANY

The Pittston Company, a Virginia corporation incorporated in 1930, has three
primary operating segments within its "Business and Security Services"
businesses: Brink's, Incorporated ("Brink's"); Brink's Home Security, Inc.
("BHS"); and BAX Global Inc. ("BAX Global").

The fourth operating segment is Other Operations, which consists of gold, timber
and natural gas operations. The Company also has significant assets and
liabilities associated with its former coal operations and expects to have
significant ongoing expenses and cash outflows related to former coal operations
in the future.

The Pittston Company and its subsidiaries are referred to herein as the
"Company". The Company's common stock trades on the New York Stock Exchange
under the symbol "PZB."

Financial information related to the Company's operating segments is included in
Note 2 to the Consolidated Financial Statements in the Company's 2002 Annual
Report, which Note is herein incorporated by reference.

The Company has approximately 50,000 employees in its Business and Security
Services operations, including approximately 37,500 at Brink's, 2,500 at BHS and
10,000 at BAX Global.

A significant portion of the Company's business is conducted outside the United
States. Because the financial results of the Company are reported in U.S.
dollars, they are affected by changes in the value of the various foreign
currencies in relation to the U.S. dollar. The Company, from time to time, uses
foreign currency forward contracts to hedge certain transactional risks
associated with foreign currencies. The Company is also subject to other risks
customarily associated with doing business in foreign countries, including labor
and economic conditions, political instability, controls on repatriation of
earnings and capital, nationalization, expropriation and other forms of
restrictive action by local governments. The future effects of such risks on the
Company cannot be predicted.

The Pittston Company's internet address is www.pittston.com. The Company makes
available, free of charge, through its website, its Annual Report on Form 10-K,
quarterly reports on Form 10-Q, current reports on Form 8-K and amendments to
those reports filed or furnished pursuant to Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the
Exchange Act as soon as reasonably practicable after the Company electronically
files such information with or furnishes it to the Securities and Exchange
Commission.


BUSINESS AND SECURITY SERVICES

BRINK'S, INCORPORATED ("BRINK'S")

GENERAL
The major services offered by Brink's include armored car transportation,
automated teller machine ("ATM") servicing, currency and deposit processing,
coin sorting and wrapping, arranging the secure air transportation of valuables
("Global Services") and the deploying and servicing of safes and safe control
devices, including its patented CompuSafe(R) service. Brink's serves customers
through 154 branches in the U.S. and 41 branches in Canada. Service is also
provided through subsidiaries, equity affiliates and associated companies in 48
countries outside the U.S. and Canada. Brink's ownership interest in
subsidiaries and affiliated companies ranges from 20% to 100%. In some instances
local laws limit the extent of Brink's ownership interest.

Brink's customers include banks; industrial, retail and other commercial
businesses; investment banking and brokerage firms; and government agencies,
such as a country's central bank. Brink's provides individualized services under
separate contracts designed to meet the distinct transportation, security and
logistics requirements of its customers. These contracts are usually for an
initial term of one year or less, but continue in effect thereafter until
canceled by either party.

Brink's armored car transportation services generally include secure
transportation of:

o Cash from businesses to banks for deposit.

o Cash, securities and other negotiable items and valuables between commercial
  banks, central banks (such as the U.S. Federal Reserve Banks and their
  branches and correspondents) and brokerage firms.

o New currency, coins and precious metals for a number of central banks
throughout the world.

o Canceled checks between banks or between a clearing house and its member banks
in certain geographic areas.

In late 2001 and early 2002, Brink's participated in the initial distribution of
the euro in Europe.

The trend by banks, retail businesses and others to outsource vaulting and cash
room operations continued in 2002. Brink's provides coin and currency processing
("cash logistics") services primarily to banks and retail customers. Retail
customers use Brink's cash logistics services to count and reconcile coins and
currency in Brink's secure environment, to prepare bank deposit information and
to replenish retail locations' coins and currency in proper denominations.


                                      -1-
<PAGE>

Through its proprietary cash processing and information systems, Brink's offers
customers the ability to integrate a full range of cash vault, ATM,
transportation, storage, processing, inventory management and reporting
services. Brink's believes that its cash processing and information systems
differentiate its cash logistics services from its competitors.

For transporting money and other valuables over long distances, Brink's Global
Services offers a combined armored car and secure air transportation service
between many cities around the world. Brink's uses regularly scheduled or
chartered aircraft in connection with its air courier services. Included in
Global Services is a worldwide specialized diamond and jewelry secure
transportation operation, with offices in the major diamond and jewelry centers
of the world.

Brink's CompuSafe(R) services provide retail customers with a proprietary
integrated system of safeguarding and managing cash. Brink's markets its
CompuSafe(R) services to a variety of cash-intensive retail customers, such as
convenience stores, gas stations and restaurants. The service includes
installing a specialized safe in the retail establishment that holds safeguarded
canisters. The customer's employees deposit currency into the canister. The
canister can only be removed by Brink's armored car personnel.

Brink's International operations accounted for approximately 56% of its revenues
and 46% of its operating profits in 2002. Brink's has International operations
in three regions: Europe, South America and Asia/Pacific.

COMPETITION
Brink's is the oldest and largest armored car service company in the U.S. as
well as a market leader in many of the countries in which it operates.
Worldwide, Brink's competes with a number of large multinational companies and
with many smaller companies.

Primary factors in attracting and retaining customers are security, the quality
of services provided and the price charged for services rendered. Brink's
believes its competitive advantages include:

o  Recognizable name

o  Reputation for a high level of service and security

o  Proprietary cash processing and information systems

o  High-quality insurance coverage

o  Ability to serve multiple markets for the same customer in many of the
   countries in which Brink's has operations

Brink's believes its cost structure is generally competitive, although Brink's
believes certain competitors may have lower costs as a result of lower wage and
benefit levels for employees or as a result of different security standards.

To reduce costs, financial institutions frequently use consultants and
purchasing and procurement professionals to negotiate price and frequency of
services with armored car companies. Brink's growth in sales to retail
businesses is partially dependent on the growth in the economy. Recent slow
economic growth has resulted in an increasing focus on the cost of armored car
services by retail customers. Because of Brink's high level of service and
security, and quality insurance coverage, Brink's resists competing on price
alone.

The availability of quality and reliable insurance coverage is an important
factor in the ability of Brink's to obtain and retain customers and to manage
the risks of its business. Brink's purchases "all risk" insurance coverage for
losses in excess of what it considers prudent deductibles and/or retentions. For
losses below deductible or retention levels, Brink's is self-insured. Brink's
insurance policies cover losses from most causes, with the exception of war,
nuclear risk and certain other exclusions typical for such policies. Brink's
generally does not offer its customers protection from losses arising from such
excluded causes.

Insurance is provided by different groups of underwriters at negotiated rates
and terms. Insurance is available to Brink's in major markets although the
premiums charged are subject to fluctuations depending on market conditions. The
loss experience of Brink's and, to a limited extent, other armored carriers
affects premium rates charged to Brink's.

SERVICE MARK, PATENTS AND COPYRIGHTS
BRINKS is a registered service mark in the U.S. and certain foreign countries.
The BRINKS mark, name and related marks are of material significance to Brink's
business. Brink's owns patents with respect to certain coin sorting and counting
machines, which expire in 2007 and 2008, respectively. Brink's has patents
associated with its integrated service, CompuSafe(R), that expire in 2015
through 2018. The patents for CompuSafe(R) and sorting and counting machines
provide important advantages to Brink's in their respective areas of business.
However, Brink's operations are not dependent on the existence of the
aforementioned patents.

The Company has entered into certain agreements to license the Brink's or the
Brink's Home Security name. Examples include licenses to distributors of
security products (padlocks, home safes, door and window hardware, etc.) offered
for sale to consumers through major retail chains.

GOVERNMENT REGULATION
The operations of Brink's are subject to regulation by the U.S. Department of
Transportation with respect to safety of operations and equipment and financial
responsibility. Intrastate operations in the U.S. and intraprovince operations
in Canada are subject to regulation by state and by Canadian and provincial
regulatory authorities, respectively. Brink's International operations are
regulated to varying degrees by the countries in which they operate.

EMPLOYEE RELATIONS
At December 31, 2002, Brink's and its subsidiaries had approximately 37,500
employees, including11,400 employees in North America, (of whom 2,000 were
classified as part-time employees) and 26,100 employees outside North America.
At

                                      -2-
<PAGE>

December 31, 2002, Brink's was a party to 14 collective bargaining agreements
in North America with various local unions covering approximately 1,500
employees, almost all of whom are employees in Canada and members of unions
affiliated with the International Brotherhood of Teamsters. Negotiations are
continuing on one agreement that has expired and three agreements expiring in
2003. The remaining agreements will expire after 2003. Outside of North America,
the branch workforce are members of labor or employee organizations in the
majority of the countries of operation. Brink's believes that its employee
relations are satisfactory.

PROPERTIES
In North America, Brink's owns 29 branch offices and leases an additional 166
branch offices, located in 39 states, the District of Columbia and nine Canadian
provinces. Such branches generally include office space and garage or vehicle
terminals. Of the leased branches, 121 facilities are held under long-term
leases. The remaining 45 branches are held under short-term leases or
month-to-month tenancies. Brink's corporate headquarters facility in Darien,
Connecticut, is held under a lease expiring in 2005.

In North America, Brink's owns or leases approximately 2,400 armored vehicles,
300 panel trucks and 200 other vehicles that are primarily service vehicles.
Brink's armored vehicles are of bullet-resistant construction and are specially
designed and equipped to afford security for crew and cargo.

Brink's subsidiaries and affiliated and associated companies located outside
North America operate from approximately 500 branches, the majority of which are
leased, with approximately 4,600 owned or leased armored vehicles.

Approximately 4,000 Brink's-owned CompuSafe(R) devices are located on customers'
premises in North America.



BRINK'S HOME SECURITY ("BHS")

GENERAL
BHS believes that it is the second largest provider of monitored security
services to single family residences in North America. BHS is primarily engaged
in the business of marketing, selling, installing, monitoring and servicing
electronic security systems in owner-occupied, single-family residences. At
December 31, 2002, BHS had approximately 767,000 systems under monitoring
contracts, including approximately 106,000 new subscribers added during the
year. BHS provides services to subscribers located in more than 250 metropolitan
areas in 43 states, the District of Columbia and two western provinces in
Canada.

BHS' typical security system installation consists of sensors and other devices
which are installed at a customer's home. The equipment can be configured to
signal intrusion, fire, medical and other alerts. When an alarm is triggered, a
signal is sent by telephone line to BHS' central monitoring station in Irving,
Texas. The monitoring station holds an Underwriters' Laboratories, Inc. ("UL")
listing. UL specifications for service centers include building integrity,
back-up computer and power systems, staffing and standard operating procedures.
In the event of an emergency, such as fire, tornado, major interruption in
telephone or computer service, or any other event affecting the Irving facility,
monitoring operations can be transferred to a backup facility located in
Carrollton, Texas.

BHS markets its alarm systems primarily through TV and direct mail advertising,
yellow page advertising, alliances with other service companies, inbound
telemarketing and field sales employees. BHS employees install and service most
of the systems; however, subcontractors are utilized on occasion in some service
areas. BHS does not manufacture the equipment used in its security systems.
Equipment is purchased from a limited number of suppliers and no interruptions
in supply are expected. Equipment inventories are maintained at each branch
office.

BHS has an authorized dealer program to expand its geographic coverage and
leverage its national advertising. The dealer program accounted for less than 9%
of new installations during 2002 and, as of December 31, 2002, less than 3% of
BHS' total subscriber base. Approximately 67 dealers were authorized to
participate in the program as of December 31, 2002. BHS requires that its
dealers install the same type of equipment as is installed by its own branches,
and adhere to the same installation quality standards.

In addition to initiating subscriber relationships through its branch and dealer
networks, BHS obtains new residential subscribers through its Brink's Home
Technologies division. Brink's Home Technologies markets residential security
systems, as well as a variety of low-voltage security, home networking,
communications and entertainment options, directly to major home builders.

BHS also provides monitored security to residents of apartment and condominium
complexes; however, such customers currently represent less than 2% of
subscribers.

Although its core business is focused on the monitoring of residential security
systems, BHS installs and monitors commercial security systems on a limited
basis. Such customers represent approximately 4% of subscribers.

GOVERNMENT REGULATION
BHS and its employees are subject to various federal, state and local consumer
protection, licensing and other laws and regulations. BHS' business relies upon
the use of telephone lines to communicate signals, and telephone companies are
currently regulated by both the Federal and state governments. Regulation of the
installation and monitoring of fire detection devices has also increased in
several local markets. BHS' wholly owned Canadian subsidiary, Brink's Home
Security Canada Limited, is subject to the laws of Canada, British Columbia and
Alberta.

The alarm service industry experiences a high incidence of false alarms. BHS
believes its false alarm rate compares favorably to other companies' rates. The
high incidence of false alarms in the industry has caused some local governments
to impose

                                      -3-
<PAGE>

assessments, fines and penalties on either subscribers or the alarm
companies. A few municipalities are considering ordinances under which both
permit and alarm dispatch fees would be charged directly to the alarm companies.
BHS alarm service contracts allow BHS to pass these charges on to customers.

Police departments in two major western U.S. cities do not respond to calls from
alarm companies unless an emergency has been visually verified. If more police
departments in the future refuse to respond to calls from alarm companies
without visual verification, this could have an adverse effect on future results
of operations for BHS.

COMPETITION
BHS competes in most major metropolitan markets in the U.S. and several markets
in western Canada through branch operations or its authorized dealer program.
The home security market has a large number of competitors, including many local
and regional companies. Several of BHS' large competitors have placed a heavy
reliance on dealers and acquisitions to increase their subscriber bases, whereas
BHS has gained almost all of its subscribers through internal sales efforts. BHS
believes that it is now the second largest provider of monitored security
services to single-family residences in North America.

Competition is based on a variety of factors including, but not limited to,
price, product quality, company reputation and service quality. There has been
substantial competitive pressure on installation fees in recent years. Several
significant competitors offer installation prices which match or are less than
BHS' prices; however, many of the small local competitors in BHS' markets
continue to charge significantly more for installation. Competitive pressure on
monitoring rates, while less intense than on installation fees, is still
substantial. BHS believes that the monitoring rates it offers are generally
comparable to the rates offered by other major security companies.

BHS believes its customer retention rate is the highest among the major home
security service companies. BHS attributes its relatively high customer
retention rate to the high credit standards for new customers which reduces the
number of subsequent cancellations of service related to nonpayment. BHS also
believes it is more effective than the other major home security services
companies in the area of customer service, which tends to reduce customer
disconnects over time.

EMPLOYEES
BHS has approximately 2,500 employees, none of whom is covered by a collective
bargaining agreement. BHS believes that its employee relations are satisfactory.

PROPERTIES
BHS has approximately 55 leased offices and warehouse facilities located
throughout the U.S. and one leased office in Canada. The central monitoring
station in Irving, Texas is leased for a seven-year term ending in 2005,
including renewal options. This facility also serves as BHS' headquarters and
houses most administrative, technical and marketing services personnel. The
lease for the backup monitoring center in Carrollton, Texas, expires in 2005.
BHS leases approximately 1,300 vehicles which are used in the process of
installing and servicing its security systems.

BHS retains ownership of most of the approximately 767,000 systems currently
under contract. When a customer cancels monitoring services, BHS typically
disables the system. In a limited number of cases, BHS removes the equipment.
When a customer cancels monitoring services because of a move, the retention of
the BHS system in the residence facilitates the marketing of monitoring services
to the new homeowner.



BAX GLOBAL

GENERAL
BAX Global provides transportation and supply chain management services on a
global basis. BAX Global specializes in the heavy freight market for business to
business shipping.

BAX Global's transportation services are provided within North America using a
dedicated fleet of 20 planes with a national sorting hub in Toledo, Ohio. BAX
Global's North American operation also has a ground network that provides
transportation on a regional basis.

Outside North America, BAX Global provides transportation services using
available space on commercial carriers, and on occasion using chartered
aircraft. BAX Global's primary markets outside North America are shipping from
Asia to North America and Europe, and between North America and Europe.

BAX Global continues to expand its ocean shipping business primarily by
marketing its ocean products to its current air freight and supply chain
management customer base.

Air Transport International, LLC ("ATI"), a wholly owned subsidiary of BAX
Global, provides transportation services in North America to BAX Global and also
provides charter transportation services to other customers.

BAX Global provides certain transportation customers with supply chain
management services and operates more than 40 logistics warehouse and
distribution facilities in key world markets. BAX Global specializes in
developing supply chain management programs for companies entering new global
markets or consolidating regional activity.

TRANSPORTATION
BAX Global offers its North American (U.S., Canada and Mexico) transportation
customers a variety of products and pricing options, such as guaranteed and
standard overnight and second-day delivery as well as deferred delivery
(delivery generally within one to three business days). A variety of value-added
ancillary services, such as shipment tracking, inventory control and management
reports are also offered.

Outside North America, BAX Global offers a variety of services including
standard and expedited freight services, ocean forwarding, and door-to-door
delivery.

                                      -4-
<PAGE>

BAX Global also frequently acts as customs broker, facilitating the clearance of
goods through customs at international points of entry. BAX Global has the
ability to link its international network with the North American transportation
infrastructure and customs brokerage capabilities to provide seamless
door-to-door delivery and distribution from global markets to virtually any city
in North America.

BAX Global sells its services primarily through its direct sales force. BAX
Global uses various marketing methods, including print media advertising and
direct marketing campaigns.

BAX Global generally picks up or receives freight shipments from its customers,
consolidates the freight of various customers into shipments for common
destinations and arranges for the transportation of the consolidated freight.
BAX Global uses either commercial carriers or, in the case of most of its North
American shipments, its own transportation fleet and regional and national hub
sorting facilities. BAX Global distributes the shipments at the package's
destination. While shipments move long distances on either common carrier or BAX
Global's fleet, the local pickup and delivery of freight are accomplished
principally by independent contractors using trucks dedicated to the BAX Global
network. BAX Global's independent contractors are required to display BAX
Global's logo and colors.

BAX Global has the ability to provide freight service to all North American
business communities as well as to virtually all countries through its network
of 500 company-operated stations and agent locations in 123 countries. BAX
Global's network is composed primarily of controlled subsidiaries and, to a
lesser extent, agents and sales representatives in many non-U.S. locations
typically under short-term contracts.

BAX Global's freight business is tied to the cycles of international trade, with
higher volumes of shipments from August through December than during the other
months of the year. The lowest volume of shipments generally occurs in January
and February.

Including U.S. export and import revenue, BAX Global's international shipments
and logistics services accounted for approximately 76% of its revenues in 2002.
Intra-U.S. shipments accounted for approximately 24% of total revenues in 2002.

BAX Global's network has a worldwide communications and information system which
provides global tracking and tracing of shipments and logistics data for
management information reports, enabling customers to improve efficiency and
control costs. BAX Global's customers are increasingly turning to its online
services offering information management available via its web site,
www.baxglobal.com.

SUPPLY CHAIN MANAGEMENT
BAX Global provides supply chain management services to a growing list of
customers. BAX Global's supply chain management business specializes in
developing solutions that include the design, implementation and management of
inventory, distribution and information processes to improve a customer's
efficiency and productivity.

BAX Global operates value-added logistics warehouse and distribution facilities
in key world markets. Companies in the healthcare, retail, automotive, aerospace
and high technology industries have been targeted as businesses with significant
supply chain management needs.

AIRCRAFT OPERATIONS
BAX Global has a fleet of leased and contracted aircraft providing regularly
scheduled next-day service throughout North America. BAX Global's wholly owned
subsidiary, ATI, is a U.S.-based freight and passenger airline that operates a
certificated fleet of DC-8 aircraft. BAX Global operates Boeing 727s under
contracts that provide the aircraft, crew, maintenance and insurance ("ACMI").
ATI also provides domestic and international service for the U.S. Government Air
Mobility Command and other charter customers.

The following is a summary of BAX Global's fleet as of December 31, 2002.

                        BAX Global's
                       Transportation Charter
                         Network     Customers Grounded  Total
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------
   DC-8:
     Cargo:
       Leased               10          3          -        13
       Owned                 -          -          4         4
     Combi-Configured (a):
       Leased                -          3          -         3
       Owned                 -          2          -         2
   727-CARGO-ACMI           10          -          -        10
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------
   Total Planes             20          8          4        32
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------
(a) Aircraft configured to accommodate both passengers and cargo.

Of the 20 planes in BAX Global's transportation network, 17 are assigned to
regularly scheduled routes. Generally, three planes are held for use as backups
or are in maintenance.

BAX Global's nightly scheduled lift capacity for planes in operation at December
31, 2002 was approximately 1.0 million pounds, based on an average freight
density of 7.5 pounds per cubic foot. BAX Global's nightly lift capacity varies
depending upon the number and type of planes operated by BAX Global at any
particular time. Including trucking capacity available to BAX Global, the
aggregate daily cargo capacity at December 31, 2002, was approximately 1.9
million pounds.

For aircraft held under long-term lease, BAX Global is generally responsible for
all the normal costs of operating and maintaining the aircraft. In addition, BAX
Global is generally responsible for all or a portion of any special maintenance
or modifications which may be required by Federal Aviation Administration
("FAA") regulations or orders (see "Government Regulation" below). BAX Global's
ultimate liability for FAA matters is generally subject to dollar limits,
specific exclusions and sharing arrangements with

                                      -5-
<PAGE>

the lessors. Over the last three years, BAX Global spent approximately $97
million on routine heavy maintenance of its aircraft fleet. BAX Global is
generally responsible for fuel costs and other incidental costs such as landing
fees for aircraft operated under ACMI contracts.

See Notes 14 and 21 to the Consolidated Financial Statements in the Company's
2002 Annual Report for information regarding future minimum lease payments and
other purchase commitments related to the Company's aircraft. BAX Global's 16
leased aircraft have various expiration dates extending through 2005, and its 10
planes under ACMI contracts have various expiration dates through 2004. Based on
the current state of the aircraft leasing market, BAX Global believes that it
should be able to renew these leases or enter into new leases on terms
reasonably comparable to those currently in effect.

The average airframe age of the fleet operated by ATI is in excess of 30 years;
however, the condition of a particular aircraft and its fair market value is
dependent on its maintenance history. Factors other than age, such as cycles
(essentially the number of flights) can have a significant impact on an
aircraft's serviceability. Generally, cargo aircraft tend to have fewer cycles
than passenger aircraft over comparable time periods because they are used for
fewer flights per day and longer flight segments.

Fuel costs are a significant element of the total costs of operating BAX
Global's aircraft fleet. Fuel prices are subject to worldwide and local market
conditions. In order to protect against price increases in jet fuel, from time
to time BAX Global enters into hedging agreements, including swap contracts,
options and collars. BAX Global charges a fuel surcharge in the U.S. to its
customers when fuel costs are higher.

CUSTOMERS
BAX Global's customers include thousands of large and small industrial and
commercial businesses. Worldwide, BAX Global's top 10 customers accounted for
less than 16% of total BAX Global revenue in 2002. The Company targets customers
in the automotive, aerospace, healthcare, high technology, retail and other
industries where rapid delivery of high-value products is required.

COMPETITION
The transportation and supply chain management industries have been and are
expected to remain highly competitive. The principal competitive factors in the
transportation industry are price, the ability to provide consistently fast and
reliable delivery of shipments and the ability to provide premium services such
as shipment tracking. The principal competitive factors in the supply chain
industry are price, access to a reliable transportation network, warehousing and
distribution capabilities, and sophisticated information systems.

There is aggressive price competition in the heavy-freight market, particularly
for the business of high volume shippers. BAX Global competes with various types
of transportation companies, including other integrated transportation companies
that operate their own fleets, as well as with freight forwarders, premium
less-than-truckload (or "LTL") carriers, express delivery services, and
passenger airlines.

Domestically, BAX Global also competes with package delivery services provided
by ground transportation companies, including trucking firms and surface freight
forwarders that offer specialized time-specific services within limited
geographical areas. As an international freight forwarder, BAX Global competes
with government-owned or subsidized passenger airlines, postal services and
ocean shipping companies.

BAX Global believes its hub-and-spoke network of aircraft and trucks that serves
the North American market allows it to move freight more reliably than if it
solely used third-party services. The hub, which is located in Toledo, Ohio,
consists of various facilities, including a technologically advanced material
handling system, which is capable of sorting approximately one million pounds of
freight per hour. BAX Global believes its hub-and-spoke system feeds much of its
North American import and export business and believes it provides a competitive
advantage by offering superior, reliable service to its customers, shipping to,
from or within North America.

In supply chain management services, BAX Global competes with many third-party
logistics providers.

EMPLOYEE RELATIONS
BAX Global and its subsidiaries have approximately 10,000 employees worldwide,
of whom about 1,200 are classified as part-time.

As of December 31, 2002, approximately 200 flight crewmembers (captains, first
officers and flight engineers), were represented for purposes of collective
bargaining by the International Brotherhood of Teamsters. Another 100 employees
in the U.S. (principally customer service, clerical and/or dock workers) were
represented by labor unions that in most cases are also affiliated with the
International Brotherhood of Teamsters. BAX Global did not experience any
significant strike or work stoppage in 2002 and believes that its employee
relations are satisfactory.

GOVERNMENT REGULATION
The air transportation industry, including BAX Global, is subject to regulation
by the FAA under the Federal Aviation Act of 1958, as amended, and the
Transportation Security Administration ("TSA") under the Aviation and
Transportation Security Act of 2001. The FAA and TSA are agencies of the
Department of Transportation ("DOT").

BAX Global is subject to various other requirements and regulations in
connection with its operations, including certain safety and security
regulations of the DOT and other federal and state agencies. BAX Global's
international operations are regulated by varying degrees by the countries in
which they operate.

                                      -6-
<PAGE>


PROPERTIES
BAX Global has approximately 260 company-operated stations (100 domestic and 160
international) and has agency agreements with approximately 240 stations (50
domestic and 190 international). BAX Global's stations are usually located at or
near airports or other transportation corridors. BAX Global operates domestic
stations, which generally include office space and warehousing facilities
located in 39 states, the District of Columbia and Puerto Rico. BAX Global
operates international facilities in 30 countries. Nearly all company-operated
stations are leased.

BAX Global operates its main distribution facility at Toledo Express Airport in
Ohio, which facilitates a fleet of aircraft and a freight-sorting operation and
related facilities (the "Hub"). The BAX Global Hub has a lease expiring in 2013
with the Toledo-Lucas County Port Authority. The lease provides BAX Global with
rights of renewal for three five-year periods. Other facilities in the U.S. are
held under leases having terms of one to ten years.

BAX Global provides certain transportation customers with supply chain
management services and operates more than 40 leased logistics warehouse and
distribution facilities in key world markets.

During 2002, BAX Global leased a new 116,000 square foot corporate office
facility through 2012 located in Irvine, California.

See "Aircraft Operations" above for information about contracted, leased and
owned aircraft.



OTHER OPERATIONS

The Company's Other Operations include its gold, timber and natural gas
businesses. At the end of 2002, the Company's Other Operations had approximately
60 employees. The Company does not consider its businesses within its Other
Operations to be core businesses. The Company expects to exit these activities
to focus resources on its core Business and Security Services segments.

Each of the gold, timber and natural gas businesses operate in cyclical
commodity business environments where prices are determined based partly on the
local and worldwide economy. The results of operations of each of these
businesses are highly dependent on the price of their respective products.

The Company's Other Operations own properties and interests including land,
hardwood forests, natural gas reserves and a gold mine and reserves.

GOLD
The Company's gold business is directed at locating and acquiring mineral
assets, developing advanced stage projects and operating mines.

At December 31, 2002, the Company had a 45.1% interest in MPI Mines Ltd. ("MPI")
and through its ownership of MPI and a 50% direct interest, the Company had a
72.5% interest in a gold mine in Stawell, Victoria, Australia ("Stawell"). At
December 31, 2002, through its ownership of MPI and a 25% direct interest, the
Company had a 36.3% interest in a gold mine and gold mill tolling operation in
Coolgardie, Western Australia.

In the fourth quarter 2002, the Company entered into an agreement to negotiate
the transfer of its direct interests in its Stawell and Coolgardie gold mining
joint ventures to MPI in exchange for additional shares of MPI and royalties on
future production. The transfer is contingent upon various factors.

In January 2003, MPI registered its shares on the Australian Stock Exchange and
issued additional shares of stock. After the new shares were issued, the Company
owns 30.4% of MPI.

Stawell's and Coolgardie's 2002 production and estimates of proved and probable
gold reserves as of December 31, 2002 were as follows:

                              2002
(Ounces of gold)           Production        Reserves
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Stawell                      101,000          222,000
Coolgardie                     3,000          181,000


TIMBER
The Company's timber business has a sawmill facility that produces products
primarily for the hardwood flooring industry. The timber business also sells
hardwood chips to the paper industry and logs to other sawmill customers that
are used in the high-grade furniture and veneer markets. The Company owns
approximately 140 thousand acres of surface and timberlands in southwest
Virginia.

NATURAL GAS
The Company invests in and receives royalty income from gas development and
operations. Net proved developed natural gas reserves located in Virginia and
West Virginia approximated 57 billion cubic feet including royalty interests and
a small interest purchased in the first quarter of 2003.



FORMER OPERATIONS

During December 2002, the Company concluded its plan to sell or shut down its
remaining coal mining operations and is no longer operating as an active coal
producer.

The Company intends to continue to market its residual coal assets to interested
parties. The Company has retained certain coal-related liabilities and related
expenses. Retained liabilities include obligations related to postretirement
benefits for Company-sponsored plans, black lung benefits, reclamation and other
costs related to idle (shut-down) mines which have been retained, Health Benefit
Act, workers' compensation claims and costs of withdrawal from multi-employer
pension plans. Expenses related to these liabilities have been reflected in the
loss from discontinued operations through the disposal date.  Subsequent to

                                      -7-
<PAGE>

the completion of the disposal process (for the period beginning
January 1, 2003), adjustments to coal-related contingent liabilities will be
reflected in discontinued operations, and expenses related to Company-sponsored
pension and postretirement benefit obligations and black lung obligations will
be reflected in continuing operations. In addition, subsequent to the disposal
date, the Company expects to have certain ongoing costs related to the
administration of the retained liabilities and will report those costs in
continuing operations. A portion of the obligations are expected to be assumed
by parties that purchase the Company's residual coal assets. The Company has not
recorded these obligations as liabilities on the balance sheet. The obligations
could be recorded as liabilities on the balance sheet in the future (with an
additional charge to earnings) if the Company no longer believes these
obligations will be assumed by other parties. See Notes 5 and 21 to the
Consolidated Financial Statements, which Notes are herein incorporated by
reference.

At December 31, 2002, the Company had approximately 110 employees related to its
former coal operations. These employees perform various duties including
reclaiming and maintaining residual assets and managing other retained
liabilities related to the former coal operations.

ENVIRONMENTAL MATTERS
The Surface Mining Control and Reclamation Act of 1977 and the regulations
promulgated thereunder ("SMCRA") by the Federal Office of Surface Mining
Reclamation and Enforcement ("OSM") establish mining and reclamation standards
for all aspects of surface mining as well as many aspects of deep mining. OSM
and its state counterparts monitor compliance with SMCRA. The Company's policy
is to correct violations that are the subject of OSM notices or to contest those
believed to be without merit.

The Company is also subject to other federal environmental laws, including the
Resource Conservation and Recovery Act; the Occupational Safety and Health Act;
the Toxic Substances Control Act; the Comprehensive Environmental Resource,
Compensation and Liability Act; the Clean Water Act; the Clean Air Act and the
Safe Drinking Water Act, as well as state laws of similar scope. The Company
believes it is in compliance with all applicable environmental laws.

The Company has agreed to pay 80% of the remediation costs arising from
hydrocarbon contamination at a formerly owned petroleum terminal facility
("Tankport") in Jersey City, New Jersey, which was sold in 1983. The Company is
in the process of remediating the site under an approved plan. The Company
estimates its portion of the actual remaining clean-up and operational and
maintenance costs, on an undiscounted basis, to be between $2.2 million and $4.3
million. The Company is in discussions with another potentially responsible
party to recover a portion of the amount paid and to be paid by the Company
related to this matter.


HEALTH AND SAFETY LAWS
Health and safety standards in the U.S. coal industry, including reclamation and
maintenance activities on the Company's residual coal assets, are legislated by
the Federal Coal Mine Health and Safety Act of 1969 and the Federal Mine Safety
and Health Act of 1977. The Company believes it is in compliance with all
applicable health and safety laws.

PROPERTIES
The residual properties of the Company's former coal operations are (i) unmined
or partially mined coal reserves, (ii) closed or idled coal mines, (iii) an
idled coal preparation plant, (iv) a corporate office in Lebanon, VA, and (v)
various other properties. The Company is attempting to sell coal reserves it
owns or leases primarily in West Virginia. Leases of land or coal mining rights
generally are either for a long-term period or until exhaustion of the reserves.

FORWARD-LOOKING INFORMATION
Certain of the matters discussed herein, including statements regarding
significant ongoing expenses and cash outflows related to former coal operations
in the future (including costs related to the administration of retained
liabilities), the uninterrupted supply of equipment to BHS, the impact that the
refusal of police departments to respond to calls from alarm companies without
visual verification would have on BHS' results of operations, the expected
seasonal impact on the volumes shipped by BAX Global, the ability of BAX Global
to renew certain aircraft leases or enter into new leases on reasonably
comparable terms, the highly competitive nature of the transportation and supply
chain management industries, the Company's plan to exit its gold, timber and
natural gas businesses, the consummation of the transfer of the Company's direct
interests in the Stawell and Coolgardie joint ventures to MPI, the amount of
proved and probable gold reserves, the amount of proved developed atural gas
reserves, the ability to sell residual coal assets and transfer various related
obligations, the possibility that various obligations associated with the
Company's former coal business may be recorded as liabilities on the balance
sheet in the future (with an additional charge to earnings), estimates of
clean-up, operational and maintenance costs relating to the Tankport matter and
possibility that the Company will be able to recover a portion of amounts paid
or to be paid from another potentially responsible party, involve
forward-looking information which is subject to known and unknown risks,
uncertainties, and contingencies which could cause actual results, performance
or achievements, to differ materially from those which are
anticipated.

Such risks, uncertainties and contingencies, many of which are beyond the
control of the Company, include, but are not limited to, actual retirement
experience of the former coal operation's employees, black lung claims
incidence, the number of dependents covered under benefit obligations, coal
industry turnover rates, actual medical and legal costs relating to the
benefits, changes in inflation rates (including the continued volatility of
medical

                                      -8-
<PAGE>

inflation), the performance of BHS' equipment suppliers, the incidence
of false alarms, the willingness of BHS' customers to pay for private response
personnel or other alternatives to police responses to alarms, the market for
airplanes, the ability to obtain appropriate value for the gold, timber, and
natural gas businesses and the remaining coal assets. The negotiation of
definitive agreements for such businesses and assets, as well as for the Stawell
and Coolgardie joint ventures, and the satisfaction of any conditions to closing
contained therein, including the receipt of various consents and other
approvals, changes in the Company's strategies regarding the sale of gold,
timber and natural gas businesses, the actual amount of gold reserves and
natural gas reserves held by the Company's Other Operations, the accuracy of the
testing done and the validity of the assumptions used in estimating gold and
natural gas reserves,the completion and processing of permit replacement
documentation and the ability of purchasers of coal assets to post the required
bonds, changes in the Company's belief that various obligations associated with
the former coal business will be assumed by other parties, changes in the scope
or method of remediation or monitoring of the Tankport property, the negotiation
of a mutually acceptable agreement with the potentially responsible party in the
Tankport matter, overall economic and business conditions, foreign currency
exchange rates, the demand for the Company's products and services, the ability
of the Company and its operations to obtain appropriate insurance coverage at
reasonable prices, pricing and other competitive industry factors, fuel prices,
new government regulations and legislative initiatives, issuance of permits,
judicial decisions, variations in costs or expenses including interest rates,
and the ability of counterparties to perform.






                                      -9-
<PAGE>





ITEM 3. LEGAL PROCEEDINGS
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

Not applicable.

ITEM 4. SUBMISSION OF MATTER TO A VOTE OF SECURITY HOLDERS
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------

Not applicable.




                                      -10-
<PAGE>



EXECUTIVE OFFICERS OF THE REGISTRANT

The following is a list as of March 15, 2003, of the names and ages of the
executive and other officers of Pittston and the names and ages of certain
officers of its subsidiaries, indicating the principal positions and offices
held by each. There is no family relationship between any of the officers named.
<TABLE>

<CAPTION>
Name                              Age      Positions and Offices Held                                           Held Since
- ----------------------------- -------- --- ---------------------------------------------------------------- --------------------
EXECUTIVE OFFICERS:
<S>                               <C>      <C>                                                                      <C>
Michael T. Dan                    52       President, Chief Executive Officer and Chairman of the Board            1998
James B. Hartough                 55       Vice President-Corporate Finance and Treasurer                          1988
Frank T. Lennon                   61       Vice President-Human Resources and Administration                       1985
Austin F. Reed                    51       Vice President, General Counsel and Secretary                           1994
Robert T. Ritter                  51       Vice President and Chief Financial Officer                              1998

OTHER OFFICERS:
Matthew A.P. Schumacher           44       Controller                                                              2001
Arthur E. Wheatley                60       Vice President and Director-Risk Management                             1988

SUBSIDIARY OFFICERS:
Joseph L. Carnes                  45       President of BAX Global Inc.                                            2000
Robert B. Allen                   49       President of Brink's Home Security, Inc.                                2001
- ----------------------------- -------- --- ---------------------------------------------------------------- --------------------
</TABLE>

Executive and other officers of Pittston are elected annually and serve at the
pleasure of its Board of Directors.

Mr. Dan was elected President, Chief Executive Officer and Director of The
Pittston Company on February 6, 1998 and was elected Chairman of the Board
effective January 1, 1999. He also serves as Chief Executive Officer of Brink's,
Incorporated, a position he has held since July 1993 and as President and Chief
Executive Officer of Brink's Holding Company, a position he has held since
December 31, 1995. He assumed the position of President of Brink's, Incorporated
in December 2002. He also serves as Chairman of the Board of BAX Global Inc., a
position he has held since February 1998. He also serves as Chairman of the
Board of Pittston Mineral Ventures, a position he has held since August 31, 1998
and as Chairman of the Board of Pittston Coal Company, a position he has held
since September 1, 1998. From August 1992 to July 1993 he served as President of
North American operations of Brink's, Incorporated and as Executive Vice
President of Brink's, Incorporated from 1985 to 1992.

Mr. Ritter joined The Pittston Company as Vice President and Chief Financial
Officer in August 1998. From June 1996 to July 1998, he served as Chief
Financial Officer of WLR Foods, Inc. He was a private investor and financial
consultant from April 1995 to May 1996 and was Treasurer at American Cyanamid
Company from March 1991 to January 1994 and Controller from February 1994 to
March 1995.

Messrs. Hartough, Lennon, Reed and Wheatley have served in their present
positions for more than the past five years.

Mr. Schumacher was elected to his current position on July 13, 2001 after
joining the Company in July 2001. For the five years prior to July 2001, he was
employed by NL Industries, Inc. as the Manager of Financial Reporting in 1996
and as the Assistant Controller in 1997 through July 2001.

Mr. Carnes was elected President of BAX Global Inc. in May 2000. He joined BAX
Global Inc. as President - U.S. and Canada in September 1999. Prior to joining
BAX Global Inc., he served as Executive Vice President, North America for Fritz
Companies Inc. where he was employed from 1987 to 1999.

Mr. Allen joined Brink's Home Security, Inc. in August 1999 as Executive Vice
President and Chief Operating Officer. He was promoted to President of Brink's
Home Security, Inc. in March 2001. From January 1997 to August 1999, he held
various positions at Aegis Communications Group (formerly ATC Communications)
including Executive Vice President of Sales and Marketing and Chief Operating
Officer. From 1980 through 1996, he held various domestic and international
positions at Frito-Lay including Vice President of Field Marketing and Country
Manager in Greece and Turkey.


                                      -11-
<PAGE>

PART II
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

ITEM 5. MARKET FOR REGISTRANT'S COMMON EQUITY AND RELATED SHAREHOLDER MATTERS
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

Prior to January 14, 2000, the Company had three classes of common stock:
Pittston Brink's Group Common Stock ("Brink's Stock"), Pittston BAX Group Common
Stock ("BAX Stock") and Pittston Minerals Group Common Stock ("Minerals Stock").
On January 14, 2000, the holders of Minerals Stock received 0.0817 shares of
Brink's Stock for each share of their Minerals Stock, and holders of BAX Stock
received 0.4848 shares of Brink's Stock for each share of their BAX Stock.
Brink's Stock is now the only outstanding class of common stock of the Company
and continues to trade on the New York Stock Exchange under the symbol "PZB."

Reference is made to page 77 of the Company's 2002 Annual Report which is herein
incorporated by reference, for other information required by this item.

ITEM 6. SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

Reference is made to pages 78 and 79 of the Company's 2002 Annual Report which
is herein incorporated by reference, for information required by this item.

ITEM 7.  MANAGEMENT'S  DISCUSSION  AND  ANALYSIS  OF RESULTS OF  OPERATIONS  AND
FINANCIAL CONDITION
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Reference is made to pages 2 through 36 of the Company's 2002 Annual Report
which is herein incorporated by reference, for information required by this
item.

ITEM 7A. QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

The information regarding quantitative and qualitative disclosures about market
risk is included in this report under Item 7.

ITEM 8. FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY DATA
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

Reference is made to pages 37 through 77 of the Company's 2002 Annual Report
which is herein incorporated by reference, for information required by this
item.

ITEM  9.  CHANGES  IN AND  DISAGREEMENTS  WITH  ACCOUNTANTS  ON  ACCOUNTING  AND
FINANCIAL DISCLOSURE
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

Not applicable.


                                      -12-
<PAGE>

PART III
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------


ITEM 10. DIRECTORS AND EXECUTIVE OFFICERS OF THE REGISTRANT
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

The information required by this Item regarding directors is herein incorporated
by reference to the Company's definitive proxy statement to be filed pursuant to
Regulation 14A within 120 days after December 31, 2002. The information
regarding executive officers is included in this report following Item 4, under
the caption "Executive Officers of the Registrant."

ITEM 11. EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

The information required by Item 11 is incorporated by reference to the
Company's definitive proxy statement to be filed pursuant to Regulation 14A
within 120 days after December 31, 2002.

ITEM 12. SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<TABLE>

<CAPTION>
                                                             Equity Compensation Plan Information
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                                                                 Number of securities remaining
Plan Category            Number of securities to be issued      Weighted average excercise   available for future issuance under
                           upon exercise of outstanding        price of outstanding options, equity compensation plans (excluding
(Shares in millions)        options warrants and rights            warrants and rights       securities reflected in column (a))
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                     (a)                                  (b)                              (c)(1)
<S>                                   <C>                                  <C>                              <C>
Equity compensation
   plans approved by
   security holders               4,123,973                         $   23.18                          1,591,479
Equity compensation
   plans not approved
   by security holders                    -                              -                                   -
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Total                             4,123,973                         $   23.18                          1,591,479
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<FN>

(1)The Key Employees' Deferred Compensation Program of The Pittston Company, as
approved by shareholders, has no limit as to the number of securities available
for issuance. The Pittston Company Director's Stock Accumulation Plan, as
approved by shareholders, has 17,006 shares available for issuance.
</FN>
</TABLE>

Other information required by Item 12 is incorporated by reference to the
Company's definitive proxy statement to be filed pursuant to Regulation 14A
within 120 days after December 31, 2002.

ITEM 13. CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

The information required by Item 13 is incorporated by reference to the
Company's definitive proxy statement to be filed pursuant to Regulation 14A
within 120 days after December 31, 2002.

ITEM 14. CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

Within the 90 days prior to the filing date of this report, the Company
performed an evaluation under the supervision and with the participation of the
Company's management, including the Chief Executive Officer and the Chief
Financial Officer, of the effectiveness of the design and operation of the
Company's disclosure controls and procedures. Based on that evaluation, the
Company's management, including the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial
Officer, concluded that the Company's disclosure controls and procedures were
effective in ensuring that material information relating to the Company was made
known to them, particularly with respect to the period covered by this report.
There have been no significant changes in the Company's internal controls or in
other factors that could significantly affect internal controls subsequent to
date of the evaluation.


                                      -13-
<PAGE>









PART IV
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

ITEM 15. EXHIBITS, FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES AND REPORTS ON FORM 8-K
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

(a)  1.  All financial statements - see index to financial statements and
         schedules.

     2.  Financial statement schedules - see index to financial statements and
         schedules.

     3.  Exhibits - see exhibit index.

(b)  A report on Form 8-K was filed on December 30, 2002. Under Items 2 and
     7 the Company reported the sale of its coal operations in Virginia to
     subsidiaries of Alpha Natural Resources, LLC and provided the required
     pro forma financial information. No other reports on Form 8-K were
     filed during the fourth quarter of 2002 and through the date of this
     report.


UNDERTAKING
For the purposes of complying with the amendments to the rules governing Form
S-8 (effective July 13, 1990) under the Securities Act of 1933, the undersigned
Registrant hereby undertakes as follows, which undertaking shall be incorporated
by reference into Registrant's Registration Statements on Form S-8 Nos. 2-64258,
33-2039, 33-21393, 33-23333, 33-69040, 33-53565, 333-02219, 333-78631,
333-78633, 333-70758, 333-70772, 333-70766 and 333-70762. Insofar as
indemnification for liabilities arising under the Securities Act of 1933 may be
permitted to directors, officers and controlling persons of the Registrant
pursuant to the foregoing provisions, or otherwise, the Registrant has been
advised that in the opinion of the Securities and Exchange Commission such
indemnification is against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act of
1933 and is, therefore, unenforceable. In the event that a claim for
indemnification against liabilities (other than the payment by the Registrant of
expenses incurred or paid by a director, officer or controlling person of the
Registrant in the successful defense of any action, suit or proceeding) is
asserted by such director, officer or controlling person in connection with the
securities being registered, the Registrant will, unless in the opinion of its
counsel the matter has been settled by controlling precedent, submit to a court
of appropriate jurisdiction the question whether such indemnification by it is
against public policy as expressed in the Act and will be governed by the final
adjudication of such issue.




                                      -14-
<PAGE>



SIGNATURES

Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange
Act of 1934, the Registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its
behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, on March 26, 2003.

                      The Pittston Company
                  -----------------------------
                          (Registrant)




             By            /s/ M. T. Dan
                 -----------------------------------
                          (M. T. Dan,
                    Chairman, President and
                   Chief Executive Officer)


Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report
has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the Registrant and
in the capacities indicated, on March 26, 2003.

 Signatures                                      Title
 -----------------                          -----------

  R. G. Ackerman*                                 Director
  B. C. Alewine*                                  Director
  J. R. Barker*                                   Director
  M. C. Breslawsky*                               Director
  J. L. Broadhead*                                Director
  W. F. Craig*                                    Director



  /s/ M. T. Dan
  ------------------------------------------
  (M. T. Dan)                                 Chairman, President and
                                              Chief Executive Officer
                                             (principal executive officer)


  M.L. Grimes*                                    Director
  G. Grinstein*                                   Director
  R. M. Gross*                                    Director


  /s/ R. T. Ritter
  ----------------------------------------------
  (R. T. Ritter)                                  Vice President and
                                              and Chief Financial Officer
                                             (principal financial officer and
                                               principal accounting officer)


  C. S. Sloane*                                   Director
  R. L. Turner*                                   Director

  *By      /s/ M. T. Dan
           -------------------------------------
           (M. T. Dan, Attorney-in-Fact)




                                      -15-
<PAGE>







         CERTIFICATIONS


         I, Michael T. Dan, certify that:

         1.       I have reviewed this annual report on Form 10-K of The
                  Pittston Company;

         2.       Based on my knowledge, this annual report does not contain any
                  untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a
                  material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light
                  of the circumstances under which such statements were made,
                  not misleading with respect to the period covered by this
                  annual report;

         3.       Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other
                  financial information included in this annual report, fairly
                  present in all material respects the financial condition,
                  results of operations and cash flows of the registrant as of,
                  and for, the periods presented in this annual report;

         4.       The registrant's other certifying officer and I are
                  responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure
                  controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules
                  13a-14 and 15d-14) for the registrant and have:

                  a)       Designed such disclosure controls and procedures to
                           ensure that material information relating to the
                           registrant, including its consolidated subsidiaries,
                           is made known to us by others within those entities,
                           particularly during the period in which this annual
                           report is being prepared;

                  b)       Evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant's
                           disclosure controls and procedures as of a date
                           within 90 days prior to the filing date of this
                           annual report (the "Evaluation Date"); and

                  c)       Presented in this annual report our conclusions about
                           the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and
                           procedures based on our evaluation as of the
                           Evaluation Date;

         5.       The registrant's other certifying officer and I have
                  disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation, to the
                  registrant's auditors and the audit committee of registrant's
                  board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent
                  functions):

                  a)       All significant deficiencies in the design or
                           operation of internal controls which could adversely
                           affect the registrant's ability to record, process,
                           summarize and report financial data and have
                           identified for the registrant's auditors any material
                           weaknesses in internal controls; and

                  b)       Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves
                           management or other employees who have a significant
                           role in the registrant's internal controls; and

         6.       The registrant's other certifying officer and I have indicated
                  in this annual report whether there were significant changes
                  in internal controls or in other factors that could
                  significantly affect internal controls subsequent to the date
                  of our most recent evaluation, including any corrective
                  actions with regard to significant deficiencies and material
                  weaknesses.

Date:    March 26, 2003                              /s/ Michael T. Dan
                                                     ---------------------------
                                                     Michael T. Dan
                                                     Chief Executive Officer




                                      -16-
<PAGE>



         CERTIFICATIONS (CONTINUED)



         I, Robert T. Ritter, certify that:

         1.       I have reviewed this annual report on Form 10-K of The
                  Pittston Company;

         2.       Based on my knowledge, this annual report does not contain any
                  untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a
                  material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light
                  of the circumstances under which such statements were made,
                  not misleading with respect to the period covered by this
                  annual report;

         3.       Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other
                  financial information included in this annual report, fairly
                  present in all material respects the financial condition,
                  results of operations and cash flows of the registrant as of,
                  and for, the periods presented in this annual report;

         4.       The registrant's other certifying officer and I are
                  responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure
                  controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules
                  13a-14 and 15d-14) for the registrant and have:

                  a)       Designed such disclosure controls and procedures to
                           ensure that material information relating to the
                           registrant, including its consolidated subsidiaries,
                           is made known to us by others within those entities,
                           particularly during the period in which this annual
                           report is being prepared;

                  b)       Evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant's
                           disclosure controls and procedures as of a date
                           within 90 days prior to the filing date of this
                           annual report (the "Evaluation Date"); and

                  c)       Presented in this annual report our conclusions about
                           the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and
                           procedures based on our evaluation as of the
                           Evaluation Date;

         5.       The registrant's other certifying officer and I have
                  disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation, to the
                  registrant's auditors and the audit committee of registrant's
                  board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent
                  functions):

                  a)       All significant deficiencies in the design or
                           operation of internal controls which could adversely
                           affect the registrant's ability to record, process,
                           summarize and report financial data and have
                           identified for the registrant's auditors any material
                           weaknesses in internal controls; and

                  b)       Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves
                           management or other employees who have a significant
                           role in the registrant's internal controls; and

         6.       The registrant's other certifying officer and I have indicated
                  in this annual report whether there were significant changes
                  in internal controls or in other factors that could
                  significantly affect internal controls subsequent to the date
                  of our most recent evaluation, including any corrective
                  actions with regard to significant deficiencies and material
                  weaknesses.

Date:    March 26, 2003            /s/ Robert T. Ritter
                                   -----------------------------------
                                   Robert T. Ritter
                                   Vice President and Chief Financial Officer







                                      -17-
<PAGE>



INDEX TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SCHEDULES

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS:

The Consolidated Financial Statements of The Pittston Company, listed in the
index below which are included in the Company's 2002 Annual Report for the year
ended December 31, 2002, are herein incorporated by reference. With the
exception of the pages listed in the index below and the information
incorporated by reference included in Parts I, II and IV, the 2002 Annual Report
of the Shareholders is not deemed filed as part of this report.

THE PITTSTON COMPANY ANNUAL REPORT


                                               Page Numbers in
                                             2002 Annual Report
                                            --------------------
Management's Discussion and Analysis of
   Results of Operations and Financial Condition......2-36
Independent Auditors' Report............................38
Consolidated Balance Sheets.............................39
Consolidated Statements of Operations................40-41
Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Loss...........42
Consolidated Statements of Shareholders' Equity.........43
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows...................44
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements...........45-77
Selected Financial Data .............................78-79


FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES:

                                                 Page Numbers
                                                 in Form 10-K
                                                --------------

Independent Auditors' Report
   on Financial Statement Schedule......................19
Schedule II - Valuation and qualifying accounts.........20




                                      -18-
<PAGE>





               INDEPENDENT AUDITORS' REPORT ON FINANCIAL STATEMENT
                                    SCHEDULE


The Board of Directors
The Pittston Company

Under date of February 10, 2003, we reported on the consolidated balance sheets
of The Pittston Company and subsidiaries (the "Company") as of December 31, 2002
and 2001, and the related consolidated statements of operations, comprehensive
loss, shareholders' equity and cash flows for each of the years in the
three-year period ended December 31, 2002, as contained in the 2002 annual
report on Form 10-K. In connection with our audits of the aforementioned
consolidated financial statements, we also audited the related financial
statement schedule as included herein. This financial statement schedule is the
responsibility of the Company's management. Our responsibility is to express an
opinion on this financial statement schedule based on our audits.

In our opinion, such financial statement schedule, when considered in relation
to the basic consolidated financial statements taken as a whole, presents
fairly, in all material aspects, the information set forth therein.

As discussed in Note 1 to the consolidated financial statements, effective
January 1, 2002, the Company adopted the provisions of Statement of Financial
Accounting Standards No. 142, "Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets." Also as
discussed in Note 1 to the consolidated financial statements, the Company
changed its method of accounting for nonrefundable installation revenues and the
related direct costs of acquiring new subscribers in 2000 as a result of the
implementation of Staff Accounting Bulletin No. 101, "Revenue Recognition in
Financial Statements."

/s/ KPMG LLP

Richmond, Virginia
February 10, 2003



                                      -19-
<PAGE>



                                                The Pittston Company
                               Schedule II - Valuation and Qualifying Accounts
                           For the Years Ending December 31, 2002, 2001 and 2000
                                                (in millions)

<TABLE>


<CAPTION>
                                       Balance at           Charged to                              Currency         Balance at
                                      Beginning of           Costs and                             Translation         End of
                                         Period            Expenses (a)        Deductions (b)      Adjustment          Period
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------

Allowance for Doubtful Accounts
<S>                                  <C>                        <C>                 <C>                <C>                <C>
Year Ended December 31, 2000          $    36.2                  22.8                (17.8)             (1.4)              39.8
Year Ended December 31, 2001               39.8                  12.3                 (8.9)             (1.4)              41.8
Year Ended December 31, 2002               41.8                   4.6                (11.8)              0.9               35.5


Valuation Allowance
Year Ended December 31, 2000                7.2                   1.8                  -                 -                  9.0
Year Ended December 31, 2001                9.0                   1.3                  -                 -                 10.3
Year Ended December 31, 2002          $    10.3                   1.5                  -                (2.0)               9.8
<FN>

(a)   Includes amounts charged to loss from discontinued operations.
(b)   Amounts written off, less recoveries
</FN>
</TABLE>





                                      -20-
<PAGE>



EXHIBIT INDEX

Each Exhibit listed previously filed document is hereby incorporated by
reference to such document.



EXHIBIT
NUMBER                   DESCRIPTION

2(i)      Membership Interest Acquisition Agreement
          Among Air Transport International LLC and BAX
          Global Inc., dated February 3, 1998. Exhibit
          2 to the Registrant's Current Report on Form
          8-K filed May 14, 1998.

2(ii)     Share Purchase Agreement, dated as of January 27, 1998, between
          Brink's Security International, Inc., acting as Purchaser, and
          Generale de Transport et D'Industrie, acting as Seller. Exhibit 10(v)
          to the Registrant's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended
          December 31, 1998 (the "1998 Form 10-K").

2(iii)    Shareholders' Agreement, dated as of January
          10, 1997, between Brink's Security
          International, Inc., and Valores Tamanaco,
          C.A. Exhibit 10(w) to the 1998 Form 10-K.

3(i)      The Registrant's Articles of Correction to
          its Articles of Incorporation. Exhibit 3(i)
          to the Registrant's Quarterly Report on Form
          10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 1998.

3(ii)     The Registrant's Bylaws, as amended through September 12, 2003.
          Exhibit 3(b) to the Registrant's Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the
          quarter ended September 30, 2002 (the "Third Quarter 2002 Form 10-Q").

4(a)       (i)      Amended and Restated Rights
                    Agreement dated as of January 14,
                    2000 (the "Rights Agreement"),
                    between the Registrant and Bank
                    Boston, N.A., as Rights Agent.
                    Exhibit 4(a) (i) to the
                    Registrant's Annual Report on
                    Form 10-K for the year ended
                    December 31, 2000 (the "2000 Form
                    10-K").

           (ii)     Form of Right Certificate for
                    Rights. Exhibit 4(a)(ii) to the
                    2000 Form 10-K. Instruments
                    defining the rights of holders of
                    long-term debt of the Registrant
                    and its consolidated subsidiaries
                    have been omitted because the
                    amount of debt under any such
                    instrument does not exceed 10% of
                    the total assets of the
                    Registrant and its consolidated
                    subsidiaries. The Registrant
                    agrees to furnish a copy of any
                    such instrument to the Commission
                    upon request. Exhibit 4(a) to the
                    Registrant's Annual Report on
                    Form 10-K for the year ended
                    December 31, 1999 (the "1999 Form
                    10-K").

           (iii)    Amendment, effective November 30,
                    2001, by and among The Pittston
                    Company, Fleet National Bank (f/k/a
                    BankBoston, N.A.) and EquiServe
                    Trust Company, N.A., to the Amended
                    and Restated Rights Agreement dated
                    as of January 14, 2000 between The
                    Pittston Company and BankBoston,
                    N.A., as Rights Agent. Exhibit 1 to
                    the Registrant's Amendment No. 3 to
                    Form 8-A/A (filed on January 14,
                    2002).

10(a)*       The Key Employees' Incentive Plan, as
             amended. Exhibit 10(a) to the 1998 Form
             10-K.

10(b)*       The Key Employees' Deferred Compensation Program, as amended and
             restated as of January 14, 2000. Exhibit 10(b) to the 1999 Form
             10-K.

10(c)*      (i)     The Registrant's Pension Equalization Plan as amended.
                    Exhibit 10(e)(I) to the Registrant's Annual Report on Form
                    10-K for the year ended December 31, 1997 (the "1997 Form
                    10-K").

             (ii)   Amended and Restated Trust Agreement, dated December 1,
                    1997, between the Registrant and Chase Manhattan Bank, as
                    Trustee (the "Trust Agreement"). Exhibit 10(e)(ii) to the
                    1997 Form 10-K.

             (iii)  Amendment No. 1 to Trust Agreement,
                    dated as of August 18, 1999.  Exhibit 10(c)(iii) to the
                    1999 Form 10-K.

             (iv)   Amendment No. 2 to Trust Agreement,

                                      -21-
<PAGE>


                    dated as of July 26, 2001.



             (v)    Amendment No. 3 to Trust Agreement,
                    dated as of September 18, 2002.

             (vi)   Trust Agreement under the Pension
                    Equalization Plan, Retirement Plan
                    for Non-Employee Directors and
                    Certain Contractual Arrangements of
                    The Pittston Company made as of
                    September 16, 1994, by and between
                    the Registrant and Chase Manhattan
                    Bank (National Association), as
                    Trustee. Exhibit 10(i) to the
                    Registrant's Quarterly Report on
                    Form 10-Q for the quarter ended
                    September 30, 1994 (filed November
                    14, 1994 - File No. 1-9148) (the
                    "Third Quarter 1994 Form 10-Q").

             (vii)  Form of letter agreement dated as of September 16, 1994,
                    between the Registrant and one of its officers. Exhibit
                    10(e) to the Third Quarter 1994 Form 10-Q.

             (viii) Form of letter agreement dated as of September 16, 1994,
                    between the Registrant and Participants pursuant to the
                    Pension Equalization Plan. Exhibit 10(f) to the Third
                    Quarter 1994 Form 10-Q.

10(d)*       The Registrant's Executive Salary
             Continuation Plan. Exhibit 10(e) to the
             Registrant's Annual Report on Form 10-K
             for the year ended December 31, 1991
             (filed March 26, 1991 - File No. 1-9148)
             (the "1991 Form 10-K").

10(e)*       The Registrant's Non-Employee Directors' Stock Option Plan, as
             amended and restated as of January 14, 2000. Exhibit 10(e) to the
             1999 Form 10-K.

10(f)*       The Registrant's 1988 Stock Option Plan, as amended and restated as
             of January 14, 2000. Exhibit 10(f) to the 1999 Form 10-K.

10(g)*       The Pittston Company Management
             Performance Improvement Plan. Exhibit
             10(g) to the 1999 Form 10-K.

10(h)*       Form of change in control agreement
             replacing all prior change in control
             agreements and amendments and
             modifications thereto, between the
             Registrant (or a subsidiary) and various
             officers of the Registrant. Exhibit
             10(l)(ii) to the 1997 Form 10-K.

10(i)*       Form of Indemnification Agreement entered
             into by the Registrant with its directors
             and officers. Exhibit 10(l) to the 1991
             Form 10-K.

10(j)*       (i)    Registrant's Retirement Plan for
                    Non-Employee Directors, as amended. Exhibit 10(g) to the
                    Third Quarter 1994 Form 10-Q.

             (ii)   Form of letter agreement dated as of September 16, 1994,
                    between the Registrant and its Non-Employee Directors
                    pursuant to Retirement Plan for Non-Employee Directors.
                    Exhibit 10(h) to the Third Quarter 1994 Form 10-Q.

10(k)*       (i)    Form of severance agreement between
                    the Registrant (or a subsidiary) and
                    various of the Registrant's officers.
                    Exhibit 10(o)(ii) to the 1997 Form
                    10-K.

10(l)*       Registrant's Directors' Stock Accumulation
             Plan, as amended and restated as of January
             14, 2000.  Exhibit 10(l) to the 1999 Form
             10-K.

10(m)*       Registrant's Amended and Restated Plan for
             Deferral of Directors' Fees. Exhibit 10(o)
             to the Registrant's Annual Report on Form
             10-K for the year ended December 31, 1989
             (filed March 24, 1990 - File No. 1-9148).

10(n)        (i)    Lease dated as of April 1, 1989,
                    between Toledo-Lucas County Port
                    Authority (the "Authority"), as
                    Lessor, and Burlington, as Lessee.
                    Exhibit 10(i) to the Registrant's
                    Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the
                    quarter ended June 30, 1989 (filed
                    August 11, 1989 - File No. 1-9148)
                    (the "Second Quarter 1989 Form 10-Q").

             (ii)   Lease Guaranty Agreement dated as of
                    April 1, 1989, between Burlington
                    (formerly Burlington Air Express
                    Management Inc.), as Guarantor, and
                    the Authority. Exhibit 10(ii) to the
                    Second Quarter 1989 Form 10-Q.




                                      -22-
<PAGE>







             (iii)  Trust Indenture dated as of April 1, 1989 between the
                    Authority and Society Bank & Trust (formerly, Trustcorp.
                    Bank, Ohio) (the "Trustee"), as Trustee. Exhibit 10(iii) to
                    the Second Quarter 1989 Form 10-Q.

             (iv)   Assignment of Basic Rent and Rights Under a Lease and Lease
                    Guaranty dated as of April 1, 1989 from the Authority to the
                    Trustee. Exhibit 10(iv) to the Second Quarter 1989 Form
                    10-Q.

             (v)    Open-End First Leasehold Mortgage and Security Agreement
                    dated as of April 1, 1989 from the Authority to the Trustee.
                    Exhibit 10(v) to the Second Quarter 1989 Form 10-Q.

             (vi)   First Supplement to Lease dated as
                    of January 1, 1990, between the
                    Authority and Burlington, as Lessee.
                    Exhibit 10 to the Registrant's
                    Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for
                    the quarter ended March 31, 1990
                    (filed May 15, 1990 - File No.
                    1-9148).

             (vii)  Revised and Amended Second Supplement to Lease dated as of
                    September 1, 1990, between the Authority and Burlington.
                    Exhibit 10(i) to the Registrant's Quarterly Report on Form
                    10-Q for the quarter ended September 30, 1990 (filed
                    November 13, 1990 - File No. 1-9148) (the "Third Quarter
                    1990 Form 10-Q").

             (viii) Amendment Agreement dated as of September 1, 1990, among
                    City of Toledo, Ohio, the Authority, Burlington and the
                    Trustee. Exhibit 10(ii) to the Third Quarter 1990 Form 10-Q.

             (ix)   Assumption and Non-Merger Agreement dated as of September 1,
                    1990, among Burlington, the Authority and the Trustee.
                    Exhibit 10(iii) to the Third Quarter 1990 Form 10-Q.

             (x)    First Supplemental Indenture between
                    Toledo-Lucas County Port Authority,
                    and Society National Bank, as
                    Trustee, dated as of March 1, 1994.
                    Exhibit 10.1 to the Registrant's
                    Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for
                    the quarter ended March 31, 1994
                    (filed May 12, 1994 - File No.
                    1-9148) (the "First Quarter 1994
                    Form 10-Q").

             (xi)   Third Supplement to Lease between
                    Toledo-Lucas County Port Authority,
                    as Lessor, and Burlington Air
                    Express Inc., as Lessee, dated as of
                    March 1, 1994. Exhibit 10.2 to the
                    First Quarter 1994 Form 10-Q.

             (xii)  Fourth Supplement to Lease between
                    Toledo-Lucas County Port Authority,
                    as Lessor, and Burlington Air
                    Express Inc., as Lessee, dated as of
                    June 1, 1991. Exhibit 10.3 to the
                    First Quarter 1994 Form 10-Q.

             (xiii) Fifth Supplement to Lease between Toledo-Lucas County Port
                    Authority, as Lessor, and Burlington Air Express Inc., as
                    Lessee, dated as of December 1, 1996. Exhibit 10(r)(xiii) to
                    the Registrant's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year
                    ended December 31, 1996.

10(o)               Credit Agreement, dated as of September 6, 2002, among The
                    Pittston Company, as Borrower, Certain of Its Subsidiaries,
                    as Guarantors, Various Lenders, Fleet National Bank, as
                    Co-Arranger and Documentation Agent, Wachovia Bank, National
                    Association, and the Bank of Nova Scotia, as Co-Arrangers
                    and Syndication Agents, JPMorgan Chase Bank, as
                    Administrative Agent, and J.P. Morgan Securities Inc., as
                    Sole Advisor, Lead Arranger and Bookrunner. Exhibit 10 to
                    the Registrant's Third Quarter 2002 Form 10-Q.






                                      -23-
<PAGE>





10(p)        (i)    Credit Agreement, dated as of
                    November 12, 2002, among BAX Global
                    Inc., Brink's, Incorporated, and
                    certain of their subsidiaries, as
                    Borrowers, the Registrant as
                    Guarantor and Bayerische Hypo-Und
                    Vereinsbank AG.

             (ii)   Guaranty, dated as of November 12, 2002, between the
                    Registrant, as Guarantor, and Bayerische Hypo-Und
                    Vereinsbank AG.

10(q)        (i)    Credit Agreement, dated as of December 20, 2002, among
                    BAX Global Inc., Brink's, Incorporated and the Registrant,
                    as Borrowers and Guarantors, and ABN AMRO Bank, N.V.

             (ii)   Guaranty between BAX Global, as Guarantor, and ABN AMRO
                    Bank, N.V.

             (iii)  Guaranty between Brink's, Incorporated, as Guarantor, and
                    ABN AMRO Bank, N.V.

             (iv)   Guaranty between the Registrant, as
                    Guarantor, and ABN AMRO Bank, N.V.

10(r)*       (i)     Employment Agreement dated as
                     of May 4, 1998, between the
                     Registrant and M. T. Dan. Exhibit
                     10(a) to the Registrant's Quarterly
                     Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter
                     ended September 30, 1998 (the
                     "Third Quarter 1998 Form 10-Q").

             (ii)    Amendment No. 1 to Employment
                     Agreement between the Registrant
                     and Michael T. Dan.  Exhibit 10 to
                     the Registrant's Quarterly Report
                     on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended
                     June 30, 2002.

10(s)*       Executive Agreement dated as of May 4,
             1998, between the Registrant and M. T. Dan.
             Exhibit 10(b) to the Third Quarter 1998
             Form 10-Q.

10(t)*       Executive Agreement dated as of August 7,
             1998, between the Registrant and R. T.
             Ritter. Exhibit 10(c) to the Third Quarter
             1998 Form 10-Q.

10(u)*       Severance Agreement dated as of August 7,
             1998, between the Registrant and R. T.
             Ritter. Exhibit 10(d) to the Third Quarter
             1998 Form 10-Q.

10(v)        Trust Agreement for The Pittston Company
             Employee Welfare Benefit Trust. Exhibit
             10(t) to the 1999 Form 10-K.

10(w)        (i)   Note Purchase Agreement dated as of January 18, 2001,
                   between the Registrant and the Purchasers listed on Schedule
                   A thereto. Exhibit 10(u)(i) to the 2000 Form 10-K.

             (ii)  Form of Series A Promissory Note.
                   Exhibit 10(u)(ii) to the 2000 Form
                   10-K.

             (iii) Form of Series B Promissory Note.
                   Exhibit 10(u)(iii) to the 2000 Form
                   10-K.

10(x)        (i)   Receivables Purchase Agreement dated
                   as of December 15, 2000, among BAX
                   Funding Corporation, BAX Global Inc.,
                   Liberty Street Funding Corp. and the
                   Bank of Nova Scotia. Exhibit 10(v)(i)
                   to the 2000 Form 10-K.

             (ii)  Purchase and Sale Agreement dated as of December 15, 2000,
                   among the Originators named therein, BAX Funding Corporation
                   and BAX Global Inc. Exhibit 10(v)(ii) to the 2000 Form 10-K.

10(y)        (i)    Note Purchase Agreement dated as
                    of April 11, 2002 between the
                    Registrant and the Purchasers set
                    forth on the signature page.
                    Exhibit 10(a)(i) to the Registrant's
                    Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for
                    the quarter ended March 31, 2002
                    (the "First Quarter 2002 Form 10-Q).

             (ii)   Form of Promissory Note.
                    Exhibit 10(a)(ii) to the First
                    Quarter 2002 Form 10-Q.

13           Parts of the 2002 Annual Report of the
             Registrant.

21           Subsidiaries of the Registrant.

23           Consent of independent auditors.



                                      -24-
<PAGE>




24              Powers of attorney.

99(a)*          Amendment to Registrant's Pension-Retirement Plan relating to
                preservation of assets of the Pension-Retirement Plan upon a
                change in control. Exhibit 99 to the Registrant's Annual Report
                on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1992 (filed March
                20, 1993 - File No. 1-9148).

99(b)           Certifications of Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial
                Officer pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as adopted pursuant
                to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.

- --------------------------
*Management contract or compensatory plan or arrangement.

                                      -25-
<PAGE>



</TEXT>
</DOCUMENT>
<DOCUMENT>
<TYPE>EX-10
<SEQUENCE>3
<FILENAME>hypocreditagreement.txt
<DESCRIPTION>HYPO BANK CREDIT AGREEMENT
<TEXT>
                                CREDIT AGREEMENT



                          DATED AS OF NOVEMBER 12, 2002



                                      AMONG



                                BAX GLOBAL INC.,
                             BRINK'S, INCORPORATED,
                       AND CERTAIN OF THEIR SUBSIDIARIES,
                                  AS BORROWERS,



                              THE PITTSTON COMPANY,
                                  AS GUARANTOR,



                                       AND



                      BAYERISCHE HYPO- UND VEREINSBANK AG,
                                     AS BANK



<PAGE>



                                TABLE OF CONTENTS


 ARTICLE I DEFINITIONS..................................................1

 1.01 Defined Terms.....................................................1
 1.02 Accounting Principles............................................14

ARTICLE II LOANS

  2.01 Amounts and Terms of Commitment..................................14
  2.02 Procedure for Incurring Loans....................................15
  2.03 Conversion and Continuation Elections
  with Respect to Outstanding Loans.....................................16
  2.04 Termination or Reduction of the Commitment by BAX and Brink's....16
  2.05 Optional Prepayments.............................................17
  2.06 Repayment of Principal...........................................17
  2.07 Interest.........................................................18
  2.08 Fees.............................................................19
  2.09 Computation of Fees and Interest.................................20
  2.10 Payments by the Borrowers........................................20
  2.11 Lending Office...................................................20
  2.12 Extension of the Termination Date................................21
  2.13 Certain Obligations Joint and Several............................21

  ARTICLE III LETTERS OF CREDIT.........................................21

  3.01 The Letters of Credit Commitment.................................21
  3.02 Terms of the Letters of Credit...................................22
  3.03 Procedure for Issuance of the Letters of Credit..................22
  3.04 Drawings and Reimbursements......................................23
  3.05 Reimbursement Obligations Absolute...............................23

  ARTICLE IV TAXES, YIELD PROTECTION AND ILLEGALITY.....................24

  4.01  Taxes...........................................................24
  4.02  Illegality......................................................26
  4.03  Increased Costs and Reduction of Return; Additional
        Interest on LIBO Rate Loans.....................................26
  4.04  Funding Losses..................................................27
  4.05  Inability to Determine Rates....................................28
  4.06  Certificate of the Bank.........................................28
  4.07  Survival........................................................28

        ARTICLE V CONDITIONS PRECEDENT..................................28

  5.01  Conditions to Effectiveness of this Agreement...................28
  5.02  Conditions to Subsequent Advances...............................30
  5.03  Conditions for Participation by Additional Covered Subsidiaries.30

        ARTICLE VI REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES.......................32

  6.01  Corporate Existence.............................................32
  6.02  Non-Contravention...............................................32
  6.03  No Consent......................................................32
  6.04  Binding Obligations.............................................32
  6.05  Title to Properties.............................................32
  6.06  Subsidiaries....................................................32
  6.07  Financial Statements............................................33
  6.08  Litigation......................................................33
  6.09  Taxes...........................................................33
  6.10  ERISA...........................................................33
  6.11  No Default......................................................34
  6.12  Federal Reserve Regulations.....................................34
  6.13  Investment Company Act..........................................34
  6.14  Environmental Matters...........................................34
  6.15  Priority of Debt................................................35
  6.16  Accuracy and Completeness of Information........................35

        ARTICLE VII COVENANTS...........................................35

  7.01  Post-Effective Date Transactions................................35
  7.02  Affirmative Covenants...........................................36
  7.03  Negative Covenants..............................................36
  7.04  Reporting Requirements of the Guarantor.........................42
  7.05  Additional Requirements of the Guarantor and the Borrowers......44

        ARTICLE VIII EVENTS OF DEFAULT..................................44

  8.01  Event of Default................................................44
  8.02  Remedies........................................................46
  8.03  Rights Not Exclusive............................................47

        ARTICLE IX MISCELLANEOUS........................................47

  9.01  Amendments and Waivers..........................................47
  9.02  Notices.........................................................47
  9.03  No Waiver; Cumulative Remedies..................................48
  9.04  Costs and Expenses..............................................48
  9.05  Indemnities.....................................................48
  9.06  Successors and Assigns..........................................49
  9.07  Assignments and Participations..................................49
  9.08  Confidentiality.................................................50
  9.09  Counterparts....................................................50
  9.10  Severability....................................................50
  9.11  Governing Law and Jurisdiction..................................51
  9.12  Waiver of Jury Trial............................................51
  9.13  Inconsistencies with Other Documents............................51
  9.14  Entire Agreement................................................52


                                    SCHEDULES

Schedule 9.02                 Addresses for Notices

                                    EXHIBITS

Exhibit A     Election to Participate for BAX Covered Subsidiaries
Exhibit B     Election to Participate for Brink's Covered Subsidiaries
Exhibit C     Guaranty
Exhibit D-1   Indemnity and Waiver Request for BAX Covered Subsidiary
Exhibit D-2   Indemnity and Waiver Request for Brink's Covered Subsidiary



<PAGE>



                                       41
                                CREDIT AGREEMENT

         This CREDIT AGREEMENT is entered into as of November 12, 2002 among (i)
BAX GLOBAL INC., a Delaware corporation ("BAX"), (ii) BRINK'S, INCORPORATED, a
Delaware corporation ("Brink's"), (iii) the following subsidiaries of Brink's
(collectively, the "Brink's Covered Subsidiaries"): BRINK'S DEUTSCHLAND GMBH, a
German limited liability company, BRINK'S BETEILIGUNGSGESELLSCHAFT MBH, a German
limited liability company, BRINK'S DIAMOND & JEWELRY SERVICE NV, a Belgium
corporation, BRINK'S NEDERLAND B.V., a Dutch corporation, and BRINK'S AUSTRALIA
PTY LTD., an Australian corporation (BAX, the BAX Covered Subsidiaries, Brink's,
the Brink's Covered Subsidiaries and any other Covered Subsidiaries that
hereafter become party hereto are hereinafter referred to collectively as the
"Borrowers" and sometimes individually as a "Borrower"), (v) THE PITTSTON
COMPANY, a Virginia corporation (the "Guarantor"), and (vi) BAYERISCHE HYPO- UND
VEREINSBANK AG (the "Bank").

         WHEREAS, to finance working capital needs and capital expenditures, and
for other general corporate purposes, the Borrowers wish to establish with the
Bank a two-year revolving credit facility providing for revolving loans and
letters of credit of up to $35,000,000 in the aggregate maximum amount at any
time outstanding, and the Bank is willing to establish such credit facility on
the terms and conditions set forth herein;

         NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the mutual agreements, provisions
and covenants contained herein, the parties hereto hereby agree as follows:

ARTICLE I
                                   DEFINITIONS

     1.01  DEFINED  TERMS.  In addition to the terms  defined in the recitals to
this Agreement, the following terms have the following meanings:

                  "Advances" has the meaning assigned thereto in Section 2.01.

                  "Affiliate" means any Person directly or indirectly
         Controlling, Controlled by, or under direct or indirect common Control
         with, the Bank, including, without limitation, foreign offices of the
         Bank.

                  "Agreement" means this Credit Agreement, as it may be amended,
         supplemented or modified from time to time hereafter.

                  "Applicable LT Rating" means as to each of Moody's and S&P,
         its rating of the Guarantor's senior, unsecured, long-term,
         non-credit-enhanced debt for borrowed money (or of the unsecured
         long-term debt of any other Person, the rating of which by Moody's and
         S&P is based upon a senior, unsecured, non-credit-enhanced guarantee by
         the Guarantor).

                  "Applicable Percentage" means, for purposes of calculating (a)
         the interest rate applicable to Loans under Section 2.07, (b) the
         Facility Fee under Section 2.08(a) or (c)
<PAGE>

         the L/C Fees under Section
         2.08(b), the applicable percentage set forth in the following tables
         opposite the Applicable LT Rating:
<TABLE>

- ------------ ------------------ ------------------ ---------------------------------- -----------------------
<CAPTION>
PRICING      APPLICABLE LT                         LOANS AND FEES FOR FINANCIAL       FEES FOR PERFORMANCE
LEVEL        RATING             FACILITY FEE       LETTERS OF CREDIT                  LETTERS OF CREDIT
- ------------ ------------------ ------------------ ---------------------------------- -----------------------
- ------------ ------------------ ------------------ ---------------------------------- -----------------------
<S>          <C>                <C>                      <C>                          <C>
I            A-/A3 or above     0.125%                   0.50%                        0.3225%
- ------------ ------------------ ------------------ ---------------------------------- -----------------------
- ------------ ------------------ ------------------ ---------------------------------- -----------------------
II           BBB+/Baa1          0.15%                    0.725%                       0.485%
- ------------ ------------------ ------------------ ---------------------------------- -----------------------
- ------------ ------------------ ------------------ ---------------------------------- -----------------------
III          BBB/Baa2           0.1625%                  0.9625%                      0.6375%
- ------------ ------------------ ------------------ ---------------------------------- -----------------------
- ------------ ------------------ ------------------ ---------------------------------- -----------------------
IV           BBB-/Baa3          0.225%                   1.15%                        0.765%
- ------------ ------------------ ------------------ ---------------------------------- -----------------------
- ------------ ------------------ ------------------ ---------------------------------- -----------------------
V            BB+/Ba1            0.30%                    1.325%                       0.885%
- ------------ ------------------ ------------------ ---------------------------------- -----------------------
- ------------ ------------------ ------------------ ---------------------------------- -----------------------
VI           BB/Ba2 or below    0.40%                    1.475%                       0.9825%
- ------------ ------------------ ------------------ ---------------------------------- -----------------------
</TABLE>

                  For purposes of the foregoing, (i) if the Applicable LT
         Ratings established by Moody's and S&P differ but correspond to
         consecutive Pricing Levels, then the Pricing Level with the lower
         number (i.e., corresponding to the better rating) shall apply (i.e., if
         Moody's and S&P's Applicable LT Ratings correspond to Pricing Level I
         and Pricing Level II, then Pricing Level I shall apply), and (ii) if
         the Applicable LT Ratings established by Moody's and S&P differ but
         correspond to non-consecutive Pricing Levels, then the Pricing Level
         with a higher number (i.e., corresponding to the worse rating) minus
         one shall apply (i.e., if Moody's and S&P's Applicable LT Ratings
         correspond to Pricing Levels I and IV, then Pricing Level III shall
         apply).

                  The Applicable Percentage shall be adjusted on the date five
         (5) Business Days after the date of any change in the Applicable LT
         Ratings. Each Applicable Percentage shall be effective from such
         adjustment date until the next such adjustment date. Adjustments in the
         Applicable Percentages shall be effective as to existing Advances as
         well as any new Advance made thereafter.

                  "Approved Currencies" means Dollars and other currencies as
         are available to be lent to a Borrower by the Lending Office and which
         are freely transferable and convertible into Dollars.

                  "Assignee" has the meaning assigned thereto in Section 9.07.

                  "Bank" has the meaning assigned thereto in the preamble.

                  "Bankruptcy  Code"  means the  Federal  Bankruptcy  Reform
         Act of 1978 (12 U.S.C.ss.101, et seq.).
<PAGE>


                  "Base Rate" means the higher of:

                           (a) the rate of interest publicly announced from time
                  to time by the Bank as its "reference rate" or its "prime
                  rate" (which publicly announced rate is a rate set by the Bank
                  based upon various factors including the Bank's costs and
                  desired return, general economic conditions and other factors,
                  and is used as a reference point for pricing some loans, which
                  may be priced at, above, or below such announced rate); and

                           (b)      one-half percent per annum above the latest
         Federal Funds Rate.

                  Any change in the reference rate or prime rate announced by
         the Bank shall take effect at the opening of business on the day
         specified in the public announcement of such change.

                  "Base Rate Loan" means a Loan that bears interest based on the
         Base Rate.

                  "BAX" has the meaning assigned thereto in the preamble.

                  "BAX Covered Subsidiaries" means the BAX Covered Subsidiaries
         listed in the recitals to this Agreement, and any other Subsidiary of
         BAX as to which an executed Election to Participate in the form of
         Exhibit A hereto shall have been delivered to and approved by the Bank
         in accordance with Section 5.03.

                  "Borrower" has the meaning assigned thereto in the preamble.

                  "Brink's" has the meaning assigned thereto in the preamble.

                  "Brink's Covered Subsidiaries" means the Brink's Covered
         Subsidiaries listed in the recitals to this Agreement, and any other
         Subsidiary of Brink's as to which an executed Election to Participate
         in the form of Exhibit B hereto shall have been delivered to and
         approved by the Bank in accordance with Section 5.03.

                  "Business Day" means any day other than a Saturday, Sunday or
         other day on which commercial banks in Munich, Germany or the relevant
         Lending Office are authorized or required by law to close.

                  "Capital Adequacy Regulation" means any guideline, request or
         directive of any central bank or other Governmental Authority, or any
         other law, rule or regulation, whether or not having the force of law,
         in each case, regarding capital adequacy of any bank or of any
         corporation controlling a bank.

                  "Capital Lease" means any lease of property which should be
         capitalized on the lessee's balance sheet in accordance with GAAP; and
         "Capital Lease Obligation" means the amount of the liability so
         capitalized.
<PAGE>

                  "Change in Control" shall be deemed to have occurred if (i)
         any person or group of persons (within the meaning of Section 13(d) of
         the Securities Exchange Act, as amended) shall obtain, directly or
         indirectly, beneficially or of record, ownership or control in one or
         more series of transactions of shares representing more than 35% of the
         aggregate ordinary voting power represented by the issued and
         outstanding capital stock of the Guarantor, provided that such person
         or group of persons shall be deemed to have obtained such ownership or
         control on the date thirty days after the date that such person or
         group of persons actually obtains such ownership or control; (ii) a
         majority of the seats on the board of directors of the Guarantor shall
         be occupied by persons other than (x) directors of the Guarantor on the
         date of this Agreement or (y) directors initially nominated or
         appointed by action of the board of directors of the Guarantor; or
         (iii) there shall have occurred, under any indenture or other
         instrument evidencing Debt of the Guarantor or any Restricted
         Subsidiary for borrowed money in excess of $25,000,000, a "change in
         control" or similar event (as defined in such indenture or other
         instrument evidencing such Debt) beyond any grace period permitted
         therein obligating the Guarantor or any Restricted Subsidiary to
         repurchase, redeem or repay all or any part of such Debt or any capital
         stock provided for therein.

                  "Code" means the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended.

                  "Commercial Letter of Credit" means a documentary letter of
         credit which is drawable upon presentation of documents evidencing the
         sale or shipment of goods purchased by a Borrower or any Covered
         Subsidiary in the ordinary course of its business.

                  "Commitment" means the commitment of the Bank under this
         Agreement to make Advances in an aggregate principal amount not to
         exceed $35,000,000, as such amount may be reduced from time to time
         pursuant to Section 2.01(a), Section 2.01(b) or Section 2.04(a).

                  "Consolidated Debt", "Consolidated Lease Rentals", and
         "Consolidated Net Worth" means the Debt, Lease Rentals and Net Worth,
         as the case may be, of the Guarantor and its Restricted Subsidiaries,
         if any, all consolidated in accordance with GAAP and after giving
         appropriate effect to any outside minority interests in the Restricted
         Subsidiaries.

                  "Consolidated EBITDA" shall mean, for the Guarantor and its
         Restricted Subsidiaries for any period, an amount equal to the sum of
         (a) Consolidated Net Income for such period plus (b) to the extent
         deducted in determining Consolidated Net Income for such period, (i)
         Consolidated Interest Expense, (ii) income tax expense, (iii)
         depreciation, depletion and amortization, and (iv) all other non-cash
         charges, determined on a consolidated basis in accordance with GAAP
         after giving appropriate effect to any outside minority interests in
         the Restricted Subsidiaries.

                  "Consolidated Interest Expense" means, for any period, as
         applied to the Guarantor and its Restricted Subsidiaries, all interest
         expense (whether paid or accrued) and capitalized interest, including
         without limitation (a) the amortization of debt discount and premium,
         (b) the interest component under Capital Leases, and (c) the implied
         interest component, discount or other similar fees or charges in
         connection with any asset securitization program in each case
         determined on a consolidated basis in accordance with GAAP after giving
         appropriate effect to any outside minority interests in the Restricted
         Subsidiaries.
<PAGE>

                "Consolidated Net Income" means, for any period, the net
         income, after taxes, of the Guarantor and its Restricted Subsidiaries
         for such period determined on a consolidated basis in accordance with
         GAAP after giving appropriate effect to any outside minority interests
         in the Restricted Subsidiaries, but excluding, to the extent reflected
         in determining such net income, (a) any extraordinary gains and losses
         for such period, (b) for any period ending before January 1, 2003, any
         loss arising from or relating to the initial classification of any
         portion of the Pittston Minerals Group, Inc., and its Subsidiaries as
         discontinued operations and any subsequent adjustments associated with
         the disposition of such discontinued operations, (c) any non-cash
         impairment, write-down or write-off in the book value of any assets,
         and (d) any non-cash loss in connection with the disposition of any
         assets.

                  "Consolidated Net Worth" means, as of any date, as applied to
         the Guarantor and its Restricted Subsidiaries, shareholders' equity or
         net worth as determined and computed on a consolidated basis in
         accordance with GAAP after giving effect to any outside minority
         interests in the Restricted Subsidiaries, provided that in determining
         "Consolidated Net Worth" there shall be (a) included any issuance of
         preferred stock by the Guarantor and (b) excluded (i) any extraordinary
         gains or losses, (ii) any loss arising from or related to the initial
         classification of any portion of the Pittston Minerals Group, Inc., and
         its Subsidiaries as discontinued operations and any subsequent
         adjustment associated with the disposition of such discontinued
         operations, (iii) any non-cash impairment, write-down or write-off in
         the book value of any assets (including any reduction in shareholders'
         equity in connection with a reduction in the value of a prepaid Plan or
         foreign pension plan), and (iv) any loss in connection with the
         disposition of assets.

                  "Contaminant" shall mean any waste, hazardous material,
         hazardous substance, toxic substance, hazardous waste, special waste,
         petroleum or petroleum derived substance or waste, including any such
         pollutant, material, substance or waste regulated under any
         Environmental Law.

                  "Control", "Controlling" and "Controlled" means the power,
         direct or indirect, of one Person to direct or cause the direction of
         the management and policies of another, whether by contract, through
         voting securities or otherwise.

                  "Covered Subsidiaries" means the BAX Covered Subsidiaries and
         the Brink's Covered Subsidiaries.


                  "Debt" of any Person means all obligations which would, in
         accordance with GAAP, be classified upon its balance sheet as debt, and
         in any event includes any Capital Lease Obligation and all debt of any
         other Person:
<PAGE>

                           (a) guaranteed, directly or indirectly in any manner,
                  by the Person or endorsed (otherwise than for collection or
                  deposit in the ordinary course of business) or discounted with
                  recourse or debt which has the substantially equivalent or
                  similar economic effect of being guaranteed by the Person, or
                  of otherwise making the Person contingently liable therefor,
                  through an agreement or otherwise, including, without
                  limitation, an agreement (i) to purchase, or to advance or
                  supply funds for the payment or purchase of, the debt, (ii) to
                  purchase, sell or lease property, products, materials or
                  supplies, or transportation or services, primarily for the
                  purpose of enabling such other Person to pay the debt or to
                  assure the owner of the debt against loss, regardless of the
                  delivery or nondelivery of the property, products, materials
                  or supplies, or transportation or services or (iii) to make
                  any loan, advance, capital contribution or other investment in
                  such other Person to assure a minimum equity, asset base,
                  working capital or other balance sheet condition for any date,
                  or to provide funds for the payment of any liability, dividend
                  or stock liquidation payment, or otherwise to supply funds to
                  or in any manner invest in such other Person, it being
                  expressly understood and agreed, however, the Lease Rentals
                  under Leases shall not be considered Debt; or

                           (b) secured by an Encumbrance in respect of property
                  owned by the Person even through the Person has not assumed or
                  become liable for the payment of such debt.

                  "Default" means any event or circumstance which, with the
         giving of notice, the lapse of time, or both, would (if not cured or
         otherwise remedied) constitute an Event of Default.

                  "Dollars", "dollars" and "$" each mean lawful money of the
         United States.

                  "Dollar Equivalent" means (a) in relation to an amount
         denominated in Dollars, the amount thereof and (b) in relation to an
         amount denominated in any Approved Currency other than Dollars, the
         amount of Dollars that can be purchased with such Approved Currency at
         the spot rate of exchange determined by the Bank in accordance with its
         customary practices on the date of determination.

                  "Effective Date" means the date on which all conditions
         precedent set forth in Section 5.01 are satisfied or waived by the
         Bank.

                  "Encumbrance" means, as to any Person, any mortgage, lien,
         pledge, adverse claim, charge, security interest or other encumbrance
         in or on, or any interest or title of any vendor, lender or other
         secured party to or of the Person under any conditional sale or other
         title retention agreement or Capital Lease with respect to, any
         property or asset of the Person, or the signing or filing of a
         financing statement which names the Person as debtor, or the signing of
         any security agreement authorizing any other party as the secured party
         thereunder to file any financing statement.
<PAGE>

                  "Environmental Laws" means any and all federal, state, local
         and foreign statutes, laws, regulations, ordinances, rules, judgements,
         orders, decrees, permits, licenses, agreements or other governmental
         restrictions relating to the environment or to emissions, discharges or
         releases of pollutants, contaminants, petroleum products, or toxic or
         hazardous substances or wastes into the environment, including ambient
         air, surface water, groundwater, or land, or otherwise relating to the
         manufacture, processing, distribution, use, treatment, storage,
         disposal, transport or handling of pollutants, contaminants, petroleum
         or petroleum products, or toxic or hazardous substances or wastes or
         the clean up or other remediation thereof.

                  "ERISA" means the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of
         1974, as amended.

                  "ERISA Affiliate" means any entity or trade or business,
         whether or not incorporated, that, together with any Borrower, is
         treated as a single employer under Section 414 of the Code.

                  "Extension Request" shall have the meaning assigned thereto in
         Section 2.12.

                  "Event of Default" means any of the events or circumstances
         specified in Section 8.01.

                  "Facility Fee" has the meaning assigned thereto in Section
2.08(a).

                  "Federal Funds Rate" means, for any day, the rate set forth in
         the weekly statistical release designated as H.15(519), or any
         successor publication, published by the Federal Reserve Board
         (including any such successor, "H.15(519)") for such day opposite the
         caption "Federal Funds (Effective)". If on any relevant day such rate
         is not yet published in H.15(519), the rate for such day will be the
         rate set forth in the daily statistical release designated as the
         Composite 3:30 p.m. Quotations for U.S. Government Securities, or any
         successor publication, published by the Federal Reserve Bank of New
         York (including any such successor, the "Composite 3:30 p.m.
         Quotation") for such day under the caption "Federal Funds Effective
         Rate". If on any relevant day the appropriate rate for such previous
         day is not yet published in either H.15(519) or the Composite 3:30 p.m.
         Quotations, the rate for such day will be the arithmetic mean of the
         rates for the last transaction in overnight Federal funds arranged
         prior to 9:00 a.m. (New York time) on that day by each of three leading
         brokers of Federal funds transactions in New York City selected by the
         Bank.

                  "Federal Reserve Board" means the Board of Governors of the
         Federal Reserve System or any successor thereof.

                  "Financial Letter of Credit" has the meaning assigned thereto
in Section 3.01(a).

                  "GAAP" means United States generally accepted accounting
         principles set forth from time to time in the opinions and
         pronouncements of the Accounting Principles Board and the American
         Institute of Certified Public Accountants and statements and
         pronouncements of the Financial Accounting Standards Board (or agencies
         with similar
<PAGE>

         functions of comparable stature and authority within the
         accounting profession), or in such other statements by such other
         entity as may be in general use by significant segments of the United
         States accounting profession, which are applicable to the circumstances
         as of the date of determination.

                  "Governmental Authority" means any nation or government, any
         state or other political subdivision thereof, any central bank (or
         similar monetary or regulatory authority) thereof, any entity
         exercising executive, legislative, judicial, regulatory or
         administrative functions of or pertaining to government, and any
         corporation or other entity owned or controlled, through stock or
         capital ownership or otherwise, by any of the foregoing.

                  "Guarantor Credit Agreement" means that certain $350,000,000
         Credit Agreement, dated as of September 6, 2002 among the Guarantor (as
         borrower), the lenders party thereto, Fleet National Bank, as a
         co-arranger and documentation agent, Wachovia Bank, National
         Association and The Bank Of Nova Scotia, as co-arrangers and
         syndication agents, and JPMorgan Chase Bank, as administrative agent,
         as it may be amended, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to
         time hereafter.

                  "Guarantor" has the meaning assigned thereto in the preamble.

                  "Guaranty" means the Guaranty of the Guarantor, substantially
in the form of Exhibit C hereto.

                  "Hedging Agreements" means interest rate protection
         agreements, foreign currency exchange agreements, other interest or
         exchange rate hedging, cap or collar arrangements or arrangements
         designed to protect the Guarantor or any of its Subsidiaries against
         fluctuations in the prices of commodities.

                  "Insolvency Proceeding" means (a) any case, action or
         proceeding before any court or other Governmental Authority relating to
         bankruptcy, reorganization, insolvency, liquidation, receivership,
         dissolution, winding-up or relief of debtors, or (b) any general
         assignment for the benefit of creditors, composition, marshalling of
         assets for creditors or other, similar arrangement in respect of its
         creditors generally or any substantial portion of its creditors; and,
         in each case, undertaken under United States federal or State or
         foreign law, including the Bankruptcy Code.

                  "Interest Coverage Ratio" means, as of the last day of any
         fiscal quarter, the ratio of (a) Consolidated EBITDA to (b)
         Consolidated Interest Expense, in each case for the period of four
         consecutive fiscal quarters ending as of such day.

                  "Interest Payment Date" means (i) with respect to all Loans,
         the Termination Date, (ii) with respect to LIBO Rate Loans, the last
         day of the Interest Period applicable to each such Loan, and, if any
         such Interest Period exceeds three months, interest shall also be paid
         on the date which falls three months after the beginning of such
         Interest Period, and (iii) with respect to Base Rate Loans and Optional
         Rate Loans, the last Business Day of each calendar quarter.
<PAGE>

                  "Interest Period" means, with respect to any LIBO Rate Loan,
         the period commencing on the Business Day such Loan is disbursed,
         continued or converted to a Base Rate Loan or Optional Rate Loan, and
         in each case ending on the date one, two, three or six months
         thereafter, as selected by the relevant Borrower in its notice of
         borrowing or notice of conversion or continuation, provided that:

                           (i)i if any Interest Period would otherwise end on a
                  day which is not a Business Day, that Interest Period shall be
                  extended to the next succeeding Business Day unless the result
                  of such extension would be to carry such Interest Period into
                  another calendar month, in which event such Interest Period
                  shall end on the immediately preceding Business Day; and

                           (ii)ii any Interest Period that begins on the last
                  Business Day of a calendar month (or on a day for which there
                  is no numerically corresponding day in the calendar month at
                  the end of such Interest Period) shall end on the last
                  Business Day of the calendar month at the end of such Interest
                  Period.

                  "Labor Laws" means any and all federal, state, local and
         foreign statutes, laws, regulations, ordinances, rules, judgements and
         orders relating to employment, equal employment opportunity,
         nondiscrimination, immigration, wages, hours, benefits, collective
         bargaining, the payment of social security and similar taxes,
         occupational safety and health, and plant closing.

                  "L/C Application" has the meaning assigned thereto in Section
3.03(b).

                  "L/C Fee" has the meaning assigned thereto in Section 2.08(b).

                  "L/C Related Documents" has the meaning assigned thereto in
Section 3.05(a).

                  "Lease" means a lease, other than a Capital Lease, of real or
         personal property; and "Lease Rentals" for any period means the sum of
         the rental and other obligations to be paid by the lessee under a Lease
         during the remaining term of such Lease (excluding any extension or
         renewal thereof at the option of the lessor or the lessee unless such
         option has been exercised), excluding any amount required to be paid by
         the lessee (whether or not therein designated as rental or additional
         rental) on account of maintenance and repairs, insurance, taxes,
         assessment, water rater and similar charges.

                  "Lending Office" has the meaning assigned thereto in Section
2.11.

                  "Letter of Credit" means any stand-by letter of credit issued
         by a Lending Office pursuant to Section 3.03 and may be a Financial
         Letter of Credit or a Performance Letter of Credit.

                  "Letter of Credit Obligations" means, in respect of any Letter
         of Credit as at any date of determination, the sum of (a) the maximum
         aggregate amount which is then available to be drawn under such Letter
         of Credit plus (b) the aggregate amount of all Reimbursement
         Obligations then outstanding with respect to such Letter of Credit.
<PAGE>

                  "Leverage Ratio" means, as of any date, the ratio of (a) the
         sum of (i) Consolidated Debt as of such date, plus (ii) the amount by
         which (A) the aggregate amount, as of the preceding December 31 (or as
         of such date, if such date is December 31), of Consolidated Lease
         Rentals under noncancellable Leases entered into by the Guarantor or
         any of its Restricted Subsidiaries, discounted to present value at 10%
         and net of aggregate minimum noncancellable sublease rentals,
         determined on a basis consistent with Note 12 to the Guarantor's
         consolidated financial statements at and for the period ended December
         31, 2001, included in the Guarantor's 1992 Annual Report to
         shareholders, exceeds (B) $350,000,000, to (b) the sum of (i) the
         amount determined pursuant to clause (a), plus (ii) Consolidated Net
         Worth as of such date.

                  "LIBO Rate" means, for each Interest Period in respect of any
LIBO Rate Loan:

                           (a) the rate per annum (carried out to the fifth
                  decimal place) equal to the rate determined by the relevant
                  Lending Office to be the offered rate that appears on the page
                  of the Telerate Screen that displays an average British
                  Bankers Association Interest Settlement Rate (such page
                  currently being page number 3750) for deposits in dollars (for
                  delivery on the first day of such Interest Period) with a term
                  equivalent to such Interest Period, determined as of
                  approximately 11:00 a.m. (London time) two Business Days prior
                  to the first day of such Interest Period, or

                           (b) in the event the rate referenced in the preceding
                  subsection (a) does not appear on such page or service or such
                  page or service shall cease to be available, the rate per
                  annum (carried to the fifth decimal place) equal to the rate
                  determined by the Bank to be the offered rate on such other
                  page or other service that displays an average British Bankers
                  Association Interest Settlement Rate for deposits in dollars
                  (for delivery on the first day of such Interest Period) with a
                  term equivalent to such Interest Period, determined as of
                  approximately 11:00 a.m. (London time) two Business Days prior
                  to the first day of such Interest Period, or

                           (c) in the event the rates referenced in the
                  preceding subsections (a) and (b) are not available, the rate
                  per annum determined by the Bank as the rate of interest at
                  which dollar deposits (for delivery on the first day of such
                  Interest Period) in same day funds in the approximate amount
                  of the applicable LIBO Rate Loan and with a term equivalent to
                  such Interest Period would be offered by the Bank's London
                  Branch to major banks in the offshore dollar market at their
                  request at approximately 11:00 a.m. (London time) two Business
                  Days prior to the first day of such Interest Period.

                  "LIBO Rate Loan" means a Loan that bears interest based on the
         LIBO Rate.

                  "Loan" means an advance of funds by a Lending Office to a
         Borrower pursuant to Section 2.02, and may be a Base Rate Loan, an
         Optional Rate Loan or a LIBO Rate Loan.
<PAGE>

                  "Loan Documents" means this Agreement and all documents
         delivered to the Bank or any Lending Office in connection herewith,
         including without limitation, the Notes, the Guaranty, any L/C Related
         Documents and any other documentation executed at the request of any
         Lending Office, all as may be amended, restated or modified.

                  "Long Term Debt" of any Person means all Debt which would, in
         accordance with GAAP, be classified upon its balance sheet as long term
         debt, excluding any portion thereof which would, in accordance with
         GAAP, be classified thereon as a current liability, and in any event
         includes (a) any obligation for borrowed money outstanding under a
         revolving credit or similar agreement providing for borrowing (and
         renewals and extensions thereof) over a period of more than one year
         after the creation of such agreement notwithstanding that any
         obligation thereunder may be payable on demand or within one year after
         the creation thereof, (b) any Capital Lease Obligation and (c) any
         guarantee or equivalent or similar obligation under any agreement
         specified in subsection (a) of the definition of Debt with respect to
         Debt of another Person of the kind otherwise described in this
         definition.

                  "Margin Stock" shall have the meaning given such term in
         Regulation U promulgated by the Federal Reserve Board.

                  "Material Adverse Effect" means a material adverse change in,
         or a material adverse effect upon the financial condition or results of
         operations of the Guarantor and its Restricted Subsidiaries taken as a
         whole that would impair the Borrowers' and the Guarantor's ability to
         perform their respective obligations under this Agreement and the
         Guaranty.

                  "Maturity Date" means November 12, 2004.

                  "Minority Owned Borrower" has the meaning assigned thereto in
Section 2.01(b).

                  "Moody's" means Moody's Investors Service, Inc.


                  "Multiemployer Plan" shall mean a multiemployer plan within
         the meaning of Section 4001(a)(3) of ERISA to which any Borrower or any
         ERISA Affiliate contributes or has, on or after September 25, 1980,
         between obligated to contribute.

                  "Munich Office" means the Bank's office in Munich, Germany at
         the address set forth in Section 9.02 hereof.

                  "Net Worth" of any Person means, at any time, its
         shareholders' equity at such time determined in accordance with GAAP,
         provided that in determining "Net Worth" there shall be included any
         issue of preferred stock of such Person and, further provided that, in
         determining "Net Worth" there shall be disregarded (i) any non-cash
         write-down or write-off in the book value of any asset, (ii) any loss
         on the sale of any asset or (iii) any change in shareholders' equity
         attributable to a change in GAAP or the Guarantor's initial
         implementation of a generally accepted accounting principle or a
         Financial Accounting Standard issued by the Financial
<PAGE>

         Accounting Standards Board, all after December 31, 1993.

                  "New York Office" means the Bank's office in New York, New
                  York. "Note" has the meaning assigned thereto in Section
                  2.01(c).

                  "Obligations" means all Loans, Letter of Credit Obligations
         and other indebtedness, advances, Debts, liabilities, obligations,
         covenants and duties owing by a Borrower to the Bank, any Lending
         Office or any other Person required to be indemnified by that Borrower
         under any Loan Document, of any kind or nature, present or future,
         whether or not evidenced by any note, guaranty or other instrument,
         arising under this Agreement, under any other Loan Document, whether
         arising under, out of, or in connection with, any checks, notes,
         drafts, bills of exchange, acceptances, orders, instruments of
         guarantee and indemnity or other instruments for the payment of money,
         or in any other manner, and also including any other document made,
         delivered or given in connection therewith, and each other obligation
         and liability, whether direct or indirect, absolute or contingent, due
         or to become due, or now existing or hereafter incurred, of any
         Borrower to the Bank or any Lending Office arising under any Loan
         Document, whether on account of principal, interest, reimbursement
         obligations, fees, indemnities, costs, expenses (including, without
         limitation, all fees and disbursements of counsel to the Bank,
         including, without limitation, allocated costs of staff counsel) or
         otherwise, whether or not for the payment of money, whether arising by
         reason of an extension of credit, loan, guaranty, indemnification or in
         any other manner, whether direct or indirect (including those acquired
         by assignment), absolute or contingent, due or to become due, now
         existing or hereafter arising and however acquired.

                  "Optional Rate" means as to any Optional Rate Loan a rate of
         interest per annum to be determined at the time a Borrower gives a
         notice of borrowing for an Optional Rate Loan, which may be a fixed
         rate or a variable rate, and which shall be at a mutually agreeable
         margin over the cost to the applicable Lending Office to obtain Dollars
         or the Approved Currency in the jurisdiction in which the Optional Rate
         Loan is to be made.

                  "Optional Rate Loan" means any Loan requested by a Borrower
         which does not exceed $1,000,000, which is to be borrowed for a term
         that does not correspond to any available Interest Period or which
         otherwise bears interest at a rate negotiated by a Borrower and the
         Bank.

                  "Performance Letter of Credit" has the meaning assigned
thereto in Section 3.01(a).

                  "Performance Letter of Credit Sublimit" means $3,000,000, as
         such sublimit may be increased or reduced from time to time.

                  "Person" means an individual, partnership, limited liability
         company, corporation, business trust, joint stock company, trust,
         unincorporated association, joint venture or Governmental Authority.
<PAGE>

                  "PBGC" shall mean the Pension Benefit Guaranty Corporation and
         any entity succeeding to any or all of its functions under ERISA.

                  "Plan" shall mean a pension plan within the meaning of Section
         3(2) of ERISA subject to Title IV of ERISA which any Borrower or any
         ERISA Affiliate maintains or to which any Borrower or any ERISA
         Affiliate contributes other than a Multiemployer Plan.

                  "Reimbursement Obligation" means in respect of any Letter of
         Credit at any date of determination, the aggregate amount of all
         drawings under such Letter of Credit honored by the issuing Lending
         Office and not theretofore reimbursed by the relevant Borrower or by
         the Guarantor.

                  "Reportable Event" shall have the meaning attributed thereto
         in Section 4043 of ERISA but shall not include any event for which the
         30-30 requirement in Section 4043 of ERISA has been waived under
         regulations of the PBGC.

                  "Requirement of Law" means, as to any Person, any law
         (statutory or common), treaty, rule or regulation or determination of a
         court or an arbitrator or of a Governmental Authority, in each case
         applicable to or binding upon the Person or any of its property or to
         which the Person or any of its property is subject.

                  "Responsible Officer" means the chief executive officer,
         president, chief financial officer or treasurer of a Borrower or the
         Guarantor, or any other officer having substantially the same authority
         and responsibility.

                  "Restricted Subsidiary" means any Person which is defined as a
         "Restricted Subsidiary" from time to time pursuant to the Guarantor
         Credit Agreement.

                  "Sale and Leaseback Transaction" means the sale by the
         Guarantor or a Restricted Subsidiary to any Person (other than the
         Guarantor or a Restricted Subsidiary) of any property or asset and, as
         part of the same transaction or series of transactions, the leasing as
         lessee by the Guarantor or any Restricted Subsidiary of the same or
         another property or asset which it intends to use for substantially the
         same purpose.

                  "S&P" means Standard & Poor's Ratings Services.
                   ---

                  "Subsidiary" of a Person means (i) any corporation of which
         more than 50% of the outstanding stock having by the terms thereof
         ordinary voting power to elect a majority of the members of the board
         of directors of such corporation (irrespective or whether or not at the
         time stock of any other class or classes of such corporation shall have
         or might have voting power by reason of the happening of any
         contingency) is owned or controlled directly or indirectly by the
         Person, or one or more of the Subsidiaries of the Person, or a
         combination thereof, or (ii) any limited liability company of which
         more than 50% of the outstanding equity interests is owned or
         controlled directly or indirectly by the Person, or one or more of the
         Subsidiaries of the Person, or a combination thereof.

                  "Taxes" has the meaning assigned thereto in Section 4.01(a).
<PAGE>

                  "Termination Date" has the meaning assigned thereto in Section
2.01.

     "United States" and "U.S." each means the United States of America.


                  "Withholding Taxes" has the meaning assigned thereto in
Section 4.01(a).

1.02     ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLES.
         ---------------------

     (a) Unless the context otherwise clearly requires, all accounting terms not
expressly  defined  herein shall be construed,  and all  financial  computations
required  under  this  Agreement   shall  be  made,  in  accordance  with  GAAP,
consistently  applied.  All  calculations  made for the purposes of  determining
compliance  with this Agreement  shall (except as otherwise  expressly  provided
herein) be made by  application of GAAP applied on a basis  consistent  with the
most recent  annual or  quarterly  financial  statements  delivered  pursuant to
Section  7.04  (or,  prior to the  delivery  of the first  financial  statements
pursuant  to  Section  7.04,   consistent  with  the  annual  audited  financial
statements referenced in Section 6.07); provided,  however, if (a) the Guarantor
shall  object  to  determining  such  compliance  on such  basis  at the time of
delivery  of such  financial  statements  due to any change in GAAP or the rules
promulgated  with  respect  thereto  or (b) the Bank  shall so object in writing
within  60  days  after  delivery  of  such  financial  statements,   then  such
calculations  shall be made on a basis consistent with the most recent financial
statements  delivered by the Guarantor to the Bank as to which no such objection
shall  have been  made.

     (b) References  herein to "fiscal year" and "fiscal  quarter" refer to such
fiscal periods of the Guarantor.

                                    ARTICLE II
                                      LOANS

2.01 AMOUNTS AND TERMS OF COMMITMENT. The Bank agrees to make available to the
Borrowers (upon the request of BAX, in the case of the BAX Covered Subsidiaries,
or Brink's, in the case of the Brink's Covered Subsidiaries), from the Effective
Date until the Maturity Date or such earlier date on which the Bank terminates
the Commitment pursuant to Section 8.02(a) or BAX and Brink's terminate the
Commitment pursuant to Section 2.04(a) or such later date to which the Bank
agrees to extend the Commitment pursuant to Section 2.12 (the "Termination
Date"), committed funds in an aggregate amount of $35,000,000 (subject to
reduction pursuant to Section 2.04(a)), on the terms and conditions set forth in
this Agreement, as follows:

     (a) The  Commitment  may be drawn  upon  for  Loans or  Letters  of  Credit
(collectively,  "Advances") in Approved Currencies from the Effective Date until
the Termination Date in an aggregate  principal amount not to exceed $35,000,000
(subject  to  reduction  pursuant to Section  2.04(a)) at any time  outstanding;
provided  that:  (1) the aggregate  principal  amount of all  outstanding  Loans
(after giving effect to any amount  requested)  shall not exceed the  Commitment
minus the sum of all outstanding Letter of Credit Obligations.
<PAGE>

     (b)  Commitment  Unavailable  to Certain  Borrowers;  Acceleration  of such
Borrowers'  Advances.  If at any time while the Commitment is outstanding BAX or
Brink's ceases to be a Subsidiary of the Guarantor,  any BAX Covered  Subsidiary
ceases to be a Subsidiary of BAX or any Brink's Covered  Subsidiary ceases to be
a Subsidiary of Brink's (each such Borrower a "Minority Owned  Borrower"),  then
and in each such event, notwithstanding anything to the contrary herein (i) such
Borrower shall  immediately,  and without  further act of the Bank,  cease to be
permitted to draw upon the Commitment for any Advance, (ii) the unpaid principal
amount of all  outstanding  Loans  and  Reimbursement  Obligations  owed by such
Borrower, together with all interest and other amounts due the Bank with respect
thereto,  shall automatically  become due and payable without further act of the
Bank,  (iii) such Borrower  shall pay to the Bank an amount equal to the maximum
amount then  available to be drawn under all Letters of Credit then  outstanding
for the  account of such  Borrower,  for  deposit in a cash  collateral  account
maintained  by the Bank,  as security for such Letters of Credit,  and (iv) upon
the Bank's receipt of full payment of the amounts  contemplated  by clauses (ii)
and (iii),  such Borrower  shall cease to be a Borrower  hereunder or a party to
this Agreement.

(c)      Documentation for Loans. Each Loan may be evidenced by (a) one or more
         master promissory notes in form and substance acceptable to the
         relevant Lending Office (each a "Note") or (b) by loan accounts
         maintained by such Lending Office. The records attached as grids to the
         Notes and the loan account and account records shall be conclusive
         evidence, absent manifest error, of the amount of the Loans and the
         interest and payments thereon. Any failure to record or any error in
         doing so shall not, however, increase, limit or otherwise affect the
         obligation hereunder of any Borrower to pay any amount owing with
         respect to the Loans.

2.02 PROCEDURE FOR INCURRING LOANS. Each Loan shall be made upon the request of
a Borrower (and, in the case of a Borrower that is a BAX Covered Subsidiary, the
request of BAX, or, in the case of a Borrower that is a Brink's Covered
Subsidiary, the request of Brink's) to the Munich Office (which request must be
received by the Munich Office not later than 11:00 a.m. (Munich time)), unless
otherwise agreed by the Munich Office and such Lending Office, (a) on the
requested borrowing date, in the case of Base Rate Loans and Optional Rate Loans
to be funded to or in jurisdictions in the Munich Office's time zone and in time
zones following the Munich Office's time zone, (b) on the Business Day prior to
the requested borrowing date, in the case of Base Rate Loans and Optional Rate
Loans to be funded to or in jurisdictions in time zones ahead of the Munich
Office's time zone, and (c) three Business Days prior to the requested borrowing
date, in the case of LIBO Rate Loans), in a written notice in a form reasonably
satisfactory to the Munich Office specifying (i) the principal amount of the
Loan and whether it is to be denominated in Dollars or another Approved
Currency, (ii) the requested borrowing date, which shall be a Business Day;
(iii) whether the Loan is to be a Base Rate Loan, an Optional Rate Loan or a
LIBO Rate Loan; and (iv) if the requested Loan is a LIBO Rate Loan, the duration
of the Interest Period applicable to such Loan. If the notice of borrowing shall
fail to specify the duration of the Interest Period for any LIBO Rate Loan, such
Interest Period shall be one month. Each LIBO Rate Loan shall be in an amount of
not less than the Dollar Equivalent of $1,000,000. There shall be no minimum
amount for Optional Rate Loans and Base Rate Loans.
<PAGE>

2.03    CONVERSION AND CONTINUATION ELECTIONS WITH RESPECT TO OUTSTANDING LOANS.
        -----------------------------------------------------------------------

(a)      Any Borrower may upon irrevocable written notice to the Bank's Munich
         Office and the applicable Lending Office in accordance with Section
         2.03(b):

(i)               elect to convert, on any Business Day, any Base Rate Loan made
                  to such Borrower into a LIBO Rate Loan or Optional Rate Loan;
                  or

(ii)              elect to convert, on any Business Day, any Optional Rate Loan
                  made to such Borrower into a LIBO Rate Loan or Base Rate Loan;
                  or

(iii)             elect to convert, on the last day of any Interest Period
                  therefor, any LIBO Rate Loan made to such Borrower into a Base
                  Rate Loan or Optional Rate Loan; or

(iv)              elect, on the last day of the Interest Period with respect to
                  any LIBO Rate Loan made to such Person, to continue such Loan
                  as a LIBO Rate Loan denominated in the same currency for an
                  additional Interest Period.

(b)      Any Borrower wishing to convert or continue a Loan as described in
         Section 2.03(a) shall deliver by telex or fax, confirmed immediately in
         writing, a notice of conversion or continuation (which notice must be
         received by the Munich Office not later than 12:00 noon (Munich time),
         unless otherwise agreed by such office) (i) on the date of conversion
         of a LIBO Rate Loan into a Base Rate Loan or Optional Rate Loan, (ii)
         three Business Days prior to the date of conversion of a LIBO Rate
         Loan; and (iii) three Business Days prior to the date of continuation
         of a LIBO Rate Loan, specifying:

(A)      the proposed date of conversion or continuation;

(B)      the aggregate principal amount of Loans to be converted or continued;

(C)      the nature of the proposed conversion or continuation; and

(D)                        the duration of any requested Interest Period. If the
                           notice of conversion or continuation shall fail to
                           specify the duration of the Interest Period for any
                           LIBO Rate Loan, such Interest Period shall be one
                           month.

(c)      During the existence of a Default or Event of Default, the Bank may
         demand that any or all of the then-outstanding LIBO Rate Loans be
         converted upon their expiration into Base Rate Loans. Such conversion
         shall continue to be in effect so long as such Default or Event of
         Default continues to exist.

2.04     TERMINATION OR REDUCTION OF THE COMMITMENT BY BAX AND BRINK'S.
         -------------------------------------------------------------

     (a) BAX and  Brink's  may,  upon not less than three  Business  Days' prior
notice to the Bank and all other  Borrowers  then party hereto (i) terminate the
Commitment upon full  prepayment of all outstanding  Advances on the termination
date, or (ii)  permanently  reduce the Commitment to an amount not less than the
greater of (A) the Dollar  Equivalent of the principal amount of all Advances to
remain outstanding on the reduction date and (B) $25,000,000.  If the Commitment
is terminated  in its entirety  under this Section  2.04(a),  the portion of the
Facility  Fee  accrued  to,  but  not  including,  the  effective  date  of such
termination  shall be payable on the effective date of such termination  without
any premium or penalty.
<PAGE>

     (b)  For the  purpose  of  ensuring  compliance  with  the  maximum  amount
available  under the  Commitment,  the Bank  shall on each  date of a  voluntary
reduction of the Commitment  under Section  2.04(a) and on the last Business Day
of each  calendar  quarter,  determine  the Dollar  Equivalent  of the principal
amount of all then-outstanding Advances.

2.05 OPTIONAL PREPAYMENTS. Subject to Section 4.04, any Borrower may, at any
time or from time to time, upon at least three Business Days' notice to the
Munich Office and the applicable Lending Office, prepay Loans made to it in
whole or in part. Such notice of prepayment shall specify the date and amount of
such prepayment and whether such prepayment is of Base Rate Loans, Optional Rate
Loans, LIBO Rate Loans or any combination thereof. No such notice shall be
revocable by any Borrower after being given. Once such notice is given by any
Borrower, such Borrower shall make such prepayment, and the payment amount
specified in such notice shall be due and payable, on the date specified
therein, together (only in the case of prepayments of LIBO Rate Loans) with
accrued interest to each such date on the amount prepaid and the amounts, if
any, required pursuant to Section 4.04.

2.06     REPAYMENT OF PRINCIPAL.
         ----------------------

     (a) Each Borrower shall repay on the Termination  Date the principal amount
of the Loans made to it that are then outstanding.

     (b) In the event that the Bank determines, based on its computation made in
accordance   with  Section   2.04(b),   that  the  Dollar   Equivalent   of  the
then-outstanding  Loans and Letter of Credit Obligations exceeds the Commitment,
the Bank shall give notice to the  Guarantor  and the Borrowers of such fact and
of the  amount  of such  excess.  Within  30 days  after  the date on which  the
Borrowers  receive such notice,  they shall prepay Loans, or  collateralize  the
Letter of Credit  Obligations  with cash (as set forth below),  in the aggregate
amount of such excess.  Any such prepayment  shall be made together with accrued
but unpaid  interest on the  principal  amount  thereof and, in the case of LIBO
Rate Loans, any amounts required to be paid in connection  therewith pursuant to
Section 4.04. Any prepayments pursuant to this Section 2.06(b) shall be applied,
first, to any Base Rate Loans and Optional Rate Loans then outstanding,  second,
to  LIBO  Rate  Loans  having  Interest  Periods  ending  on the  date  of  such
prepayment,  and third,  to the extent that the  amounts  referred to in clauses
"first"  and  "second"  are not  sufficient  to satisfy  the  entire  prepayment
requirement under this Section 2.06(b) or there are no such Loans outstanding on
the date such prepayment would be required, then the remaining amount that would
be required to be prepaid  under this  Section  2.06(b)  shall be deposited in a
cash collateral  account  maintained by the Bank, to be held as security for the
Obligations hereunder pursuant to a cash collateral agreement to be entered into
in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Bank and the Borrowers, and
to be applied to the  prepayment of LIBO Rate Loans at the end of the respective
Interest Periods therefor and to the payment of Reimbursement Obligations as the
same become due.
<PAGE>

2.07     INTEREST.
         --------

     (a)  Subject  to  Section  2.07(c),  each  Loan  funded  by the Bank or any
Affiliate shall bear interest on the outstanding  principal  amount thereof from
the date when made  until it becomes  due at a rate per annum  equal to the LIBO
Rate, the Optional Rate or the Base Rate, as selected  pursuant to Section 2.02,
plus the Applicable Percentage for Loans.

     (b)  Interest  on each Loan shall be  payable  in arrears on each  Interest
Payment Date.  Interest  shall also be payable on the date of any  prepayment of
LIBO Rate  Loans  pursuant  to  Section  2.05 for the  portion  of such Loans so
prepaid  and upon  payment  (including  prepayment)  in full of LIBO Rate Loans;
provided,  however,  that interest  payable pursuant to Section 2.07(c) shall be
payable on demand.

     (c) While there shall be any default hereunder in the payment of principal,
interest,  fees or any other amount owing hereunder or after acceleration,  each
Borrower shall pay interest  (after as well as before entry of judgment  thereon
to the extent  permitted by law) on the principal  amount of all  Obligations of
such Person that are due and unpaid, at a rate per annum determined by adding 1%
per annum to the interest rate then in effect for the  applicable  type of Loan,
and, in the case of Obligations  other than Loans,  at a rate per annum equal to
the Base Rate  plus the  Applicable  Percentage  for  Loans  plus 1%;  provided,
however,  that, with respect to any Obligation for which the payment of interest
has been  determined  by a Lending  Office to be at a rate other than LIBO Rate,
the late  payment  rate  shall be 1% per annum  over  such  rate;  and  provided
further,  that, on and after the expiration of any Interest Period applicable to
any LIBO  Rate  Loan  outstanding  on the date of  occurrence  of such  Event of
Default or  acceleration,  the principal  amount of such Loan shall,  during the
continuation of such Event of Default or after acceleration,  bear interest at a
rate per annum equal to the Base Rate plus the  Applicable  Percentage for Loans
plus 1%.

     (d) Anything herein to the contrary notwithstanding, the obligations of the
Borrowers hereunder shall be subject to the limitation that payments of interest
shall not be required,  for any period for which interest is computed hereunder,
to the extent (but only to the extent) that  contracting  for or receiving  such
payment by the relevant  Lending  Office would be contrary to the  provisions of
any  applicable  law limiting the highest rate of interest which may be lawfully
contracted for, charged or received by the relevant Lending Office,  and in such
event the  Borrowers  shall pay the  relevant  Lending  Office  interest  at the
highest rate permitted by applicable law.
<PAGE>

2.08     FEES.
         ----

(a)      Facility Fee. The Borrowers shall pay to the Bank a facility fee in
         Dollars in an amount equal to the product of (i)i the Applicable
         Percentage for Facility Fee, times (ii)ii 25%, times (iii)iii the
         Commitment, computed on a quarterly basis in arrears on the last
         Business Day of each calendar quarter. Such Facility Fee shall accrue
         from the Effective Date to the Termination Date and shall be due and
         payable quarterly in arrears on the fifth Business Day following
         receipt of an invoice from the Bank, with the final payment to be made
         on the Termination Date.

(b)      Letter of Credit Fees.
         ---------------------

(i)               Each Borrower shall pay to the Bank a letter of credit fee
                  ("L/C Fee") with respect to each Letter of Credit issued by
                  the Bank in an amount determined as follows:

(A)                        subject to clause (C) below, as to Performance
                           Letters of Credit, the Dollar Equivalent of the
                           average daily undrawn amount of such issued Letters
                           of Credit as reported by the Bank times the
                           Applicable Percentage for Performance Letters of
                           Credit then in effect;

(B)                        subject to clause (C) below, as to Financial Letters
                           of Credit, the Dollar Equivalent of the average daily
                           undrawn amount of such issued Letters of Credit as
                           reported by the Bank times the Applicable Percentage
                           for Financial Letters of Credit then in effect; and

(C)                        if the original face amount of a Letter of Credit
                           does not exceed $200,000, the L/C Fee will be
                           separately agreed upon by the Borrower and the Bank
                           or applicable Lending Office at the time such Letter
                           of Credit is issued.

                  Such fee shall accrue on such amount from the date of issuance
                  of each Letter of Credit (with such issuance date being deemed
                  to be the Effective Date in the case of the Outstanding LCs
                  that are to be continued hereunder as Performance Letters of
                  Credit or Financial Letters of Credit) until its expiration
                  date, taking into account any extensions of the expiration
                  date beyond the initial expiration date. Such fee shall be
                  payable quarterly in arrears on the last day of each calendar
                  quarter and on the date each Letter of Credit expires or is
                  fully drawn.

(ii)              In addition to the letter of credit fees due the Bank
                  hereunder, each Borrower shall pay to any Lending Office
                  issuing a Letter of Credit (other than the Munich Office or
                  the New York Office) any standard amendment, negotiation or
                  other fees as such Lending Office may request at the time such
                  Letter of Credit is issued or amended.

     (c)  Arrangement  Fee.  The  Borrowers  shall  pay to the  Bank an  initial
arrangement fee in the amount of $35,000 on the Effective Date.

<PAGE>

2.09     COMPUTATION OF FEES AND INTEREST.
         --------------------------------

(a)      All computations of interest payable in respect of Base Rate Loans at
         all times as the Base Rate is determined by the Bank's "reference" or
         "prime" rate shall be made on the basis of a year of 365 or 366 days,
         as the case may be, and actual days elapsed. All other computations of
         fees and interest under this Agreement shall be made on the basis of a
         360-day year and actual days elapsed. Interest and fees shall accrue
         during each period during which interest or such fees are computed from
         and including the first day thereof to but excluding the last day
         thereof.

(b)      Each determination of an interest rate by the Bank pursuant to any
         provision of this Agreement shall be conclusive and binding on the
         Borrowers in the absence of manifest error.

2.10     PAYMENTS BY THE BORROWERS.
         -------------------------

(a)      All payments (including prepayments) to be made by any Borrower on
         account of Obligations shall be made without set-off or counterclaim
         and shall, except as otherwise expressly provided herein, be made to
         the relevant Lending Office, in the currency in which the relevant type
         of Obligation was denominated and in immediately available funds, no
         later than 3:00 p.m. (local time) unless otherwise agreed, on the date
         specified herein. Any payment which is received by a Lending Office
         later than 3:00 p.m. (local time) shall be deemed to have been received
         on the immediately succeeding Business Day and any applicable interest
         or fee shall continue to accrue.

(b)      Whenever any payment hereunder shall be stated to be due on a day other
         than a Business Day, such payment shall be made on the next succeeding
         Business Day, and such extension of time shall in such case be included
         in the computation of interest or fees, as the case may be, subject to
         the provisions set forth in the definition of "Interest Period" herein.

2.11 LENDING OFFICE. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained herein,
each Advance made for the account of any Borrower incorporated or otherwise
organized in the United States or any political subdivision thereof shall be
made by the Bank's New York Office, unless otherwise agreed to by the parties,
and each Advance made for the account of any Borrower incorporated or otherwise
organized in any foreign country shall be made by an Affiliate of the Bank
located in such country, if applicable, and otherwise as may be mutually agreed
upon by the Bank and such Borrower (the Bank's branch or office or such foreign
Affiliate, as the case may be, which is required to make a given Advance
hereunder is referred to as the "Lending Office" with respect to such Advance).
The Bank agrees to use its best efforts not to change the location of any
Lending Office or to transfer its interest in any Loan to an Assignee so as to
cause payments by any Borrower to be made to a Lending Office outside the
country in which such Borrower is incorporated or otherwise organized. If the
Bank intends to change the location of any such Lending Office and such change
would cause any Borrower to become liable to make payments to the Bank pursuant
to Article IV, such payments shall not be applicable unless the Bank has given
the Borrowers at least 30 days' prior notice of the change, unless the relevant
sections of Article IV provide for a different notice period.
<PAGE>

2.12 EXTENSION OF THE TERMINATION DATE. BAX and Brink's, by notice to the Bank
and the other Borrowers then party hereto (an "Extension Request") at any time
not less than 90 days prior to the Termination Date then in effect, request that
such Termination Date be extended for successive one-year terms. If in its sole
discretion the Bank agrees to grant the Extension Request, the Bank shall so
notify Brink's and BAX within 30 days after the Bank's receipt of the Extension
Request, whereupon the Termination Date shall be extended for one year.

2.13 CERTAIN OBLIGATIONS JOINT AND SEVERAL. BAX shall be jointly and severally
liable with each of the BAX Covered Subsidiaries for all Obligations of such BAX
Covered Subsidiary. Brink's shall be jointly and severally liable with each of
the Brink's Covered Subsidiaries for all Obligations of such Brink's Covered
Subsidiary. Other than as set forth herein, no Borrower shall be liable for the
Obligations of any other Borrower.

ARTICLE III
                                LETTERS OF CREDIT

3.01     THE LETTERS OF CREDIT COMMITMENT.
         --------------------------------

     (a) Letters of Credit denominated in Dollars or any other Approved Currency
may be issued under the  Commitment for the following  purposes:  (i) "Financial
Letters of Credit" may be issued to any Person other than an Affiliate to secure
the payment by any Person of its financial obligations, or to provide counter or
"back-up"  guarantees in support of bank guarantees,  Letters of Credit or other
credit  facilities  afforded  to  a  Borrower,  or  to  support  local  currency
borrowings outside the United States,  and (ii) "Performance  Letters of Credit"
may be issued to secure the performance by any Person of its obligations,  or to
guaranty or otherwise secure any Person's obligations relating to a bid, advance
payment or  security  deposit,  retention  release,  custom  and duty  deferment
guaranty  or bond,  warranty or  performance  bond or other  guaranty  and shall
include  Commercial  Letters of Credit.  No Lending Office shall be obligated to
issue any Letter of Credit if, after giving effect to such issuance, (a) the sum
of the (i)  aggregate  amount  of Letter  of  Credit  Obligations  plus (ii) the
aggregate principal amount of outstanding Loans would exceed the Commitment,  or
any Performance  Letter of Credit if, after giving effect to such issuance,  the
aggregate  Letter  of  Credit  Obligations  allocable  to the  then  outstanding
Performance  Letters of Credit  would  exceed the  Performance  Letter of Credit
Sublimit,  provided  that for  --------  purposes of  determining  the amount of
Letter of Credit  Obligations  under  Performance  Letters of Credit at any such
time,  any portion of such amount that is  denominated  in an Approved  Currency
shall be included in such amount as the Dollar Equivalent thereof at such time.

     (b) No  Lending  Office  shall be  obligated  to issue any Letter of Credit
hereunder if such issuance  would conflict with, or cause such Lending Office to
be in violation of, any  Requirements  of Law,  including any prohibition of the
Foreign Assets Control regulations of the United States Treasury Department,  or
after the Bank or any  Lending  Office  has  promptly  notified  the  applicable
Borrower that it cannot, for any reason, issue a particular Letter of Credit.
<PAGE>

3.02     TERMS OF THE LETTERS OF CREDIT.
         ------------------------------

     (a) Performance Letters of Credit issued after the Effective Date shall not
have a term exceeding one year.

     (b) No Letter of Credit may expire  (including all rights of renewal) later
than the Termination Date,  provided,  however,  that the Bank in its discretion
may elect to, and may elect to allow any other relevant Lending Office to, issue
Letters of Credit that expire after the relevant  Termination  Date,  upon terms
and  conditions  acceptable  to the Bank,  including  without  limitation,  cash
collateral provisions,  it being understood and agreed that this Agreement shall
remain in full force and effect with respect to all such Letters of Credit until
they have expired and all related Letter of Credit Obligations have been paid in
full. Without limiting the generality of the foregoing,  the applicable Borrower
will cash  collateralize  each Letter of Credit  that  remains  outstanding  and
undrawn as of the Termination Date by deposit of immediately  available funds in
an  amount  equal  to  the  undrawn  amount  of  such  Letter  of  Credit  in  a
non-interest-bearing account maintained with the Bank.

3.03     PROCEDURE FOR ISSUANCE OF THE LETTERS OF CREDIT.
         -----------------------------------------------

     (a) Each Letter of Credit to be issued  after the  Effective  Date shall be
issued upon the request of a Borrower  (and, in the case of a Borrower that is a
BAX Covered  Subsidiary,  the request of BAX, or, in the case of a Borrower that
is a Brink's Covered Subsidiary,  the request of Brink's) received by the Bank's
Munich Office and any other  relevant  Lending  Office not later than 12:00 noon
(local  time),  unless  otherwise  agreed by the Munich  Office and the relevant
Lending Office, three (3) Business Days prior to the requested date of issuance.
Upon receipt of such request,  the Bank and any other  relevant  Lending  Office
will  determine  whether or not the  issuance of such Letter of Credit  would be
permitted pursuant to Section 3.01.


     (b) Each  request  for  issuance  of a Letter  of  Credit  shall be made in
writing by fax and  confirmed  by delivery of the  original  executed  Letter of
Credit Application and Agreement,  in the Bank's standard form or a similar form
if the  relevant  Lending  Office  uses a  different  form  (each,  an "L/C
Application"),  not later than one (1) Business Day thereafter. Each request for
issuance of a Letter of Credit and each L/C  Application  shall  specify,  among
other things: (i) the proposed date of issuance (which shall be a Business Day);
(ii) the face amount of the Letter of Credit;  (iii) the date of  expiration  of
the Letter of Credit; (iv) the name and address of the beneficiary  thereof; (v)
the documents to be presented by the beneficiary of the Letter of Credit in case
of any drawing thereunder; (vi) the full text of any certificate to be presented
by the  beneficiary  in case of any drawing  thereunder;  and (vii)  whether the
Letter of Credit is a Financial Letter of Credit or a Performance
         Letter of Credit.

     (c) Any request for an amendment to any previously-issued  Letter of Credit
shall be received by the Bank and any Lending  Office which issued the Letter of
Credit not later than 12:00 noon (local time),  unless  otherwise  agreed by the
Bank and any such other Lending Office,  two (2) Business Days prior to the date
of the  proposed  amendment  in  writing by fax.  Each  written  request  for an
amendment  to a  previously-issued  Letter of Credit made by fax shall be in the
form of the relevant L/C Application signed by the relevant Borrower and, unless
otherwise  agreed by the Munich  Office and any Lending  Office which issued the
Letter of Credit in accordance with the last sentence of Section 3.02(b),  shall
not request an extension beyond the relevant  Termination Date described in said
Section. Amendments and extensions shall be at the sole discretion of the Munich
Office and any Lending Office which issued the Letter of Credit.
<PAGE>

     (d)  Notwithstanding  any provision of any L/C Application to the contrary,
in the event of any conflict  between the terms of any such L/C  Application and
the terms of this  Agreement,  the terms of this  Agreement  shall  control with
respect  to  payment  obligations,   events  of  default,   representations  and
warranties,  and  covenants,  except that such L/C  Application  may provide for
further  warranties   relating   specifically  to  the  transaction  or  affairs
underlying such Letter of Credit.

3.04 DRAWINGS AND REIMBURSEMENTS. Each Borrower hereby unconditionally and
irrevocably agrees to reimburse the relevant Lending Office for each payment
made by such Lending Office under any Letter of Credit issued for the account of
such Borrower. Such reimbursement shall be due and payable on the date the
relevant Lending Office makes such payment under such Letter of Credit. If such
reimbursement payment is not made when due, the amount thereof shall bear
interest from the date such reimbursement payment became due to the date the
relevant Lending Office is reimbursed therefor at a rate per annum equal to the
Base Rate plus 1% per annum or, with respect to any Reimbursement Obligation
denominated in a currency other than Dollars or euros, such other rate per annum
as is determined by the issuing Lending Office to be due pursuant to the
relevant L/C Related Documents, in all cases as permitted by applicable laws.
Such interest shall be payable on demand.

3.05 REIMBURSEMENT OBLIGATIONS ABSOLUTE. The obligations of the Borrowers to
reimburse the relevant Lending Office for payments made by such Lending Office
under any Letter of Credit honoring a demand for payment by the beneficiary
thereunder shall be irrevocable, absolute and unconditional under any and all
circumstances, including the following circumstances:

(a)      any lack of validity or enforceability of this Agreement, any Letter of
         Credit, any L/C Application or any other agreement or instrument
         relating thereto (collectively, the "L/C Related Documents");

(b)      any change in the time, manner or place of payment of, or in any other
         term of, all or any of the obligations of any Borrower in respect of
         any Letter of Credit or any other amendment or waiver of or any consent
         to or departure from all or any of the L/C Related Documents;

(c)      the existence of any claim, set-off, defense or other right that any
         Borrower may have at any time against any beneficiary or any transferee
         of any Letter of Credit (or any Person for whom any such beneficiary or
         any such transferee may be acting), the Bank, any Lending Office or any
         other Person, whether in connection with this Agreement, the
         transactions contemplated by the L/C Related Documents or any unrelated
         transaction;
<PAGE>

(d)      any draft, certificate, statement or other document presented under any
         Letter of Credit proving to be forged, fraudulent, invalid or
         insufficient in any respect or any statement therein being untrue or
         inaccurate in any respect other than if such payment resulted from the
         gross negligence or willful misconduct of the relevant Lending Office;

(e)      payment by the relevant Lending Office under any Letter of Credit
         against presentation of a draft or certificate that does not comply
         with the terms of the Letter of Credit other than if such payment
         resulted from the gross negligence or willful misconduct of the
         relevant Lending Office;

(f)      any release or  amendment or waiver of or consent to departure  from
         any  guaranty,  for all or any of the obligations of any Borrower in
         respect of any Letter of Credit; or

(g)      any other circumstance or happening whatsoever, whether or not similar
         to any of the foregoing, including any other circumstance that might
         otherwise constitute a defense available to, or a discharge of, any
         Borrower or any account party other than a circumstance constituting a
         breach of this Agreement by or the gross negligence or willful
         misconduct on the part of the relevant Lending Office.

ARTICLE IV
                     TAXES, YIELD PROTECTION AND ILLEGALITY

4.01     TAXES.
         -----

     (a) Payments made  hereunder and under any  instrument  executed  hereunder
shall be made free and clear of, and without  deduction for, any and all present
or future taxes, levies, imposts,  duties,  deductions,  withholding and similar
charges  ("Taxes")  excluding,  in the case of the Bank, each Lending Office and
each Assignee,  Taxes  (including  franchise or receipts taxes) imposed on or in
respect of its net income,  capital,  or receipts,  by the  jurisdiction (or any
political  subdivision thereof) under the laws of which the Bank or such Lending
Office or Assignee (as the case may be) (A) is organized,  (B) has its principal
place  of  business,  or (C) is,  through  an  office  or other  fixed  place of
business,  deemed to be doing business or maintaining a permanent  establishment
under  any  applicable  income  tax  treaty  (such   non-excluded   Taxes  being
"Withholding  Taxes").  If any Borrower or Guarantor shall be required by law to
deduct any Withholding  Taxes from or in respect of any sum payable hereunder or
under any instrument executed hereunder, such Borrower or Guarantor:

(i)               shall pay to the Bank, Lending Office or Assignee an
                  additional amount so that the net amount received and retained
                  by the Bank, Lending Office or Assignee after taking into
                  account such Withholding Taxes (and any additional Withholding
                  Taxes payable on account of any additional payment called for
                  by this sentence) will equal the full amount which would have
                  been received and retained by the Bank, Lending Office or
                  Assignee as if no such Withholding Taxes been paid, deducted,
                  or withheld;

(ii)     shall make such deductions for Withholding Taxes; and

(iii)             shall pay the full amount deducted to the relevant taxing
                  authority or other authority in accordance with applicable
                  law.

     (b) Borrower shall  indemnify the Bank,  Lending Office or Assignee (as the
case  may be) for  (i) the  full  amount  of any  Withholding  Taxes  (including
interest  and  penalties  thereon)  that the Bank,  Lending  Office or  Assignee
becomes  liable for as a result of a Borrower's  or  Guarantor's  failure to pay
such Withholding Taxes pursuant to Section 4.01 or applicable law.
<PAGE>

     (c) Each  Borrower  will  furnish  the Bank,  Lending  Office  or  Assignee
original Withholding Tax receipts,  notarized copies of Withholding Tax receipts
or such other appropriate  documentation as will prove payment of tax in a court
of law  applying  U.S.  Federal  Rules of  Evidence  for all Taxes  paid by such
Borrower  pursuant to Section 4.01(a).  The relevant  Borrower will deliver such
receipts within a reasonable period after payment of any Withholding  Taxes, but
in no event  later than 60 days after the due date for the  related  Withholding
Tax.

     (d) If the Bank,  Lending  Office or  Assignee  is  entitled to a refund or
credit of Withholding Tax, it shall use reasonable efforts to pursue such refund
(and interest with respect  thereto),  and if it receives such refund or credit,
shall pay to the  relevant  Borrower  the  amount of the  refund or credit  (and
interest with respect thereto) actually received.

     (e) The Bank,  Lending  Office or  Assignee  shall use  reasonable  efforts
(consistent with its internal policies and legal and regulatory restrictions) to
change the  jurisdiction  of its  relevant  Lending  Office if such change would
avoid  or  reduce  any  Withholding  Tax;   provided  that  no  such  change  of
jurisdiction  shall be made if, in the  reasonable  judgment  of the Bank,  such
Lending Office or such  Assignee,  such change would be  disadvantageous  to the
Bank, such Lending Office or such Assignee, as the case may be.

     (f) The Bank or its Affiliate,  Lending  Office or Assignee  agrees that it
will  deliver  to the  Guarantor  or the  Borrowers,  within  30 days  after the
execution of this  Agreement  (unless  theretofore  so delivered)  and as may be
reasonably  required from time to time by applicable law or  regulation,  United
States Internal  Revenue Service Forms W-8BEN and/or W-8ECI (or successor Forms)
or such other form, if any, as from time to time may permit the Guarantor or the
Borrowers to demonstrate that payments made by the Guarantor or the Borrowers to
the Bank or its  Affiliate,  Lending  Office or  Assignee  under this  Agreement
either are exempt from United States Federal Withholding Taxes or are payable at
a reduced rate (if any) specified in any applicable tax treaty or convention.
<PAGE>

4.02     ILLEGALITY.
         ----------

(a)      If the Bank shall determine that the introduction of any Requirement of
         Law, or any change in any Requirement of Law or in the interpretation
         or administration thereof, has made it unlawful, or that any central
         bank or other Governmental Authority has asserted that it is unlawful,
         for the Bank or any other relevant Lending Office to make LIBO Rate
         Loans or to issue Letters of Credit, then, on notice thereof by the
         Bank to the Borrowers, the obligation of the Bank to make LIBO Rate
         Loans or to issue Letters of Credit, as the case may be, shall be
         suspended until the Bank shall have notified the Borrowers that the
         circumstances giving rise to such determination no longer exist.

(b)      If the Bank shall determine that it is unlawful to maintain any LIBO
         Rate Loan, the affected Borrowers shall prepay in full all LIBO Rate
         Loans then outstanding, together with interest accrued thereon, either
         on the last day of the Interest Period thereof if the Bank may lawfully
         continue to maintain such LIBO Rate Loans to such day, or immediately,
         if the Bank may not lawfully continue to maintain such LIBO Rate Loans,
         together with any amounts required to be paid in connection therewith
         pursuant to Section 4.04.

(c)      The Bank shall immediately notify the Borrowers of any event described
         in (a) or (b) above.

4.03     INCREASED COSTS AND REDUCTION OF RETURN; ADDITIONAL INTEREST ON LIBO
RATE LOANS.


     (a) If the Bank shall determine that, due to either (i) the introduction of
any  Requirement  of Law,  or any  change  in any  Requirement  of Law or in the
interpretation  or  administration  thereof  or (ii)  the  compliance  with  any
guideline  or request  from any  central  bank or other  Governmental  Authority
(whether  or not having the force of law),  there  shall be any  increase in the
cost to the Bank or any Lending Office of agreeing to make or making, funding or
maintaining  any LIBO Rate Loans,  then the relevant  Borrowers  shall be liable
for, and shall from time to time, upon written request therefor by the Bank, pay
to the Bank additional  amounts as are sufficient to compensate the Bank or such
Lending Office for such increased costs.
     (b) If the Bank  shall have  determined  that (i) the  introduction  of any
Capital Adequacy Regulation, (ii) any change in any Capital Adequacy Regulation,
(iii) any change in the interpretation or administration of any Capital Adequacy
Regulation by any central bank or other Governmental  Authority charged with the
interpretation  or  administration  thereof,  or (iv) compliance by the Bank (or
other relevant Lending Office) or any corporation controlling the Bank, with any
Capital  Adequacy  Regulation  affects  or would  affect  the  amount of capital
required or expected to be  maintained  by the Bank,  any Lending  Office or any
corporation  controlling the Bank and (taking into  consideration the Bank's and
such controlling corporation's policies with respect to capital adequacy and the
Bank's desired return on capital) and determines that the amount of such capital
is increased as a  consequence  of Advances  under this  Agreement,  then,  upon
written request of the Bank, the Borrowers shall  immediately pay to the Bank or
the  relevant  Lending  Office,  from  time to time as  specified  by the  Bank,
additional  amounts sufficient to compensate the Bank or such Lending Office for
such increase.
<PAGE>

     (c) Each  Borrower  shall  pay to the  Bank,  as long as the Bank  shall be
required  under Federal  Reserve  Board  regulations  to maintain  reserves with
respect to liabilities or assets consisting of or including  Eurocurrency  funds
or deposits (currently known as "Eurocurrency liabilities"), additional costs on
the  unpaid  principal  amount of all LIBO Rate  Loans  made by the Bank to such
Borrower equal to the actual costs of such reserves  allocated to each such Loan
by the Bank (as determined by the Bank in good faith, which  determination shall
be conclusive absent manifest error), payable on each Interest Payment Date with
respect to each such Loan,  provided that such  Borrower  shall have received at
least 15 days' prior --------  written notice of such additional  costs from the
Bank.  If the Bank fails to give notice 15 days prior to the  relevant  Interest
Payment Date, such additional  interest shall accrue and be payable 15 days from
receipt of such notice.
     (d) The Bank will notify each  Borrower  of any event  occurring  after the
date hereof  which will entitle the Bank or any Lending  Office to  compensation
from such  Borrower  pursuant to this  Section  4.03 as promptly as  practicable
after it obtains knowledge thereof and determines to request such  compensation,
and will designate a different Lending Office if such designation will avoid the
need for,  or reduce the  amount of,  such  compensation.  If the Bank  requests
compensation  under this Section 4.03, the relevant  Borrowers may, by notice to
the Bank,  require  that:  (x) the Bank  furnish  to the  relevant  Borrowers  a
statement  setting  forth the basis for  requesting  such  compensation  and the
method  for  determining  the  amount  thereof or (y) the Loans of the type with
respect to which such  compensation  is requested be either prepaid or converted
into another type.

     4.04 FUNDING LOSSES. Each Borrower agrees to reimburse the Bank and to hold
the Bank and any relevant Lending Office harmless from any loss or expense which
the Bank may sustain or incur as a consequence of:

(a)      the failure by such Borrower to make any payment or prepayment of
         principal of any LIBO Rate Loan when due (including payments made after
         any acceleration thereof);

(b)      the failure by such Borrower to borrow, continue or convert a Loan
         after such Borrower has given (or is deemed to have given) a notice of
         borrowing or a notice of conversion or continuation;

(c)      the failure by such Borrower to make any  prepayment  after such
         Borrower has given a notice in accordance with Section 2.05;


(d)      the  prepayment  of a LIBO  Rate  Loan on a day  which  is not the last
         day of the  Interest  Period  with respect thereto; or

(e)      the conversion pursuant to Section 2.03 of any LIBO Rate Loan to a Base
         Rate Loan or Optional Rate Loan on a day that is not the last day of
         the Interest Period with respect to the LIBO Rate Loan;
<PAGE>

including any such loss or expense arising from the liquidation or reemployment
of funds obtained by any Lending Office to maintain its LIBO Rate Loans
hereunder or from fees payable to terminate the deposits from which such funds
were obtained.

4.05 INABILITY TO DETERMINE RATES. If the Bank shall have determined that for
any reason adequate and reasonable means do not exist for ascertaining the LIBO
Rate for any requested Interest Period with respect to a LIBO Rate Loan or that
the LIBO Rate for any requested Interest Period with respect thereto does not
adequately and fairly reflect the cost to the Bank or any relevant Lending
Office of funding such Loan, the Bank will forthwith give notice of such
determination to the relevant Borrowers. Thereafter, the obligation of the Bank
or any relevant Lending Office to make or continue LIBO Rate Loans or to convert
Base Rate Loans or Optional Rate Loans to LIBO Rate Loans hereunder, as the case
may be, shall be suspended until the Bank revokes such notice in writing. Upon
receipt of such notice, the relevant Borrower may revoke any notice of borrowing
or notice of conversion or continuation then submitted by it. If the relevant
Borrower does not revoke such notice with respect to a LIBO Rate Loan, the Bank
shall make, convert or continue the Loan, as proposed by such Borrower, in the
amount specified in the applicable notice submitted by such Borrower, but such
Loan shall be made, converted or continued as a Base Rate Loan instead of a LIBO
Rate Loan.

4.06 CERTIFICATE OF THE BANK. If claiming reimbursement or compensation pursuant
to this Article IV, the Bank shall deliver to each relevant Borrower a
certificate setting forth in reasonable detail the amount payable to the Bank or
any relevant Lending Office hereunder, and such certificate shall be conclusive
and binding on each recipient Borrower in the absence of manifest error.

     4.07  SURVIVAL.  The  agreements  and  obligations of the Borrowers in this
Article IV shall survive the payment of all other Obligations.
                                   ARTICLE V
                              CONDITIONS PRECEDENT

5.01 CONDITIONS TO EFFECTIVENESS OF THIS AGREEMENT. The effectiveness of this
Agreement is subject to the condition that the Bank shall have received on or
before the Effective Date all of the following, in form and substance
satisfactory to the Bank and its counsel:

(a)      Credit Agreement.  This Agreement executed by each Borrower and by the
         Guarantor;


(b)      Resolutions; Incumbency.
         -----------------------

(i)               Copies of the resolutions of the board of directors of BAX,
                  Brink's and the Guarantor approving and authorizing the
                  execution, delivery and performance of this Agreement and the
                  other Loan Documents to be delivered by it hereunder, and, in
                  the case of BAX and Brink's, authorizing the borrowing of the
                  Loans and the incurrence of the Reimbursement Obligations,
                  certified as of the Effective Date by the Secretary or an
                  Assistant Secretary of such Borrower or the Guarantor, as the
                  case may be; and
<PAGE>

(ii)              A certificate of the Secretary or Assistant Secretary of BAX,
                  Brink's and the Guarantor as of the Effective Date certifying
                  the names and true signatures of the officers of such Borrower
                  or the Guarantor, as the case may be, authorized to execute
                  and deliver this Agreement and all other Loan Documents to be
                  delivered by it hereunder.

(c)      Articles of Incorporation, By-laws and Good Standing.
         Each of the following documents:


(i)               the articles or certificate of incorporation of BAX, Brink's
                  and the Guarantor as in effect on the Effective Date,
                  certified by the Secretary of State of its state of
                  incorporation as of a recent date and by its Secretary or
                  Assistant Secretary as of the Effective Date;

(ii)              the by-laws of BAX, Brink's and the Guarantor as in effect on
                  the Effective Date, certified by the Secretary or Assistant
                  Secretary of such Borrower or the Guarantor, as the case may
                  be, as of the Effective Date; and

(iii)             a good standing certificate for BAX, Brink's and the Guarantor
                  from the Secretary of State of its state of incorporation as
                  of a recent date.

(d)      Guaranty.  The Guaranty executed by the Guarantor.


(e)      Notes. Any Notes requested by the Bank, executed by the applicable
         Borrower.


(f)      Legal  Opinion.  Opinions  in form and  substance  reasonably
         satisfactory  to the  Bank of an  assistant general  counsel of the
         Guarantor  (and in such  capacity,  acting as counsel  to the
         Borrowers)  and of Hunton & Williams, counsel to the Guarantor and the
         Borrowers.

(g)      Payment of Costs and Fees. The Borrowers shall have paid (i) all costs,
         accrued and unpaid fees and expenses incurred by the Bank, to the
         extent due and payable on the Effective Date, including the fees and
         expenses of outside counsel to the Bank, and (ii) the initial
         arrangement fee of $35,000.

(h)      Certificates.  A certificate  signed by a Responsible  Officer of each
         Borrower and the  Guarantor,  date as of the Effective Date, stating
         that:

(i)       the representations and warranties made by such Person in
          Article VI, and the representations and warranties made by the
          Guarantor in the Guaranty, are true and correct on and as of
          such date, as though made on and as of such date;

(ii)     no Default or Event of Default exists as of and after giving effect to
         the Effective Date; and

(iii)    since December 31, 2001, there has occurred no event or
         circumstance that has had or would have a Material Adverse
         Effect; and

(i)      Financial Statements. A copy of the audited and unaudited financial
         statements of the Guarantor and its Subsidiaries referred to in Section
         6.07, accompanied by a copy of the related auditor's report, in the
         case of the audited financial statements, and a certificate of a
         Responsible Officer of the Guarantor, in the case of the unaudited
         financial statements.

(j)      No Legal Bar; Approvals. All governmental and third party approvals
         necessary in connection with the financing contemplated hereby shall
         have been obtained and be in full force and effect, and there shall not
         exist any judgment, order, injunction or other restraint issued or
         filed or a hearing seeking injunctive relief or other restraint pending
         or notified prohibiting the transactions contemplated by this Agreement
         and the other Loan Documents, or any pending or threatened litigation
         seeking such a result.

     5.02 CONDITIONS TO SUBSEQUENT ADVANCES.  The obligation of the Bank to make
any  Advance  after the  Effective  Date is subject to the  satisfaction  of the
following conditions precedent on the date of the relevant extension of credit:

     (a) Notice of Advance.  The Bank shall have  received a notice of borrowing
pursuant to Section 2.02 or an L/C Application pursuant to Section 3.03;

     (b) Continuation of Representations and Warranties. The representations and
warranties  made  by the  Borrowers  and the  Guarantor  in  Article  VI and the
representations  and  warranties  made by the Guarantor in the Guaranty shall be
true and correct on and as of the date of such extension of credit with the same
effect as if made on and as of such date;

     (c) No Existing Default.  No Default or Event of Default shall exist on the
date of such  extension of credit or shall result from such extension of credit;
and
     (d) Additional  Documentation.  The relevant  Borrower shall have delivered
any Note or  other  document  as the  relevant  Lending  Office  may  reasonably
require.

         Each request for an Advance shall constitute a representation and
warranty by the requesting Borrower that, as of the date of such request and as
of the date that the Advance is made, the conditions in this Section 5.02 are
satisfied.
<PAGE>

5.03 CONDITIONS FOR PARTICIPATION BY ADDITIONAL COVERED SUBSIDIARIES. The Bank's
acceptance of additional Covered Subsidiaries as parties to and Borrowers under
this Agreement after the Effective Date is subject to the satisfaction of the
following conditions precedent before the effectiveness of each such Covered
Subsidiary's Election to Participate:

(a)      Election to Participate. The Bank shall have received an Election to
         Participate from the Covered Subsidiary, duly executed by such Covered
         Subsidiary, BAX (in the case of a BAX Covered Subsidiary) or Brink's
         (in the case of a Brink's Covered Subsidiary) and the Guarantor, in the
         form of Exhibit A hereto (in the case of a BAX Covered Subsidiary) or
         Exhibit B hereto (in the case of a Brink's Covered Subsidiary);

(b)      Authorization. The Bank shall have received evidence of the authority
         for and the validity of the Election to Participate of such Covered
         Subsidiary including, without limitation, documents of the type listed
         in Sections 5.01(b) and (c) or similar constitutive documents, and any
         other documents the Bank may reasonably request, all in form and
         substance satisfactory to the Bank.

(c)      Continuation of Representations and Warranties. The representations and
         warranties made by the Borrowers and the Guarantor in Article VI and
         the representations and warranties of the Guarantor made in the
         Guaranty shall be true and correct on and as of the date of such
         Election to Participate with the same effect as if made on and as of
         such date.

(d)      Bank Approval. The Bank, in its reasonable discretion, shall have
         accepted such Covered Subsidiary as a Borrower hereunder by returning
         an executed copy of its Election to Participate to such Covered
         Subsidiary, BAX or Brink's, as the case may be, and the Guarantor.

     (e) Indemnity and Waiver. Notwithstanding the requirements of clause (b) of
this Section 5.03,  BAX or Brink's may request that the Bank  temporarily  waive
the  requirements  of such clause (b) by executing and delivering to the Bank an
Indemnity and Waiver Request in the form of Exhibit D-1 hereto (in the case of a
BAX Covered  Subsidiary) or Exhibit D-2 hereto (in the case of a Brink's Covered
Subsidiary).  If such an Indemnity  and Waiver  Request is accepted by the Bank,
then  the  Covered  Subsidiary  to  which it  refers  may  become a party to and
Borrower under this Agreement  notwithstanding its failure to meet the condition
set forth in Section 5.03(b);  provided,  however,  that such Covered Subsidiary
must  subsequently  satisfy  the  requirements  of Section  5.03(b).  If (1) the
condition  set forth in Section  5.03(b) has not been  satisfied  within 75 days
after  such  Covered  Subsidiary  has  become a party to  andBorrower  under the
Agreement,  and (2) the Bank shall have given the  Guarantor  and either BAX (in
the case of a BAX  Covered  Subsidiary)  or  Brink's  (in the case of a  Brink's
Covered  Subsidiary)  15  days'  written  notice  of such  failure  and it shall
nevertheless  continue and (3) the proposed Covered Subsidiary together with BAX
or  Brink's,  as the case may be,  shall  not  have  notified  the Bank of their
respective  decisions that such Subsidiary shall not become a Covered Subsidiary
hereunder,  then all amounts owed to the Bank by the proposed Covered Subsidiary
hereunder,  under any promissory  note or any other loan document  shall, at the
option of the Bank and upon  written  notice from the Bank to BAX or Brink's (as
the case may be) and to the Guarantor,  become  immediately  due and payable and
such proposed Covered  Subsidiary  shall not thereafter be a Covered  Subsidiary
hereunder,  unless  and  until  such  proposed  covered  Subsidiary  shall  have
satisfied fully the requirements of this Section 5.03.
<PAGE>

                                   ARTICLE VI
                         REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES

         Each Borrower, and, to the extent set forth below, the Guarantor,
represents and warrants to the Bank, for its benefit and for the benefit of all
Lending Offices, as follows:

6.01 CORPORATE EXISTENCE. Such Borrower is duly organized, validly existing and
in good standing under the laws of its jurisdiction of incorporation and (i) has
the requisite power and authority to own its property and assets and to carry on
its business as now conducted and (ii) is qualified to do business in every
jurisdiction where such qualification is required, except where the failure so
to qualify would not have a Material Adverse Effect. Such Borrower has the
corporate power to execute and deliver and to perform its obligations under the
Loan Documents to which it is party and to borrow hereunder.

6.02 NON-CONTRAVENTION. The execution, delivery and performance by such Borrower
of the Loan Documents to which it is party have been duly authorized by all
necessary corporate action and do not and will not (i) require any consent or
approval of the shareholders of the Borrower, (ii) violate any provision of any
law, rule, regulation (including, without limitation, Regulation T, U or X of
the Federal Reserve Board), order, writ, judgment, injunction, decree,
determination, or award presently in effect having applicability to the Borrower
or of the charter or by-laws of the Borrower, (iii) result in a material breach
of or constitute a material default under any indenture or loan or credit
agreement or any other agreement, lease, or instrument to which such Borrower is
a party or by which it or its properties may be bound or affected, or (iv)
result in the creation of an Encumbrance of any nature upon or with respect to
any of the properties now owned or hereafter acquired by such Borrower; and such
Borrower is not in default under any such order, writ, judgment, injunction,
decree, determination, or award or any such indenture, agreement, lease, or
instrument or in default under any such law, rule, or regulation, which default
would have a Material Adverse Effect.

6.03 NO CONSENT. No authorization, consent, approval, license, exemption of, or
filing or registration with, or any other action in respect of any Governmental
Authority is or will be necessary for the valid execution, delivery or
performance by such Borrower of the Loan Documents to which it is party.

6.04 BINDING OBLIGATIONS. Each of the Loan Documents to which such Borrower is
party constitute legal, valid, and binding obligations of such Borrower
enforceable against such Borrower in accordance with their respective terms,
except as enforceability may be limited by applicable bankruptcy, insolvency or
similar laws affecting the enforcement of creditors' rights generally or by
equitable principles relating to enforceability.

6.05 TITLE TO PROPERTIES. Such Borrower has good and marketable title to all of
the material assets and properties purported to be owned by it, free and clear
of all liens except those liens permitted by the Guarantor Credit Agreement.

6.06 SUBSIDIARIES. Each BAX Covered Subsidiary is a Subsidiary of BAX, each
Brink's Covered Subsidiary is a Subsidiary of Brink's, and all of such Covered
Subsidiaries' shares which are owned, directly or indirectly, by BAX or Brink's
have been duly authorized and validly issued, are fully paid and nonassessable
and are free and clear of any Encumbrance. The Guarantor represents and warrants
that Pittston Minerals Group Inc., a Virginia corporation, and its Subsidiaries,
Pittston Coal Company, a Virginia corporation, and Pittston Mineral Ventures
Company, a Delaware corporation, and their respective Subsidiaries, are not
direct or indirect Subsidiaries of BAX or Brink's and may not at any time become
Covered Subsidiaries.
<PAGE>

6.07     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS.  The Guarantor hereby represents and warrants
that:


     (a) The consolidated balance sheet of the Guarantor and its Subsidiaries as
at December 31, 2001,  and the related  consolidated  statements of  operations,
shareholders'  equity and cash flows for the year then ended,  certified by KPMG
LLP,  independent public  accountants,  copies of which will be delivered to the
Bank on or prior to the Effective Date,  fairly present in all material respects
the consolidated financial condition of the Guarantor and its Subsidiaries as at
such date and the  consolidated  results of their  operations  for the year then
ended, all prepared in accordance with GAAP applied on a consistent basis.

     (b) The  unaudited  consolidated  balance  sheet of the  Guarantor  and its
Subsidiaries as at June 30, 2002, the related unaudited  consolidated  statement
of operations of the Guarantor and its  Subsidiaries for the fiscal quarter year
then ended, and the related  unaudited  consolidated  statement of cash flows of
the Guarantor and its Subsidiaries for the fiscal quarter then ended,  copies of
which will be delivered to the Bank on or prior to the  Effective  Date,  fairly
present in all material  respects the  consolidated  financial  condition of the
Guarantor and its Subsidiaries as at such date and their consolidated results of
operations  for the quarter  then ended,  all prepared in  accordance  with GAAP
(except for the omission of notes and subject to year-end  adjustments)  applied
on a consistent  basis;  and there has been no material  adverse  change in such
condition  or  operations  since June 30,  2002 that has had a Material  Adverse
Effect.

6.08 LITIGATION. Except as otherwise disclosed in writing to the Bank, including
through the delivery to the Bank of copies of reports and statements filed by
the Guarantor with the Securities and Exchange Commission, there are no actions,
suits, or proceedings pending or, to the knowledge of the Borrower, threatened
against or affecting the Borrower or the properties of such Borrower before any
Governmental Authority or arbitrator that would have a Material Adverse Effect,
and such Borrower is not in default (in any respect which would have a Material
Adverse Effect) with respect to any law, rule, regulation, order, writ,
judgment, injunction, decree, determination or award presently in effect and
applicable to such Borrower.

6.09 TAXES. Each Borrower and the Guarantor has filed all material tax returns
(federal, state, and local) required to be filed and paid all taxes shown
thereon to be due, including interest and penalties, or provided adequate
reserves, in accordance with GAAP, for the payment thereof.

6.10 ERISA. Each Plan has complied with and has been administered in all
material respects in accordance with the applicable provisions of ERISA and the
Code. No Plan has terminated under circumstances giving rise to liability of the
Borrower or any ERISA Affiliate to the PBGC under Section 4062, 4063 or 4064 of
ERISA, which liability remains unpaid in whole or in part, and no lien under
Section 4068 of ERISA exists with respect to the assets of the Borrower or any
ERISA Affiliate. No Reportable Event has occurred with respect to any Plan,
except for Reportable Events previously disclosed in writing to the Bank that
would not have a Material Adverse Effect. No accumulated funding deficiency
within the meaning of Section 302 of ERISA or Section 412 of the Code (whether
or not waived) exists with respect to any Plan, nor does any lien under Section
302 of ERISA or Section 412 of the Code exist with respect to any Plan.
<PAGE>

         Neither such Borrower nor any ERISA Affiliate has completely or
partially withdrawn from any one or more Multiemployer Plans under circumstances
which would give rise to withdrawal liability which, in the aggregate, could
have a Material Adverse Effect and which has not been fully paid as of the date
hereof. Neither the Borrower nor any ERISA Affiliate has received notice that
any Multiemployer Plan is in reorganization (within the meaning of Section 4241
of ERISA), is insolvent (within the meaning of Section 4245 of ERISA), or has
terminated under Title IV of ERISA, nor, to the best knowledge of the Borrower,
is any such reorganization, insolvency or termination reasonably likely to
occur, where such reorganization, insolvency or termination has resulted or can
reasonably be expected to result in an increase in the contributions required to
be made to such Multiemployer Plan in an amount that would have a Material
Adverse Effect. Neither the Borrower nor any ERISA Affiliate has failed to make
any contribution to a Multiemployer Plan which is required under ERISA or an
applicable collective bargaining agreement in an amount which is material in the
aggregate (except to the extent there is a good faith dispute as to whether any
contribution is owed, the amount owed or the existence of facts that would give
rise to a withdrawal).


6.11      NO DEFAULT. Each Borrower and the Guarantor represent and warrant that
no Default and no Event of Default has occurred and is continuing.

6.12     FEDERAL RESERVE REGULATIONS.
         ---------------------------

(a)      The Borrower is not engaged principally, or as one of its important
         activities, in the business of extending credit for the purpose of
         purchasing or carrying Margin Stock.

(b)      No part of the proceeds of any Advances will be used, whether directly
         or indirectly, and whether immediately, incidentally or ultimately, for
         any purpose which entails a violation of, or which is inconsistent
         with, the provisions of the Regulations promulgated by the Federal
         Reserve Board, including, without limitation, Regulations T, U or X.

6.13     INVESTMENT  COMPANY ACT. None of the Borrowers nor the Guarantor is an
"investment  company"  as  defined  in, or  subject  to  regulation  under,  the
Investment Company Act of 1940.
<PAGE>

6.14 ENVIRONMENTAL MATTERS. In the ordinary course of its business, the
Guarantor conducts an ongoing review of the effect of Environmental Laws and
laws relating to occupational safety and health on the business, operations and
properties of the Guarantor and its Subsidiaries, in the course of which it
identifies and evaluates associated liabilities and costs (including any capital
or operating expenditures required for clean-up, closure or restoration of
properties presently or previously owned, any capital or operating expenditures
required to achieve or maintain compliance with environmental protection and
occupational health and safety standards imposed by law or as a condition of any
license, permit or contact, any related constraints on operating activities,
including any periodic or permanent shutdown of any facility or reduction in the
level of or change in the nature of operations conducted thereat and any actual
or potential liabilities to third parties, including employees, and any related
costs and expenses). On the basis of this review, each Borrower and the
Guarantor represents and warrants that applicable Environmental Laws and laws
relating to occupational health and safety do not have a Material Adverse
Effect, and it has obtained and holds all material permits, licenses and
approvals required under Environmental Laws which are necessary for the conduct
of its business and the operation of its facilities, and it has not received any
written notice of any failure to be in compliance with the terms and conditions
of such permits, licenses and approvals, which failure could reasonably be
expected to have a Material Adverse Effect.

6.15 PRIORITY OF DEBT. Each Borrower and the Guarantor hereby represents and
warrants that all Debt created under this Agreement for which it is or may be
liable ranks pari passu with the Debt outstanding under the Guarantor Credit
Agreement.

6.16 ACCURACY AND COMPLETENESS OF INFORMATION. The financial statements
referenced in Section 6.07, the financial statements to be provided pursuant to
Section 7.04 and the written information with respect to the Guarantor and the
Borrowers contained in this Agreement, taken as a whole, do not contain any
material misstatement of fact or omit to state any material fact necessary to
make the statements therein, in light of the circumstances under which such
statements were then made, not misleading.

ARTICLE VII
                                    COVENANTS

7.01 POST-EFFECTIVE DATE TRANSACTIONS. Within 60 days after the Effective Date
each BAX Covered Subsidiary that is a Borrower hereunder as of the Effective
Date, each Brink's Covered Subsidiary that is a Borrower hereunder as of the
Effective Date, and each other Covered Subsidiary that may be a Borrower
hereunder when such documents are delivered, shall furnish to the Bank documents
of the type listed in Sections 5.01(b) and (c) or similar constitutive
documents. Each such Brink's Covered Subsidiary is a Subsidiary of both Brink's
and the Guarantor, and Brink's and the Guarantor each represent and warrant to
the Bank that each of the Representations and Warranties contained in Article VI
which would, by their terms, apply to a Covered Subsidiary are true and correct
with respect to such Brink's Covered Subsidiaries. In addition, the Company and
the Guarantor hereby jointly and severally agree to indemnify the Bank and hold
it harmless from any loss, cost or expense which may arise from: (i) agreeing to
the provisions of this Section 7.01 and (ii) extending credit to such Brink's
Covered Subsidiaries during such 60-day period. In addition (and without
limitation) during such 60-day period, the Guaranty shall secure the obligations
of such Brink's Covered Subsidiaries just as if the requirements of Section
5.03(b) had been fully satisfied.

                                       1
<PAGE>

7.02 AFFIRMATIVE COVENANTS. For the benefit of the Bank and all Lending Offices,
so long as any Advance remains outstanding hereunder or the Commitment remains
in effect, each Borrower and the Guarantor shall, unless the Bank otherwise
consents in writing:

(i)               Payment of Taxes, etc. Pay and discharge all taxes,
                  assessments and governmental charges or levies imposed upon it
                  or upon its income or profits, or upon any properties
                  belonging to it, prior to the date on which penalties attach
                  thereto, and all lawful claims which, if unpaid, might become
                  a lien or charge upon any of its properties; provided,
                  however, that neither it shall not be required to pay any such
                  tax, assessment, charge, levy or claim which is being
                  contested in good faith and by proper proceedings and against
                  which it is maintaining adequate reserves in accordance with
                  GAAP.

(ii)              Maintenance of Insurance. Maintain, and cause each Restricted
                  Subsidiary to maintain, insurance with responsible and
                  reputable insurance companies or associations (or, to the
                  extent consistent with prudent business practice, through its
                  own program of self-insurance) in such amounts and covering
                  such risks as is usually carried by companies engaged in
                  similar businesses and owning similar properties in the same
                  general areas in which it operates.

(iii)             Preservation of Corporate Existence, etc. Preserve and
                  maintain its corporate existence, rights, franchises and
                  privileges in the jurisdiction of its incorporation; provided,
                  however, that nothing herein contained shall prevent any
                  merger or consolidation permitted by Section 7.03(ii).

(iv)              Compliance with Laws, etc. Comply with the requirements of all
                  applicable laws, rules, regulations and orders (other than
                  laws, rules, regulations, and orders which are not final and
                  are being contested in good faith by proper proceedings) of
                  any Governmental Authority (including Labor Laws and
                  Environmental Laws) applicable to or binding upon it or its
                  property, noncompliance with which would have a Material
                  Adverse Effect.

(v)               Compliance with ERISA. Comply with the minimum funding
                  standards under ERISA with respect to its Plans and use its
                  best efforts to comply in all material respects with all other
                  applicable provisions of ERISA and the regulations and
                  interpretations promulgated thereunder.

(vi)              Access to Properties. Permit any representatives designated by
                  the Bank, upon reasonable prior notice to it, to visit its
                  properties at reasonable times and as often as reasonably
                  requested.

(vii)             Use of Proceeds. Use the Advances, and any proceeds thereof,
                  for working capital and other general corporate purposes not
                  in contravention of any Requirement of Law or the provisions
                  of Section 6.12(b).

7.03 NEGATIVE COVENANTS. For the benefit of the Bank and all Lending Offices, so
long as any Advance remains outstanding hereunder or the Commitment remains in
effect, none of the Borrowers nor the Guarantor will suffer or permit to any of
the following to exist, unless the Bank otherwise consents in writing:

                                       2
<PAGE>

     (i) Debt  Encumbrances.  Have any Debt for  borrowed  money  secured  by an
Encumbrance  on any property of any Borrower or the  Guarantor,  unless (a) such
Borrower's payment obligations hereunder, or the Guarantor's payment obligations
under the  Guaranty,  as the case may be,  shall have  effectively  been secured
equally and ratably with (or, at the option of such  Borrower or the  Guarantor,
as the case may be, in priority to) such secured Debt or (b)  immediately  after
giving effect  thereto and to any  concurrent  repayment of Debt,  the aggregate
amount of all such secured Debt of the Guarantor  and of each of its  Restricted
Subsidiaries, plus the aggregate amount of Consolidated Lease Rentals (excluding
Consolidated  Lease Rentals under Leases in effect as of December 31, 2001,  and
any  renewal,  extension  or  replacement  thereof,  and Leases with  respect to
property not owned by the  Guarantor on such date),  discounted to present value
at 10%, compounded annually,  arising out of all Sale and Leaseback Transactions
to which the Guarantor or any of its  Restricted  Subsidiaries  is then a party,
does not exceed 10% of  Consolidated  Net Worth;  provided,  however,  that this
Section  7.03(i)  shall not apply to, and there shall be excluded  from  secured
Debt in any computation under this Section 7.03(i), Debt secured by
     (A)  Encumbrances  existing on the  Closing  Date and set forth on Schedule
7.03(i);


     (B) Encumbrances for taxes,  assessments and other governmental  charges or
levies not yet due or as to which the period of grace,  if any,  related thereto
has not expired or which are being  contested  in good faith and by  appropriate
proceedings if adequate reserves are maintained to the extent required by GAAP;

     (C)  The  claims  of  materialmen,   mechanics,   carriers,   warehousemen,
processors or landlords for labor,  materials,  supplies or rentals  incurred in
the ordinary course of business,  (i) which are not overdue for a period of more
than 30 days or (ii) which are being  contested in good faith and by appropriate
proceedings if adequate reserves are maintained to the extent required by GAAP;

     (D)  Encumbrances  consisting  of deposits or pledges  made in the ordinary
course of business (i) in connection with, or to secure payment of,  obligations
under workers'  compensation,  unemployment  insurance or similar legislation or
obligations  under customer service  contracts,  or (ii) to secure (or to obtain
letters  of  credit  that  secure)  the   performance   of  tenders,   statutory
obligations,  surety  bonds,  appeal  bonds,  bids,  leases  (other than Capital
Leases), performance bonds, purchase,  construction or sales contracts and other
similar  obligations,  in each case not incurred or made in connection  with the
borrowing  of money,  the  obtaining of advances or credit or the payment of the
deferred purchase price of property;


<PAGE>

     (E)  Encumbrances   constituting  encumbrances  in  the  nature  of  zoning
restrictions,  easements and rights or restrictions of record on the use of real
property, which in the aggregate are not substantial in amount and which do not,
in any case,  detract from the value of any material  parcel of real property or
impair the use thereof in the ordinary conduct of business;

     (F) Encumbrances in favor of the Bank;

     (G)  Encumbrances  on the property or assets of any  Restricted  Subsidiary
existing at the time such  Restricted  Subsidiary  becomes a  Subsidiary  of the
Guarantor and not incurred in contemplation  thereof, as long as the outstanding
principal  amount of the Debt secured  thereby is not  voluntarily  increased by
such Restricted  Subsidiary after the date such Restricted  Subsidiary becomes a
Subsidiary of the
                           Guarantor;

     (H)  Encumbrances  on  the  property  or  assets  of the  Borrowers  or the
Guarantor  or any  Restricted  Subsidiary  securing  Debt which is  incurred  to
finance the acquisition of such property or assets,  provided that (i) each such
Encumbrance shall be created simultaneously with, or within twelve months after,
the acquisition of the related  property or assets;  (ii) each such  Encumbrance
does not at any time  encumber any property  other than the related  property or
assets financed by such Debt; (iii) the principal amount of Debt secured by each
such Encumbrance is not increased; and (iv) the principal amount of Debt secured
by each such Encumbrance  shall at no time exceed 100% of the original  purchase
price of such related property or assets at the time acquired;

     (I)   Encumbrances   consisting   of  judgment   or   judicial   attachment
Encumbrances,  provided that (i) the claims giving rise to such Encumbrances are
being  diligently  contested  in good  faith by  appropriate  proceedings,  (ii)
adequate  reserves for the obligations  secured by such  Encumbrances  have been
established and (iii) enforcement of such Encumbrances has been stayed;

     (J)  Encumbrances  created or deemed to exist in connection  with any asset
securitization   program   (including  any  related  filings  of  any  financing
statements),  but only to the extent that such Encumbrances attach to the assets
actually  sold,  contributed,  financed  or  otherwise  conveyed  or  pledged in
connection with such securitization program;

     (K) Encumbrances on property or assets of the Borrowers or the Guarantor or
any Restricted  Subsidiary  securing  indebtedness owing to the Borrowers or the
Guarantor;


<PAGE>

     (L)  Encumbrances  on  coal  reserves  leased  by the  Guarantor  or by any
Restricted Subsidiary as lessee,  securing Debt to the lessors thereof,  arising
out of such leases;

     (M)  Encumbrances on any Margin Stock purchased or carried by the Guarantor
or any of its Subsidiaries; and

     (N) The extension,  renewal or replacement of any Encumbrance  permitted by
clauses (A), (G), (H) or (L), but only if the  principal  amount of Debt secured
by  the  Encumbrance   immediately  prior  thereto  is  not  increased  and  the
Encumbrance is not extended to other property.

     For purposes of this Section  7.03(i),  property of a  corporation  when it
becomes a successor or transferee  of the  Guarantor or a Restricted  Subsidiary
shall be deemed to have been acquired at that time and any Encumbrance  existing
on property when acquired shall be deemed to have been created at that time. The
sale or transfer of (A) coal,  oil, gas or other  minerals in place for a period
of time until, or in an amount such that, the transferee will realize  therefrom
a specified  amount of money (however  determined) or a specified amount of such
coal or other  minerals or (B) any other  interest in property of the  character
commonly referred to as a "production payment" shall not be deemed to constitute
Debt secured by an  Encumbrance.  In the event that any Borrower shall hereafter
be required to secure its payment obligations hereunder,  or the Guarantor shall
hereafter  be  required to secure its payment  obligations  under the  Guaranty,
equally and ratably with any other Debt pursuant to this Section  7.03(i),  then
(X) such Borrower,  or the Guarantor,  as the case may be, will promptly deliver
to the Bank a certificate of its Responsible Officer stating that the provisions
of this  Section  7.03(i)  have been  complied  with and an  opinion  of counsel
satisfactory  to the Bank to the  effect  that the  provisions  of this  Section
7.03(i) have been complied with and all  instruments  executed by such Person in
the  performance of the  requirements  of this Section  7.03(i) comply with such
requirements  and have been duly executed and  delivered and are valid,  binding
and  enforceable  and (Y) the Borrowers  and the  Guarantor  shall enter into an
agreement  supplemental  hereto, and the Guarantor shall enter into an agreement
supplemental  to the Guaranty,  and the  Borrowers and the Guarantor  shall take
such other reasonable action, if any, as the Bank deems advisable, to enable the
Bank, as so secured, to enforce its rights hereunder and under the Guaranty.

     (ii) Disposition of Debt and Shares of Restricted Subsidiaries; Issuance of
Shares by  Restricted  Subsidiaries;  Consolidation,  Merger or  Disposition  of
Assets.  None of the  Borrowers  nor the  Guarantor  will (a) sell or  otherwise
dispose of any shares or any Long Term Debt of any Restricted Subsidiary,  other
than the sale of Capital Stock of the Pittston Minerals Group,  Inc., and any of
its Subsidiaries,  (b) in the case of any Restricted Subsidiary,  issue, sell or
otherwise  dispose of any of such  Restricted  Subsidiary's  shares  (other than
directors' qualifying shares, to satisfy preemptive rights or in connection with
a split or  combination  of  shares  or a  dividend  in  shares)  except  to the
Guarantor  or another  Restricted  Subsidiary  or (c)  directly  or  indirectly,
consolidate  with or merge with or into or sell,  lease or otherwise  dispose of
all or  substantially  all of its assets  (other than in the ordinary  course of
business and the sale of all or any part of the assets of the Pittston  Minerals
Group,  Inc., and any of its  Subsidiaries)  to any Person unless,  after giving
effect thereto, all of the following conditions shall be met:
<PAGE>

     (w) the Leverage Ratio shall not be greater than 0.55:1.00;

     (x) in the  case  of a  consolidation  or  merger  of  the  Guarantor,  the
Guarantor  shall be the  surviving  corporation,  and,  in the case of a sale or
other  disposition of the Guarantor's  assets as an entirety or substantially as
an entirety to any corporation,  the successor or surviving corporation shall be
a solvent  corporation  organized under the laws of a state of the United States
of America which expressly  assumes in writing the due and punctual  payment and
performance of the obligations of the Guarantor under the Guaranty;

     (y) if any properties or assets of the Guarantor or a Restricted Subsidiary
would thereupon  become subject to an Encumbrance  other than those described in
Section  7.03(i)(A)  through (N),  inclusive,  the  obligations of the Guarantor
under the Guaranty  hereunder  shall have been equally and ratably  secured with
(or, at the option of the  Guarantor,  in priority  to) any Debt  secured by the
Encumbrance  on such  properties  and assets,  and the last paragraph of Section
7.03(i) shall be applicable thereto; and

     (z) no Default or Event of Default has occurred and is continuing.

     Provided that the conditions of this Section  7.03(ii) are met, none of the
foregoing shall be deemed to prohibit the Guarantor and/or its Subsidiaries from
selling, transferring, assigning or otherwise disposing of Margin Stock for fair
market  value or selling,  contributing,  financing  or  otherwise  conveying or
pledging assets in connection with any asset securitization program permitted by
Section 7.03(i)(J).

     (iii)  Transactions  with  Affiliates.  Engage in any transaction  with any
Person that any Borrower or the Guarantor Controls, is Controlled by or is under
common  Control  with (other  than a Borrower,  the  Guarantor  or a  Restricted
Subsidiary) material to any Borrower or the Guarantor on terms more favorable to
such affiliated Person than would have been obtainable in arm's-length dealing.
<PAGE>

     (iv) Interest  Coverage Ratio.  Permit the Interest Coverage Ratio for each
fiscal quarter of the Guarantor, to be calculated as at the end of such quarter,
to be less than 3.00:1.00.

     (v) Leverage  Ratio.  Permit the Leverage  Ratio as of the last day of each
fiscal quarter of the Guarantor to be greater than 0.55:1.00.

     (vi) Compliance  with  Regulations T, U and X. Purchase or carry any Margin
Stock or incur,  create or assume any  obligation  for  borrowed  money or other
liability  or make  any  investment,  capital  contribution,  loan,  advance  or
extension  of  credit  or sell or  otherwise  dispose  of any  assets or pay any
dividend or make any other distribution to its shareholders or take or permit to
be taken any other  action or permit to occur or exist any event or condition if
such action,  event or condition would result in this  Agreement,  the Advances,
the use of the proceeds thereof or the other  transactions  contemplated  hereby
violating or being  inconsistent  with  Regulations T, U or X promulgated by the
Federal Reserve Board, including, Section 221.3(f) of said Regulation U.

     (vii) Hedging  Agreements.  Enter into material Hedging  Agreements for the
purpose of speculation and not for the purpose of hedging risks  associated with
the  businesses  of the  Guarantor,  the  Borrowers  and the  Guarantor's  other
Subsidiaries.

     (viii) ERISA.

(A)                        Terminate any Plan under circumstances which would
                           reasonably result in a material liability of the
                           Guarantor, any Borrower or any ERISA Affiliate to the
                           PBGC, or permit to exist the occurrence of any
                           Reportable Event or any other event or condition
                           which presents a material risk of such a termination
                           by the PBGC;

(B)                        engage, or permit any Plan to engage, in a
                           "prohibited transaction" (within the meaning of
                           Section 406 of ERISA or Section 4975 of the Code)
                           that would reasonably result in material liability of
                           the Guarantor, any Borrower or any of the Guarantor's
                           other Restricted Subsidiaries;

(C)                        fail to make any contribution to a Multiemployer Plan
                           which is required by ERISA or an applicable
                           collective bargaining agreement in an amount which is
                           material (except to the extent there is a good faith
                           dispute as to whether any contribution is owed, the
                           amount owed or the existence of facts that would give
                           rise to a withdrawal);

(D)                        completely or partially withdraw from a Multiemployer
                           Plan, if such complete or partial withdrawal would
                           result in any material withdrawal liability under
                           Title IV of ERISA; or
<PAGE>

(E)                        enter into any new Plan or modify any existing Plan
                           so as to increase its obligations thereunder which
                           could result in any material liability to the
                           Guarantor or any ERISA Affiliate.

                  For purposes of this Section 7.03(viii), an amount is material
                  if it would have a Material Adverse Effect, and the
                  materiality of any amount described in this Section 7.03(viii)
                  shall be determined after aggregation with all other
                  liabilities described in this Section 7.03(viii).

7.04 REPORTING REQUIREMENTS OF THE GUARANTOR. For the benefit of the Bank and
all Lending Offices, so long as any Advance remains outstanding hereunder or the
Commitment remains in effect, the Guarantor will, unless the Bank otherwise
consents in writing:

(i)      furnish to the Bank:

     (1) annually, as soon as available,  but in any event within 120 days after
the last  day of each of the  Guarantor's  fiscal  years,  consolidated  balance
sheets of the Guarantor and its  Subsidiaries  as at the last day of such fiscal
year,  and the related  consolidated  statements  of  operations,  shareholders'
equity  and cash  flows  for the  fiscal  year  then  ended,  each  prepared  in
accordance  with  GAAP,  in  reasonable   detail,  and  each  setting  forth  in
comparative  form  corresponding  figures from the  preceding  annual  financial
statements,  certified by independent certified public accountants of recognized
national standing as fairly presenting in all material respects the consolidated
financial  condition  and results of  operations  for the subject  companies and
whose opinion shall not be qualified with respect to scope  limitations  imposed
by the  Guarantor  or any  Subsidiary,  the  status  of the  Guarantor  and  its
Subsidiaries  as a going concern or the  accounting  principles  followed by the
Guarantor or any Subsidiary not in accordance with GAAP;

     (2) as soon as available,  but in any event within 60 days after the end of
each of the first three fiscal quarters of each of the Guarantor's fiscal years,
consolidated  balance  sheets as at the last day of such quarter and the related
consolidated statements of operations and cash flows for the quarter then ended,
and for the  then-current  fiscal year through the end of such quarter,  for the
Guarantor and its  Subsidiaries,  in each case prepared in accordance  with GAAP
(except for omission of notes and subject to year-end  adjustments)  and setting
forth in  comparative  form  figures for the  corresponding  period in the prior
fiscal  year,  certified  by a  Responsible  Officer of the  Guarantor as fairly
presenting in all material  respects the  consolidated  financial  condition and
results of operations for the subject companies;
<PAGE>

     (3) at the same time as it delivers the financial statements required under
the  provisions  of clause  (1) above,  a  certificate  signed by a  Responsible
Officer of the  Guarantor  to the effect that such  Officer has made due inquiry
and that to the best of the knowledge of such Officer  except as stated  therein
no Default or Event of Default has occurred  hereunder and that such officer has
made due inquiry and that to the best of the knowledge of such Officer except as
stated  therein no default has occurred  under any other  agreement to which the
Guarantor or any Borrower is a party or by which it is bound, or by which any of
its  properties or assets may be affected,  which could have a Material  Adverse
Effect and  specifying  in  reasonable  detail the  exceptions,  if any, to such
statements;

     (4) at the same time as it delivers the financial statements required under
the  provisions  of clauses  (1) and (2) above,  a  statement  of a  Responsible
Officer of the Guarantor  showing the Leverage Ratio and Interest Coverage Ratio
as of the last day of the  fiscal  period  to which  such  financial  statements
relate;

     (5) at the same time as it delivers the financial statements required under
the  provisions  of clause  (2) above,  a  certificate  signed by a  Responsible
Officer of the  Guarantor and stating that such Officer has made due inquiry and
that to the best of his knowledge no Default has occurred and is continuing, or,
if such Default has occurred  and is  continuing,  specify the nature and extent
thereof; and

     (6) forthwith  upon the  occurrence  of any Default or Event of Default,  a
certificate of a Responsible  Officer of the Guarantor setting forth the details
thereof and the action which the Guarantor or the Borrower,  as the case may be,
is taking or proposes to take with respect thereto;

(ii)              furnish to the Bank, promptly after the same are available,
                  copies of all current reports on Form 8-K, quarterly reports
                  on Form 10-Q, annual reports on Form 10-K (or similar
                  corresponding reports) and registration statements or
                  statements which the Guarantor or any Restricted Subsidiary
                  may be required to file with the Securities and Exchange
                  Commission (excluding registration statements filed pursuant
                  to employee stock option or benefit plans);

(iii)             furnish to the Bank, as soon as reasonably practicable after
                  receipt by the Guarantor or any of its Subsidiaries, a copy of
                  any written notice or claim to the effect that the Guarantor
                  or any of its Subsidiaries is liable to any Person as a result
                  of the presence or release of any Contaminant which claim
                  could reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse
                  Effect; and

(iv)              within three (3) Business Days after the Guarantor receives
                  notice of any change in the Applicable LT Rating, furnish
                  written notice of such change and the new Applicable LT Rating
                  to the Bank.
<PAGE>

7.05 ADDITIONAL REQUIREMENTS OF THE GUARANTOR AND THE BORROWERS. For the benefit
of the Bank and all Lending Offices, so long as any Advance remains outstanding
hereunder or the Commitment remains in effect, the Guarantor and each Borrower
will, unless the Bank otherwise consents in writing:

(i)               keep proper books of record and accounts in which full, true
                  and correct entries in accordance with GAAP shall be made of
                  all dealings or transactions in relation to its business and
                  activities; and

(ii)              furnish with reasonable promptness such other financial
                  information as the Bank may reasonably request, provided that
                  no Borrower, nor the Guarantor, shall be required to furnish
                  any information that would result in violation of any
                  confidentiality agreement by which it is bound but, at the
                  request of the Bank, shall use its reasonable best efforts to
                  obtain a waiver of such agreement to permit furnishing of such
                  information under this provision.

                                  ARTICLE VIII
                                EVENTS OF DEFAULT

8.0      EVENT OF DEFAULT.  Any of the following shall constitute an .
         "Event of Default":


     (a)  Non-Payment.  Any Borrower fails to pay (i) when and as required to be
paid  herein,  any  amount  of  principal  of  any  Loan  or  any  Reimbursement
Obligation,  or (ii) within three (3) business  days after the same shall become
due, any interest,  fee or any other amount payable hereunder or pursuant to any
other Loan Document to which such Borrower is a party;

     (b) Breach of Representation or Warranty. Any representation or warranty by
any  Borrower or the  Guarantor  made or deemed made herein or in any other Loan
Document,  or which is  contained in any  certificate,  document or financial or
other  statement  by  any  Borrower  or  the  Guarantor,   or  their  respective
Responsible Officers, furnished at any time under this Agreement, or in or under
any other Loan  Document,  shall prove to have been  incorrect  in any  material
respect  on or as of  the  date  made  or  deemed  made;  provided  that  if the
representation  or  warranty  contained  in Section  6.16 or any  representation
 or warranty  contained in any financial  statement  furnished under
this Agreement  shall prove to be incorrect in any material  respect on or as of
the date when  made,  such  breach  shall not  constitute  a Default or Event of
Default unless the Guarantor  fails to correct such default  (including  without
limitation  publicly  correcting any related  material  misstatement  of fact or
disclosing any material omitted fact) within 90 days after a Responsible Officer
obtains actual knowledge of such default;
<PAGE>

     (c) Default in Performance of Certain Covenants.  Any Borrower or Guarantor
fails to perform or observe  any  covenant  or  agreement  contained  in Section
7.03(iv),  (v) or (vi), and such default shall continue  unremedied for a period
of 10 days after the earlier of (i) the date upon which a Responsible Officer of
such Borrower or the Guarantor  gives written notice of such failure to the Bank
or (ii) the date upon which written  notice thereof is given to such Borrower or
the Guarantor by the Bank;

     (d) Other  Defaults.  Any  Borrower  or the  Guarantor  fails to perform or
observe any other term or covenant contained in this Agreement or any other Loan
Document,  and such default shall  continue  unremedied  for a period of 30 days
after the  earlier  of (i) the date upon  which a  Responsible  Officer  of such
Borrower or the Guarantor  gives  written  notice of such failure to the Bank or
(ii) the date upon which written notice thereof is given to such Borrower or the
Guarantor by the Bank;

     (e) Insolvency;  Voluntary  Proceedings.  The Guarantor or any Borrower (i)
ceases or fails to be solvent,  or generally  fails to pay, or admits in writing
its inability to pay, its debts as they become due,  subject to applicable grace
periods,  if any,  whether at stated  maturity or  otherwise;  (ii)  voluntarily
ceases operations as a going concern;  (iii) commences any Insolvency Proceeding
with respect to itself;  or (iv) takes any action to effectuate or authorize any
of the foregoing;

     (f) Involuntary Proceedings.


     (i) Any involuntary Insolvency Proceeding is commenced or filed against the
Guarantor  or any  Borrower,  or any  writ,  judgment,  warrant  of  attachment,
execution or similar process,  is issued or levied against a substantial part of
the  property  of  the  Guarantor,  any  Borrower  or any  of  their  respective
Subsidiaries,  and any such  proceeding or petition  shall not be dismissed,  or
such writ, judgment,  warrant of attachment,  execution or similar process shall
not be  released,  vacated or fully  bonded  within 60 days after  commencement,
filing or levy;

     (ii) the Guarantor,  any Borrower or any of their  respective  Subsidiaries
admits  the  material  allegations  of a petition  against it in any  Insolvency
Proceeding,  or an order for  relief  (or  similar  order  under the laws of any
jurisdiction other than the United States of America or a political  subdivision
thereof) is ordered in any Insolvency Proceeding; or

     (iii) the Guarantor,  any Borrower or any of their respective  Subsidiaries
acquiesces in the appointment of a receiver,  trustee,  custodian,  conservator,
liquidator, mortgagee in possession (or agent therefor), or other similar Person
for itself or a substantial portion of its property or business;
<PAGE>

(g)      Monetary Judgments. One or more final (non-interlocutory) and
         nonappealable judgments, orders or decrees shall be entered against any
         Borrower, the Guarantor or any of their respective Subsidiaries
         involving in the aggregate a liability (not fully covered by insurance)
         as to any single or related series of transactions, incidents or
         conditions that have a reasonable likelihood of having a Material
         Adverse Effect (which, solely for the purposes hereof, shall be deemed
         to mean at least $25,000,000) and the same shall remain undischarged,
         unvacated and unstayed pending appeal for a period of 60 days after the
         entry thereof;

(h)      Guarantor Defaults. The Guarantor shall fail in any material respect to
         perform or observe any term, covenant or agreement herein or in the
         Guaranty; or the Guaranty shall for any reason be partially (including
         with respect to future advances) or wholly revoked or invalidated, or
         otherwise cease to be in full force and effect, or the Guarantor or any
         other Person shall contest in any manner the validity or enforceability
         thereof or deny that it has any further liability or obligation
         thereunder;

(i)      Guarantor Cross-Acceleration. There shall be any default under any
         agreement or instrument evidencing or securing Debt of any Borrower or
         the Guarantor (including, without limitation, Debt incurred under the
         Guarantor Credit Agreement), if the effect of such default is to permit
         the holder or holders of such Debt (or a trustee on its or their
         behalf) to cause, and such holder or holders (or trustee) do cause,
         such Debt to become due prior to its stated maturity, and the aggregate
         amount of such Debt so accelerated equals or exceeds $25,000,000 (or
         the equivalent thereof);

(j)      Payment Cross-Defaults. Any Borrower or the Guarantor shall default in
         the payment when due, after giving effect to any grace period permitted
         from time to time, of any Debt (including, without limitation, Debt
         incurred under the Guarantor Credit Agreement) and the aggregate amount
         of such Debt is at least $25,000,000 (or the equivalent thereof);

(k)      Change in Control.  A Change in Control shall occur; or

(l)      Material Adverse Effect.  The occurrence of any  circumstance,
         development,  event or condition which has a Material Adverse Effect.

8.02     REMEDIES.  If any Event of Default occurs, the Bank may:


(a)      declare the Commitment to be terminated, whereupon the Commitment shall
         forthwith be terminated;

(b)      declare the unpaid principal amount of all outstanding Loans, all
         interest accrued and unpaid thereon, and all other amounts owing or
         payable hereunder (including all Reimbursement Obligations) or under
         any other Loan Document to be immediately due and payable; without
         presentment, demand, protest or other notice of any kind, all of which
         are hereby expressly waived by the Borrowers;

(c)      exercise all rights and remedies available to it under the Loan
         Documents or applicable law; and

(d)      require the Borrowers to pay to the Bank in immediately available
         funds, in the respective currencies of the applicable Obligations, an
         amount equal to the maximum amount then available to be drawn under all
         Letters of Credit then outstanding, for deposit in a cash collateral
         account maintained by the Bank, as security for the Letters of Credit
         then outstanding,

provided, however, that upon the occurrence of any event specified in Section
8.01(e) or Section 8.01(f) (in the case of Section 8.01(f)(i), upon the
expiration of the 60-day period mentioned therein), the Commitment shall
automatically terminate and the unpaid principal amount of all outstanding
Loans, Reimbursement Obligations and all interest and other amounts as aforesaid
shall automatically become due and payable without further act of the Bank.
<PAGE>

8.03 RIGHTS NOT EXCLUSIVE. The rights provided for in this Agreement and the
other Loan Documents are cumulative and are not exclusive of any other rights,
powers, privileges or remedies provided by law or in equity, or under any other
instrument, document or agreement now existing or hereafter arising.

                                   ARTICLE IX
                                  MISCELLANEOUS

9.01 AMENDMENTS AND WAIVERS. No amendment or waiver of any provision of this
Agreement or any other Loan Document to which any Borrower or the Guarantor is
party, and no consent with respect to any departure by any Borrower or the
Guarantor therefrom, shall be effective unless the same shall be in writing and
signed by the Bank, the Borrowers party thereto and the Guarantor, if party
thereto, and then such waiver shall be effective only in the specific instance
and for the specific purpose for which given.

9.02     NOTICES.
         -------

     (a) All notices,  requests and other communications  provided for hereunder
shall be in writing (including, unless the context expressly otherwise provides,
telex or fax) and mailed, sent by overnight delivery service,  telexed or faxed,
to the address or number specified for notices to the applicable party set forth
on Schedule 9.02 (or, in the case of a Covered Subsidiary, the address specified
for notices in its Election to Participate  delivered under Section 5.03(a)); or
to such other address as shall be  designated by such party in a written  notice
to the other parties.

     (b) All  such  notices,  requests  and  other  communications  shall,  when
transmitted by overnight  delivery  service,  telex or fax, be effective the day
after  delivered to the  overnight  delivery  service,  when  confirmed by telex
answerback or when  transmitted  by fax with machine  transmittal  confirmation,
respectively,  or, if  transmitted by mail,  upon delivery,  except that notices
pursuant  to Article II or Article  III shall not be  effective  until  actually
received by the Bank.

     (c) The  Borrowers  acknowledge  and agree  that the  Bank's  agreement  to
receive  notices,  requests  and other  communications  by fax is solely for the
convenience  and at the request of the Borrowers.  The Bank shall be entitled to
rely on the authority of any Person  purporting to be a Person authorized by the
applicable  Borrower to give such communications and the Bank shall not have any
liability  to any Borrower or other Person on account of any action taken or not
taken by the Bank in reliance upon such fax communication. The obligation of the
Borrowers  to repay the  Obligations  shall not be affected in any way or to any
extent by any  failure by the Bank to receive  written  confirmation  of any fax
communication  or by the  receipt  by the  Bank of a  confirmation  which  is at
variance  with  the  terms  understood  by the Bank to be  contained  in the fax
communication.

9.03 NO WAIVER; CUMULATIVE REMEDIES. No failure to exercise and no delay in
exercising, on the part of the Bank, any right, remedy, power or privilege
hereunder, shall operate as a waiver thereof; nor shall any single or partial
exercise of any right, remedy, power or privilege hereunder preclude any other
or further exercise thereof or the exercise of any other right, remedy, power or
privilege.

9.04     COSTS AND EXPENSES.  The Borrowers  shall,  whether or not the
transactions  contemplated  hereby shall be consummated:

(a)      pay or reimburse the Bank within five Business Days after demand (or on
         the Effective Date to the extent provided in Section 5.01(g)) for all
         reasonable costs and expenses incurred by the Bank in connection with
         the delivery and administration of, and any amendment, supplement,
         waiver or modification to, this Agreement, any other Loan Document and
         any other documents prepared in connection herewith or therewith, and
         the consummation of the transactions contemplated hereby and thereby,
         including reasonable counsel fees, incurred by the Bank with respect
         thereto; and

(b)      pay or reimburse the Bank within five Business Days after demand for
         all reasonable costs and expenses incurred by it in connection with the
         enforcement, attempted enforcement, or preservation of any rights or
         remedies (including in connection with any "workout" or restructuring
         regarding the Obligations) under this Agreement or any other Loan
         Document, including reasonable counsel fees (including the allocated
         cost of staff counsel) incurred by the Bank.

     9.05 INDEMNITIES. Whether or not the transactions contemplated hereby shall
be consummated:(a) The Borrowers shall pay, indemnify, and hold the
Bank  and  each of its  officers,  directors,  employees,  counsel,  agents  and
attorneys-in-fact  (each, an "Indemnified Person") harmless from and against any
and  all  liabilities,   obligations,   losses,  damages,  penalties,   actions,
judgments,   suits,  costs,  charges,   expenses  or  disbursements   (including
reasonable  counsel fees,  including the allocated cost of staff counsel) of any
kind or nature whatsoever with respect to the execution, delivery,  enforcement,
performance and administration of this Agreement and any other Loan Document, or
the  transactions  contemplated  hereby  and  thereby,  and with  respect to any
investigation,  litigation or proceeding related to this Agreement, the Loans or
the Letters of Credit,  or the use of the proceeds  thereof,  whether or not any
Indemnified  Person is a party  thereto (all the  foregoing,  collectively,  the
"Indemnified  Liabilities");  provided,  no Borrower  shall have any  obligation
hereunder  to any  Indemnified  Person with respect to  Indemnified  Liabilities
arising from the breach of this Agreement by or the gross  negligence or willful
misconduct of such Indemnified Person.

     (b) The obligations in this Section 9.05 shall survive payment of all other
Obligations.  At the  election of the  Borrowers,  one or more  Borrowers  shall
defend  such  Indemnified  Person  using  legal  counsel  satisfactory  to  such
Indemnified  Person  in such  Person's  sole  discretion,  at the sole  cost and
expense of the  Borrowers;  provided,  further  that no Borrower  may settle any
Indemnified  Liability  without the Bank's  consent  (which consent shall not be
unreasonably  withheld or  delayed).  All amounts  owing under this Section 9.05
shall be paid within 30 days after demand.
<PAGE>

     (c) If any sum due from a Borrower  under this  Agreement  or another  Loan
Document  or under any order or  judgment  given or made in  relation  hereto or
thereto has to be converted  from the currency  (the "first  currency") in which
the same is payable hereunder or thereunder or under such order or judgment into
another currency (the "second currency") for the purpose of (i) making or filing
a claim or proof against such Borrower with any Governmental Authority or in any
court or  tribunal  or (ii)  enforcing  any order or  judgment  given or made in
relation  hereto,  such Borrower  shall  indemnify and hold harmless each of the
Persons to whom such sum is due from and against any loss actually suffered as a
result of any  discrepancy  between (a) the rate of exchange used to convert the
amount in question from the first currency into the second  currency and (b) the
rate or rates of  exchange  at which  such  Person,  acting  in good  faith in a
commercially  reasonable  manner,  purchased the first  currency with the second
currency  after  receipt  of a  sum  paid  to  it  in  the  second  currency  in
satisfaction,  in whole or in part, of any such order, judgment, claim or proof.
The foregoing  indemnity shall constitute a separate obligation of each Borrower
distinct  from its other  obligations  hereunder and shall survive the giving or
making  of any  judgment  or  order  in  relation  to all or any of  such  other
obligations.

9.06 SUCCESSORS AND ASSIGNS. The provisions of this Agreement shall be binding
upon and inure to the benefit of the parties hereto and their respective
successors and assigns, except that no Borrower nor the Guarantor may assign or
transfer any of its rights or obligations under this Agreement without the prior
written consent of the Bank and any assignment by the Bank must be in compliance
with Section 9.07.

9.07 ASSIGNMENTS AND PARTICIPATIONS. The Bank, with the prior written consent of
the Guarantor, which consent shall not be unreasonably withheld or delayed, may
at any time assign and delegate to one or more Persons (each an "Assignee") all,
or any ratable part of all, of the Advances, the Commitment and the other rights
and obligations of the Bank hereunder; provided, however, that no consent shall
be required for an assignment (i) to an affiliate of the Bank or any approved
Assignee or (ii) during the existence of an Event of Default under Section
8.01(a), (f) or (g); and provided further, that the Borrowers may continue to
deal solely and directly with the Bank in connection with the interest so
assigned to an Assignee until written notice of such assignment, together with
payment instructions, addresses and related information with respect to the
Assignee, shall have been given to the Borrowers by the Bank and the Assignee.
The Bank and any Assignee may, without the consent of the Guarantor or any Bank,
sell participations to one or more banks or other entities (a "Participant") in
all or a portion of the Bank's or Assignee's rights and obligations under this
Agreement (including all or a portion of the Commitment and the Advances owing
to it); provided that (i) the Bank's or Assignee's obligations (including,
without limitation, the Commitment) under this Agreement shall remain unchanged,
(ii) the Bank or Assignee shall remain solely responsible to the other parties
hereto for the performance of such obligations and (iii) the Borrowers and the
Guarantor shall continue to deal solely and directly with the Bank or Assignee
in connection with the Bank's or Assignee's rights and obligations under this
Agreement. Any agreement pursuant to which the Bank or an Assignee sells such a
participation shall provide that the Bank or such Assignee shall retain the sole
right to enforce this Agreement and to approve any amendment, modification or
waiver of any provision of this Agreement. Subject to the next sentence of this
Section, the Guarantor and the Borrowers agree that each Participant shall be
entitled to the benefits and subject to the requirements of Article IV and
Sections 9.04 and 9.05 to the same extent as if it were the Bank or an Assignee
and had acquired its interest by assignment pursuant to this Section. No
Participant shall be entitled to receive any greater payment under Article IV or
Section 9.04 or 9.05 than the Bank or applicable Assignee would have been
entitled to receive with respect to the participation sold to such Participant,
unless the Guarantor specifically consents to such right.
<PAGE>

9.08 CONFIDENTIALITY. The Bank agrees to take normal and reasonable precautions
and exercise due care to maintain the confidentiality of all non-public
information provided to it by the Guarantor, any Borrower or any of their
respective Subsidiaries, in connection with this Agreement or any other Loan
Document, and neither it nor any of its Affiliates shall use any such
information for any purpose or in any manner other than pursuant to the terms
contemplated by this Agreement, except to the extent such information (i) was or
becomes generally available to the public other than as a result of a disclosure
by the Bank, or (ii) was or becomes available on a non-confidential basis from a
source other than the Guarantor or a Borrower, provided that such source is not
bound by a confidentiality agreement with the Guarantor or such Borrower to the
knowledge of the Bank; provided further, however that the Bank may disclose such
information (A) at the request or pursuant to any requirement of any
Governmental Authority to which the Bank is subject or in connection with an
examination of the Bank by any such authority; (B) pursuant to subpoena or other
court process; (C) when required to do so in accordance with the provisions of
any applicable Requirement of Law; and (D) to the Bank's independent auditors
and other professional advisors. Notwithstanding the foregoing, the Borrowers
and the Guarantor authorize the Bank to disclose to any Assignee, and to any
prospective Assignee, such financial and other information in the Bank's
possession concerning the Guarantor, the Borrowers or their respective
Subsidiaries which has been delivered to the Bank pursuant to this Agreement or
which has been delivered to the Bank by the Guarantor, a Borrower, or any of
their respective Subsidiaries in connection with the Bank's credit evaluation of
the Guarantor and the Borrowers prior to entering into, or upon review or
renewal of, this Agreement; provided that, unless otherwise agreed by the
Guarantor and the Borrowers, such Assignee or prospective Assignee agrees in
writing to the Bank to keep such information confidential to the same extent
required of the Bank hereunder.

9.09 COUNTERPARTS. This Agreement may be executed by one or more of the parties
to this Agreement in any number of separate counterparts, each of which, when so
executed, shall be deemed an original, and all of said counterparts taken
together shall be deemed to constitute but one and the same instrument.

9.10 SEVERABILITY. The illegality or unenforceability of any provision of this
Agreement or any instrument or agreement required hereunder shall not in any way
affect or impair the legality or enforceability of the remaining provisions of
this Agreement or any instrument or agreement required hereunder.
<PAGE>

9.11     GOVERNING LAW AND JURISDICTION.
         ------------------------------

     (a) THIS AGREEMENT SHALL BE GOVERNED BY, AND CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE  WITH,
THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW  YORK;  PROVIDED  THAT THE BANK  SHALL  RETAIN  ALL
RIGHTS ARISING UNDER FEDERAL LAW.

     (b) ANY LEGAL ACTION OR  PROCEEDING  WITH RESPECT TO THIS  AGREEMENT MAY BE
BROUGHT IN THE  COURTS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK OR OF THE UNITED  STATES FOR THE
SOUTHERN DISTRICT OF NEW YORK, AND, BY EXECUTION AND DELIVERY OF THIS AGREEMENT,
EACH OF THE PARTIES HERETO CONSENTS,  FOR ITSELF AND IN RESPECT OF ITS PROPERTY,
TO THE IN PERSONAM  JURISDICTION  OF THOSE  COURTS.  EACH OF THE PARTIES  HERETO
IRREVOCABLY WAIVES ANY OBJECTION, INCLUDING ANY OBJECTION TO THE LAYING OF VENUE
OR BASED ON THE GROUNDS OF FORUM NON  CONVENIENS,  WHICH IT MAY NOW OR HEREAFTER
HAVE TO THE BRINGING OF ANY ACTION OR PROCEEDING IN SUCH JURISDICTION IN RESPECT
OF THIS  AGREEMENT OR ANY DOCUMENT  RELATED  HERETO.  EACH OF THE PARTIES HERETO
WAIVES PERSONAL SERVICE OF ANY SUMMONS, COMPLAINT OR OTHER PROCESS, WHICH MAY BE
MADE BY ANY OTHER MEANS  PERMITTED BY NEW YORK LAW OR BY REGISTERED OR CERTIFIED
MAIL TO SUCH PARTY'S ADDRESS FOR NOTICES PURSUANT TO SECTION 9.02.

9.12 WAIVER OF JURY TRIAL. EACH OF THE PARTIES HERETO WAIVES ITS RIGHTS TO A
TRIAL BY JURY OF ANY CLAIM OR CAUSE OF ACTION BASED UPON OR ARISING OUT OF OR
RELATED TO THIS AGREEMENT, THE OTHER LOAN DOCUMENTS, OR THE TRANSACTIONS
CONTEMPLATED HEREBY OR THEREBY, IN ANY ACTION, PROCEEDING OR OTHER LITIGATION OF
ANY TYPE BROUGHT BY ANY OF THE PARTIES AGAINST ANY OTHER PARTY OR PARTIES,
WHETHER WITH RESPECT TO CONTRACT CLAIMS, TORT CLAIMS, OR OTHERWISE. EACH OF THE
PARTIES HERETO AGREES THAT ANY SUCH CLAIM OR CAUSE OF ACTION SHALL BE TRIED BY A
COURT TRIAL WITHOUT A JURY. WITHOUT LIMITING THE FOREGOING, THE PARTIES FURTHER
AGREE THAT THEIR RESPECTIVE RIGHTS TO A TRIAL BY JURY ARE WAIVED BY OPERATION OF
THIS SECTION 9.12 AS TO ANY ACTION, COUNTERCLAIM OR OTHER PROCEEDING WHICH
SEEKS, IN WHOLE OR IN PART, TO CHALLENGE THE VALIDITY OR ENFORCEABILITY OF THIS
AGREEMENT OR THE OTHER LOAN DOCUMENTS OR ANY PROVISION HEREOF OR THEREOF. THIS
WAIVER SHALL APPLY TO ANY SUBSEQUENT AMENDMENTS, RENEWALS, SUPPLEMENTS OR
MODIFICATIONS TO THIS AGREEMENT AND THE OTHER LOAN DOCUMENTS.

9.13     INCONSISTENCIES  WITH OTHER  DOCUMENTS.  In the event there is a
conflict or  inconsistency  between  this Agreement and any other Loan Document,
the terms of this Agreement shall control.

9.14 ENTIRE AGREEMENT. This Agreement, together with the other Loan Documents,
embodies the entire agreement and understanding between the Borrowers, the
Guarantor and the Bank, and supersedes all prior or contemporaneous agreements
and understandings of such Persons, oral or written, relating to the subject
matter hereof and thereof.


<PAGE>


         IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have caused this Agreement to be
duly executed and delivered in New York by their proper and duly authorized
officers as of the day and year first above written.

                                    BORROWERS

                   BAX GLOBAL INC.


                   By:      /s/ James B. Hartough
                            -------------------------------------
                   Name:    James B. Hartough
                   Title:   Treasurer and Assistant Secretary


                   BRINK'S, INCORPORATED


                   By:      /s/ Michael T. Dan
                            -------------------------------------
                   Name:    Michael T. Dan
                   Title:   Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer


                   BRINK'S DEUTSCHLAND GMBH


                   By:      /s/ Joseph Eyal
                            -------------------------------------
                   Name:    Joseph Eyal
                   Title:   Managing Director


                   BRINK'S BETEILIGUNGSGESELLSCHAFT MBH

                   By:      /s/ Christopher Corrini
                            -----------------------------------
                   Name:    Christopher Corrini
                   Title:   Managing Director


                   BRINK'S DIAMOND & JEWELRY SERVICE NV

                   By:      /s/ Michael T. Dan
                            -------------------------------------
                   Name:    Michael T. Dan
                   Title:   Chairman and Director

<PAGE>


                   BRINK'S NEDERLAND B.V.

                   By:      /s/ Ian Sanders
                            -------------------------------------
                   Name:    Ian Sanders
                   Title:   Director


                   BRINK'S AUSTRALIA PTY LTD.


                   By:      /s/ Christopher Corrini
                            -----------------------------------
                   Name:    Christopher Corrini
                   Title:   Director


  GUARANTOR

                   THE PITTSTON COMPANY


                   By:      /s/ James B. Hartough
                            -------------------------------------
                   Name:    James B. Hartough
                   Title:   Vice President - Corporate Finance
                            and Treasurer


    BANK


                   BAYERISCHE HYPO- UND VEREINSBANK AG

                   By:      /s/ Ricarda Soltanmoradi
                            -----------------------------------
                   Name:    Ricarda Soltanmoradi
                   Title:   Managing Director


                   By:      /s/ Christina Winkler-Kruse
                            -------------------------------------
                   Name:    Christina Winkler-Kruse
                   Title:   Senior Credit Analyst



</TEXT>
</DOCUMENT>
<DOCUMENT>
<TYPE>EX-10
<SEQUENCE>4
<FILENAME>hypobankguaranty_nov12.txt
<DESCRIPTION>HYPO BANK GUARANTY
<TEXT>
                                    GUARANTY

GUARANTY, dated as of November 12, 2002 made by THE PITTSTON COMPANY, a Virginia
corporation (the "Guarantor"), in favor of BAYERISCHE HYPO- UND VEREINSBANK AG
(the "Bank"), and each Assignee under the Credit Agreement referred to below
(collectively, the "Lenders").

                              W I T N E S S E T H :

WHEREAS, the Bank is willing, subject to the conclusion of satisfactory
documentation and the satisfaction of other conditions, to extend credit, and to
facilitate the extension of credit by certain of the Bank's foreign lending
offices (as Lending Offices), from time to time to BAX Global Inc., a Delaware
corporation ("BAX") and Brink's, Incorporated, a Delaware corporation
("Brink's"), subsidiaries of the Guarantor, and to certain subsidiaries of BAX
and Brink's which are now or later become parties to the Credit Agreement dated
as of November 12, 2002, among BAX, BRINK'S, BRINK'S DEUTSCHLAND GMBH, a German
limited liability company, BRINK'S BETEILIGUNGSGESELLSCHAFT MBH, a German
limited liability company, BRINK'S DIAMOND & JEWELRY SERVICE NV, a Belgium
corporation, BRINK'S NEDERLAND B.V., a Dutch corporation, and BRINK'S AUSTRALIA
PTY LTD., an Australian corporation and the Covered Subsidiaries that become
parties thereto from time to time as Borrowers, the Guarantor, the Bank and the
other financial institutions that become parties from time to time thereto as
Assignees, as the same may be amended from time to time thereafter (the "Credit
Agreement"); and it is a condition precedent to the extension of credit from
time to time to the Borrowers under the Credit Agreement that the Guarantor
shall have executed and delivered and keep in full force and effect this
Guaranty.

NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the premises and to induce the Bank and its
Lending Offices to extend credit from time to time to the Borrowers under the
Credit Agreement, the Guarantor hereby agrees with the Bank as follows:

         1.       DEFINED TERMS.  Capitalized terms not otherwise defined herein
                  -------------
shall have the same meaning given to such terms in the Credit Agreement.

         2. GUARANTY. The Guarantor hereby unconditionally and irrevocably
guarantees to the Lenders the prompt and complete payment in full and
performance by the Borrowers when due (whether at the stated maturity, by
acceleration or otherwise) of the Obligations in the currency or currencies in
which the Obligations are denominated from time to time. The Guarantor further
agrees to pay any and all expenses, including, without limitation, all
reasonable fees and disbursements of counsel (including, without limitation,
allocated costs of staff counsel) which may be paid or incurred by the Lenders
in enforcing and preserving any of their respective rights under this Guaranty
and such as may be incurred by the Bank in connection with the preparation,
negotiation, execution, delivery and administration hereof. This Guaranty shall
remain in full force and effect until the Obligations are paid in full and the
Commitment is terminated, notwithstanding that from time to time prior thereto
any Borrowers may have been free from any Obligations.
<PAGE>

The Guarantor agrees that whenever, at any time, or from time to time, it shall
make any payment to the Bank or any Lending Office on account of its liability
hereunder, it will notify the Bank and such relevant Lending Office in writing
that such payment is made under this Guaranty for such purpose. No payment or
payments made by a Borrower or any other Person or received or collected by any
Lender from a Borrower or any other Person by virtue of any action or proceeding
or any set-off or appropriation or application, at any time or from time to
time, in reduction of or in payment of the Obligations shall be deemed to
modify, reduce, release or otherwise affect the liability of the Guarantor
hereunder which shall, notwithstanding any such payment or payments, remain
liable for the amount of the Obligations as aforesaid until the Obligations are
paid in full and the Commitment is terminated.

         3. SUBROGATION. The Guarantor expressly waives any and all rights of
subrogation, reimbursement and contribution (contractual, statutory or
otherwise), including any claim or right of subrogation under the Bankruptcy
Code (Title 11 of the U.S. Code) or any successor statute, arising from the
existence or performance of this Guaranty, and the Guarantor irrevocably waives
any right to enforce any remedy, which any Lender now has or may hereafter have
against any Borrower, and waives any benefit of, and any right to participate
in, any security now or hereafter held by any of them. The provisions of this
paragraph 0 shall survive the termination of this Guaranty and the payment in
full of the Obligations; provided, however, that the foregoing waiver shall be
of no force and effect 370 days following the termination of this Guaranty and
the payment in full of the Obligations, but only if during such 370-day period
no Borrower nor the Guarantor shall have commenced or have commenced against it
a bankruptcy proceeding under the Bankruptcy Code or similar law under any state
or foreign jurisdiction.

         4. AMENDMENTS, ETC. WITH RESPECT TO THE OBLIGATIONS. The Guarantor
shall remain obligated hereunder notwithstanding that, without any reservation
of rights against the Guarantor, and without notice to or further assent by the
Guarantor, any demand for payment of any of the Obligations made by any Lender
may be rescinded, and any of the obligations continued, and the Obligations, or
the liability of any other party upon or for any part thereto, may, from time to
time, in whole or in part, be renewed, extended, amended, modified, accelerated,
compromised, waived, surrendered or released by any Lender, and any agreement or
instrument relating to the extension of credit by any Lender to any Borrower,
any Note, and any other document in connection therewith may be amended,
modified, supplemented or terminated, in whole or in part, as any Lender may
deem advisable from time to time, and any collateral security, guarantee or
right of offset at any time held by any Lender for the payment of the
Obligations may be sold, exchanged, waived, surrendered or released. No Lender
shall have any obligation to protect, secure, perfect or insure any lien at any
time held by it as security for the Obligations or for this Guaranty or any
property subject thereto.

         5. WAIVER OF RIGHTS; GUARANTEE ABSOLUTE AND UNCONDITIONAL. The
Guarantor waives any and all notice of the creation, renewal, extension or
accrual of any of the Obligations and notice of or proof of reliance by the
Lenders upon this Guaranty or acceptance of this Guaranty; the Obligations, and
any of them, shall conclusively be deemed to have been created, contracted or
incurred in reliance upon this Guaranty; and all dealings between any Borrower
or the Guarantor, on the one hand, and any Lender, on the other, shall likewise
be conclusively presumed to have been had or consummated in reliance upon this
Guaranty.

                                      -2-
<PAGE>

The Guarantor waives diligence, presentment, protest, demand for
payment and notice of default or nonpayment to or upon any Borrower or the
Guarantor with respect to the Obligations. This Guaranty shall be construed as a
continuing, absolute and unconditional guarantee of payment without regard to
(a) the validity or enforceability of any of the Loan Documents, any of the
Obligations or any collateral security therefor or guarantee or right of offset
with respect thereto at any time or from time to time held by any Lender, (b)
any defense, set-off or counterclaim (other than a defense of payment or
performance) which may at any time be available to or be asserted by any
Borrower against any Lender, or (c) any other circumstance whatsoever (with or
without notice to or knowledge of any Borrower or the Guarantor) which
constitutes, or might be construed to constitute, an equitable or legal
discharge of any Borrower for the Obligations, or of the Guarantor under this
Guaranty, in bankruptcy or in any other instance, and the Obligations may be
declared to be forthwith due and payable as provided under Article VIII of the
Credit Agreement (and shall be deemed to have become automatically due and
payable in case of defaults arising under Sections 8.01(d) or (e) of the Credit
Agreement) notwithstanding any stay, injunction or other prohibition preventing
such declaration as against any other Person and that, in the event of such
declaration (or the Obligations being deemed to have become automatically due
and payable), the Obligations shall forthwith become due and payable by the
Guarantor. When pursuing its rights and remedies hereunder against the
Guarantor, any Lender may, but shall be under no obligation to, pursue such
rights and remedies as it may have against any Borrower or any other Person or
against any collateral security or guarantee for the Obligations or any right of
offset with respect thereto, and any failure by such Lender to pursue such other
rights or remedies or to collect any payments from any Borrower or any such
other Person or to realize upon any such collateral security or guarantee or to
exercise any such right of offset, or any release of any Borrower or any such
other Person or any such collateral security, guarantee or right of offset,
shall not relieve the Guarantor of any liability hereunder, and shall not impair
or affect the rights and remedies, whether express, implied or available as a
matter of law, of any Lender against the Guarantor.

         6. REINSTATEMENT. This Guaranty shall continue to be effective, or be
reinstated, as the case may be, if at any time payment, or any part thereof, of
any of the Obligations is rescinded or must otherwise be restored or returned by
any Lender upon the insolvency, bankruptcy, dissolution, liquidation or
reorganization of any Borrower or upon or as a result of the appointment of a
receiver, intervenor or conservator of, or trustee or similar officer for any
Borrower or any substantial part of its property, or otherwise, all as though
such payments had not been made.

         7. PAYMENTS. The Guarantor hereby agrees that the Obligations will be
paid to the Lenders without set-off or counterclaim in the currency or
currencies in which such Obligations are denominated from time to time at the
Lending Office identified in the documentation governing such Obligations, at
such office of the Bank.

         8.       REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES.  The Guarantor represents and
warrants that:


         (a) the Guarantor (i) is a corporation duly organized, validly existing
         and in good standing under the laws of the jurisdiction of the
         Commonwealth of Virginia, (ii) has the corporate power and authority
         and the legal right to own and operate its property, to lease the
         property it operates under lease and to conduct the business in which
         it is currently

                                      -3-
<PAGE>

         engaged, and (iii) is qualified to do business in every
         jurisdiction where such qualification is required, except where the
         failure to so qualify would not have a Material Adverse Effect;

         (b) the Guarantor has the corporate power and authority and the legal
         right to execute and deliver, and to perform its obligations under,
         this Guaranty, and has taken all necessary corporate action to
         authorize its execution, delivery and performance of this Guaranty;

         (c) this Guaranty constitutes a legal, valid and binding obligation of
         the Guarantor enforceable in accordance with its terms, except as
         enforceability may be limited by bankruptcy, insolvency,
         reorganization, moratorium or similar laws affecting the enforcement of
         creditors' rights generally;

         (d) the execution, delivery and performance of this Guaranty will not
         (i) violate any provision of any law or regulation or of any judgment,
         order, decree, determination or award of any court, arbitrator or
         governmental authority, bureau or agency or of the charter, by-laws or
         other corporate rules of, or any securities issued by, the Guarantor,
         (ii) result in a breach of or constitute a default under any mortgage,
         indenture, loan or security agreement, lease, contract or other
         agreement, instrument or undertaking to which the Guarantor is a party
         or which purports to be binding upon it or any of its properties or
         assets, or (iii) result in or require the creation or imposition of any
         lien on any of the properties or revenues of the Guarantor pursuant to
         the provisions of any of the foregoing;

         (e) no consent or authorization of, filing with, or other act by or in
         respect of, any Governmental Authority, and no consent of any other
         person (including, without limitation, any stockholder or creditor of
         the Guarantor) is required in connection with the execution, delivery,
         performance, validity or enforceability of this Guaranty; and

         (f) except as disclosed to the Bank in writing (including disclosure by
         delivery of financial statements to the Bank pursuant to Section
         5.01(i) of the Credit Agreement), no litigation, investigation or
         proceeding of or before any arbitrator or governmental authority,
         bureau or agency is pending or, to the knowledge of the Guarantor,
         threatened by or against the Guarantor or against any of its properties
         or revenues (i) with respect to this Guaranty or any of the
         transactions contemplated hereby or (ii) the probable outcome of which
         would have a Material Adverse Effect;

         9. STATUS OF BORROWERS. The Guarantor represents and warrants as of the
date hereof that the Guarantor directly or indirectly owns and has the power to
vote at least 51% of the voting interests of each of BAX and Brink's, that BAX
directly or indirectly owns at least 51% of the voting interests of each of the
BAX Covered Subsidiaries that are party to the Credit Agreement, and that
Brink's directly or indirectly owns at least 51% of the voting interests of each
of the Brink's Covered Subsidiaries that are party to the Credit Agreement.
Notwithstanding any sale or transfer of any ownership interest in any Borrower,
the Guarantor will continue to be bound by the terms of this Guaranty in all
respects including without limitation to guaranty the Obligations of each
Minority Owned Borrower.

                                      -4-
<PAGE>

The Guarantor hereby acknowledges and agrees that the
representations and warranties contained in the first sentence of this paragraph
0 shall be deemed repeated as of the date of each Advance made after the
Effective Date and as of the date of effectiveness of each Election to
Participate requesting that an additional Covered Subsidiary be made a party to,
and a Borrower under, the Credit Agreement after the Effective Date.

         10. SEVERABILITY. Any provision of this Guaranty which is prohibited or
unenforceable in any jurisdiction shall, as to such jurisdiction, be ineffective
to the extent of such prohibition or unenforceability without invalidating the
remaining provisions hereof, and any such prohibition or unenforceability in any
jurisdiction shall not invalidate or render unenforceable such provision in any
other jurisdiction.

         11.      PARAGRAPH HEADINGS.  The paragraph headings used in this
Guaranty are for convenience of reference only and are not to affect the
construction hereof or be taken into consideration in the interpretation
hereof.

         12. NO WAIVER: CUMULATIVE REMEDIES. Neither the Bank nor any Lending
Office affiliates, branches or subsidiaries shall by any act (except by a
written instrument pursuant to paragraph 0 hereof), delay, indulgence, omission
or otherwise be deemed to have waived any right or remedy hereunder or to have
acquiesced in any default or in any breach of any of the terms and conditions
hereof. No failure to exercise, nor any delay in exercising, on the part of the
Bank or any Lending Office, any right, power or privilege hereunder shall
operate as a waiver thereof. No single or partial exercise of any right, power
or privilege hereunder shall preclude any other or further exercise thereof or
the exercise of any other right, power or privilege. A waiver by the Bank or any
Lending Office of any right or remedy hereunder on any one occasion shall not be
construed as a bar to any right or remedy which the Bank or such Lending Office
would otherwise have on any future occasion. The rights and remedies herein
provided are cumulative, may be exercised singly or concurrently and are not
exclusive of any rights or remedies provided by law.

         13. WAIVERS AND AMENDMENTS; SUCCESSORS AND ASSIGNS: GOVERNING LAW.
Except as otherwise set forth in paragraph 0 hereof, none of the terms or
provisions of this Guaranty may be waived, amended, supplemented or otherwise
modified except by a written instrument executed by the Guarantor and the Bank;
provided that any provision of this Guaranty may be waived by the Bank in a
letter or agreement executed by the Bank or by telex or fax transmission by the
Bank. This Guaranty shall be binding upon the successors and assigns of the
Guarantor and shall inure to the benefit of the Bank, all Lending Offices and
their respective successors and assigns. THIS GUARANTY IS A GUARANTEE OF PAYMENT
AND NOT SOLELY OF COLLECTION AND SHALL BE GOVERNED BY, AND CONSTRUED AND
INTERPRETED IN ACCORDANCE WITH, THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK.

         14.      JUDGMENT CURRENCY.

         (a) The Guarantor's obligations under this Guaranty to make payments to
         any Lenders in the currency or currencies in which the Obligations are
         denominated in the documentation governing such Obligations (the
         "Obligations Currency") shall not be discharged or satisfied by any
         tender or recovery pursuant to any judgment expressed in

                                      -5-
<PAGE>

         or converted into any other currency, except to the extent that such
         tender or recovery results in the effective receipt by the Lenders of
         the full amount of the Obligations Currency payable to the Lenders
         under this Guaranty, and the Guarantor shall indemnify the Lenders
         (and the Lenders shall have an additional legal claim) for any
         difference between such full amount and the amount effectively received
         by such Person pursuant to any such tender or recovery. The
         determination by any Lender of amounts effectively received by it shall
         be conclusive absent manifest error.

                  (b) (i)i If for the purpose of obtaining or enforcing any
                  judgment against the Guarantor in any court in any
                  jurisdiction, it becomes necessary to convert into any
                  currency other than the Obligations Currency (such currency
                  being hereinafter in this paragraph 0 referred to as the
                  "Judgment Currency") an amount due in the Obligations Currency
                  under this Guaranty, the conversion shall be made, at the
                  option of the Bank or the relevant Lending Office, at the rate
                  of exchange prevailing on the business day immediately
                  preceding the day on which the judgment is given (such
                  business day being hereinafter in this paragraph 0 referred to
                  as the "Conversion Date").

                  (ii)ii If there is a change in the rate of exchange prevailing
                  between the Conversion Date and the date of actual payment of
                  the amount due, the Guarantor covenants and agrees to pay such
                  additional amounts (if any, but in any event not a lesser
                  amount) as may be necessary to ensure that the amount paid in
                  the Judgment Currency, when converted at the rate of exchange
                  prevailing on the date of payment, will produce the amount of
                  the Obligations Currency which could have been purchased with
                  the amount of Judgment Currency stipulated in the judgment of
                  judicial award at the rate of exchange prevailing on the
                  Conversion Date.

         (c) Any amount due from the Guarantor under the foregoing paragraph
         will be due as a separate debt and shall not be affected by judgment
         being obtained for any other sums due under or in respect of this
         Guaranty.

         (d) The term "rate of exchange" in this paragraph 0 means the Bank's or
         the relevant Lending Office's rate of exchange on the relevant date
         applicable to the purchase of the Obligations Currency with the
         Judgment Currency or, if such rate is not so published by the Bank or
         such Lending Office, such term shall mean the spot rate at which the
         Bank or such Lending Office in accordance with its normal practices is
         able on the relevant date to purchase the Obligations Currency with the
         Judgment Currency and includes in either case any premium and costs of
         exchange payable in connection with such purchase.

         15. SUBMISSION TO JURISDICTION. The Guarantor hereby irrevocably agrees
that any legal action, suit or proceeding against it with respect to its
obligations, liabilities or any other matter under or arising out of or in
connection with this Guaranty or for recognition or enforcement of any judgment
rendered in any such action, suit or proceeding may be brought in the United
States Courts for the Southern District of New York, or in the courts of the
State of New York, as the Bank or, if applicable, any Lending Office may elect,
and, by execution and delivery of this Guaranty, the Guarantor hereby
irrevocably accepts and submits to the non-

                                      -6-
<PAGE>

exclusive jurisdiction of each of the
aforesaid courts in personam generally and unconditionally with respect to any
such action, suit or proceeding for itself and in respect of its property. The
Guarantor further agrees that final judgment against it in any action, suit or
proceeding referred to herein shall be conclusive and may be enforced in any
other jurisdiction, within or outside the United States of America, by suit on
the judgment, a certified or exemplified copy of which shall be conclusive
evidence of the fact and of the amount of its indebtedness. The Guarantor hereby
irrevocably designates and appoints Brink's, Incorporated at the address of its
registered agent in the State of New York (which, as of the date hereof, is CT
Corporation System, currently located at 111 Eighth Avenue, New York, New York
10011) as the designee, appointee and agent of the Guarantor to receive, accept
and acknowledge for and on behalf of the Guarantor and its property service of
any and all legal process, summons, notices and documents which may be served in
any such action, suit or proceeding in the case of United States Courts for the
Southern District of New York and the courts of the State of New York, which
service may be made on such designee, appointee and agent in accordance with
legal procedures prescribed for such courts. It is agreed that if any legal
process, summons, notice or document shall be served upon Brink's, Incorporated
at the address of such registered agent with respect to the Guarantor in
connection herewith, notice thereof shall promptly be provided to the Guarantor
at the address set forth on the signature page hereof; provided, that the
failure to provide any such notice shall not affect the validity of such service
upon Brink's, Incorporated as agent for and on behalf of Guarantor, at the
address of such registered agent. The Guarantor agrees to take any and all such
action necessary to continue such designation in full force and effect and to
advise the Bank on its behalf and on behalf of each other Lender of any change
of address of such designee, appointee and agent; and should said designee,
appointee and agent become unavailable for this purpose for any reason, the
Guarantor will forthwith irrevocably designate a new designee, appointee and
agent within the City of New York, New York, which shall irrevocably consent to
act as such, with the powers and for the purposes specified in this paragraph.
The Guarantor further irrevocably consents and agrees to the service of any and
all legal process, summons, notices, and documents out of any of the aforesaid
courts in any such action, suit or proceeding by mailing copies thereof by
registered or certified mail, postage prepaid, to the Guarantor at its address
set forth with its signature below or to its then designee, appointee and agent
for service. The Guarantor agrees that service upon it or any such designee,
appointee, and agent as provided for herein shall constitute a valid and
effective personal service upon it and that the failure of any such designee,
appointee and agent to give any notice of such service to it shall not impair or
affect in any way the validity of such service. Nothing herein contained shall,
or shall be construed so as to, limit the right of the Bank or any other Lender
to bring actions, suits or proceedings with respect to the obligations and
liabilities of the Guarantor under, or any other matter arising out of or in
connection with, this Guaranty, or for recognition or enforcement of any
judgment rendered in any such action, suit or proceeding, in the courts of
whatever jurisdiction in which the office of the Bank or such Lending Office or
Assignee deems appropriate, or to affect the right to service of process in any
jurisdiction in any other manner permitted by the law.

In addition, the Guarantor hereby irrevocably and unconditionally waives any
objection which it may now or hereafter have to the laying of venue of any of
the aforesaid actions, suits or proceedings arising out of or in connection with
this Guaranty brought in any of the aforesaid courts, and hereby further
irrevocably and unconditionally waives and agrees not to plead any

                                      -7-
<PAGE>

claim that any such action, suit or proceeding brought in any such court has
been broughtin an inconvenient forum.

Each party hereto waives its rights to a trial by jury of any claim or cause of
action based upon or arising out of or related to this Guaranty, or the
transactions contemplated hereby or thereby, in any action, proceeding or other
litigation of any type brought by any party against the other party.

         16. NOTICES. All notices, requests and other communications provided
for hereunder shall be in writing (including, unless the context expressly
otherwise provides, telex or fax) and mailed, sent by overnight delivery
service, telexed or faxed, to the address or number specified for notices to the
applicable party set forth on Schedule 9.02 to the Credit Agreement or to such
other address as shall be designated by such party in a written notice to the
other parties.

All such notices, requests and other communications shall, when transmitted by
overnight delivery service, telex or fax, be effective the day after delivered
to the overnight delivery service, when confirmed by telex answerback or when
transmitted by fax with machine transmittal confirmation, respectively, or, if
transmitted by mail, upon delivery, except that notices pursuant to Article II
or Article III of the Credit Agreement shall not be effective until actually
received by the Bank.

The Guarantor acknowledges and agrees that the Bank's agreement to receive
notices, requests and other communications by fax is solely for the convenience
and at the request of the Guarantor. Each Lender shall be entitled to rely on
the authority of any Person purporting to be a Person authorized by the
Guarantor to give such communications and no Lender shall have any liability to
Guarantor or any other Person on account of any action taken or not taken by
such Lender in reliance upon such fax communication. The obligations of the
Guarantor hereunder shall not be affected in any way or to any extent by any
failure by the Bank or any other Lender to receive written confirmation of any
fax communication or by the receipt of a confirmation which is at variance with
the terms understood by such Lender to be contained in the fax communication.

         17. COUNTERPARTS; FACSIMILE SIGNATURES. This Guaranty may be executed
by one or more of the parties in separate counterparts, each of which, when so
executed, shall be deemed an original, and all of said counterparts taken
together shall be deemed to constitute but one and the same instrument. The
parties hereto confirm that any facsimile copy of another party's executed
counterpart of this Guaranty (or its signature page thereof) will be deemed to
be an executed original thereof.

                        [SIGNATURES APPEAR ON NEXT PAGE]



                                      -8-
<PAGE>



IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the undersigned has caused this Guaranty to be duly executed
and delivered as of the date first above written.

                                  THE PITTSTON COMPANY


                                  By:      /s/ James B.  Hartough
                                           ----------------------------
                                  Name:    James B. Hartough
                                  Title:   Vice President - Corporate Finance
                                            and Treasurer



ACKNOWLEDGED:
BAYERISCHE HYPO- UND VEREINSBANK AG


By:      /s/ Ricarda Soltanmoradi
         --------------------------------------------
Name:    Ricarda Soltanmoradi
Title:   Managing Director


By:      /s/ Christina Winkler-Kruse
         -----------------------------------------------------
Name:    Christina Winkler-Kruse
Title:   Senior Credit Analyst


                                      -9-
<PAGE>



</TEXT>
</DOCUMENT>
<DOCUMENT>
<TYPE>EX-10
<SEQUENCE>5
<FILENAME>creditagree_abnamro.txt
<DESCRIPTION>ABN AMRO CREDIT AGREEMENT
<TEXT>
                                CREDIT AGREEMENT

                          DATED AS OF DECEMBER 20, 2002

                                      AMONG

                                BAX GLOBAL INC.,

                             BRINK'S, INCORPORATED,

                              THE PITTSTON COMPANY

                                       AND

                               ABN AMRO BANK N.V.


<PAGE>





                                CREDIT AGREEMENT

         This CREDIT AGREEMENT is entered into as of December 20, 2002 among (i)
BAX GLOBAL INC., a Delaware corporation formerly known as Burlington Air Express
Inc. ("BAX"), (ii) BRINK'S,  INCORPORATED,  a Delaware corporation  ("Brink's"),
and (iii) THE PITTSTON COMPANY, a Virginia  corporation,  (the "Pittston") (BAX,
Brink's and Pittston are sometimes  hereinafter  referred to as "Borrowers"  and
"Guarantors"), and (iv) ABN AMRO BANK N.V. (the "Bank").

         WHEREAS,  the parties enter into this  Agreement to set forth the terms
and conditions  upon which the Bank will extend to the Borrowers,  a $45,000,000
(the  "Commitment")  revolving  credit  facility for a  three-year  period ( the
"Facility"), in part to refinance facilities currently extended by the Bank;

                  WHEREAS,  upon the written  request of any  Borrower  and upon
written advice from the Bank to the requesting  Borrower agreeing  thereto,  any
portion of the then unused Commitment may be allocated for use by any Subsidiary
of BAX listed on Schedule A-1 hereto or by any  Subsidiary of Brink's  listed on
Schedule A-2 hereto,  as the same may be  supplemented  and amended from time to
time  with the  written  consent  of the  Bank,  at a branch  or  Affiliate  (as
hereinafter defined) of the Bank, provided, that at all times the Guaranties (as
hereinafter  defined) of the  Guarantors  shall apply to all such  extensions of
credit by all such branches and Affiliates of the Bank;

         WHEREAS, pursuant to a Credit Agreement, dated as of December 22, 1999,
as renewed and amended  from time to time  thereafter,  the Bank has  extended a
revolving  credit facility (the "1999 Revolving  Facility") to BAX,  Brink's and
certain of the BAX Covered  Subsidiaries  and Brink's Covered  Subsidiaries  (as
both terms are defined  therein),  which facility is terminating and expiring in
accordance with its terms;

         WHEREAS, the Facility provided hereunder shall be available immediately
upon the  termination  of the 1999  Revolving  Facility in  accordance  with its
terms, provided the conditions precedent set forth below have been satisfied;

         NOW, THEREFORE,  in consideration of the mutual agreements,  provisions
and covenants contained herein, the parties hereto hereby agree as follows:

                                    ARTICLE I

                                   DEFINITIONS

         1.01  Defined  Terms1.01  Defined  Terms.01  Defined  Terms.01  Defined
Terms.  In  addition to the terms defined in the recitals to this Agreement,
the following terms have the following meanings:

                  "Advances" has the meaning assigned thereto in Section 2.01.

                  "Affiliate"  means,  with  respect  to any  Person,  any other
         Person (other than a Subsidiary)  which directly or indirectly  through
         one or more intermediaries,  controls,
<PAGE>
         or is controlled by, or is under
         common control with, such first Person or any of its Subsidiaries.  The
         term "control"  means the  possession,  directly or indirectly,  of any
         power to direct or cause the direction of the  management  and policies
         of a  Person,  whether  through  ownership  of  voting  securities,  by
         contract or otherwise.

                  "Agreement" means this Credit Agreement, as it may be amended,
         supplemented or modified from time to time hereafter.

                  "Approved  Currencies"  means Dollars and other  currencies as
         are  available  to a  Borrower  for  Loans and  Letters  of Credit or a
         Covered  Subsidiary  for credit  extensions by a branch or Affiliate of
         the Bank  and  which  are  freely  transferable  and  convertible  into
         Dollars.

                  "Assignee" has the meaning assigned thereto in Section 9.07.

                  "Bankruptcy  Code" means Title 11 of the United  States  Code,
         entitled  "Bankruptcy",  as  now  or  hereinafter  in  effect  and  any
         successor thereto.

                  "Base Rate" means the higher of:

                           (a) the rate of interest publicly announced from time
                  to time by the  Bank as its  "reference  rate"  or its  "prime
                  rate" (which publicly announced rate is a rate set by the Bank
                  based upon  various  factors  including  the Bank's  costs and
                  desired return, general economic conditions and other factors,
                  and is used as a reference point for pricing some loans, which
                  may be priced at, above, or below such announced rate); and

                           (b)  one-half percent per annum above the latest
         Federal Funds Rate. Any change in the  reference  rate or prime rate
         announced  by the Bank shall take effect at the
         opening of business on the day specified in the public  announcement of
         such  change."Base Rate Loan" means a Loan that bears interest based on
         the Base Rate.

                  "Business Day" means any day other than a Saturday,  Sunday or
         other day on which  commercial  banks in New York City and  Chicago are
         authorized or required by law to close except in the case of LIBOR Rate
         Loans,  "Business  Day" means any day other than a Saturday,  Sunday or
         other day on which  commercial  banks in New York,  Chicago and London,
         England are authorized or required by law to close.

                  "Capital Adequacy Regulation" means any guideline,  request or
         directive of any central bank or other Governmental  Authority,  or any
         other law, rule or regulation,  whether or not having the force of law,
         in  each  case,  regarding  capital  adequacy  of  any  bank  or of any
         corporation controlling a bank.

                                      -2-
<PAGE>

                  "Capital  Lease"  means any lease of property  which should be
         capitalized on the lessee's  balance sheet in accordance with GAAP; and
         "Capital  Lease  Obligation"  means  the  amount  of the  liability  so
         capitalized.

                  "Code" means the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended.

                  "Commercial  Letter of Credit" means a  documentary  letter of
         credit which is drawable upon presentation of documents  evidencing the
         sale or  shipment  of goods  purchased  by a  Borrower  or any  Covered
         Subsidiary in the ordinary course of its business.

                  "Commitment"  means  the  commitment  of the Bank  under  this
         Agreement  to make  Advances  pursuant to the  Facility in an aggregate
         principal  amount  not to exceed  $45,000,000,  as such  amount  may be
         reduced from time to time pursuant to the terms of this Agreement.

                  "Commitment  Fee Rate"  means the  applicable  percentage  set
         forth  below  based upon the  higher of the S&P  Rating or the  Moody's
         Rating on the last day of the  calendar  quarter  with respect to which
         the commitment fee is being calculated,  provided,  that if on any such
         date the S&P Rating and the Moody's Rating do not fall into  contiguous
         columns under the following  grid,  then the applicable  percentage set
         forth below  based upon the lower of the S&P or the  Moody's  Rating on
         the last day of such calendar quarter (but no lower than the applicable
         percentage in the column  contiguous  with the higher of the S&P or the
         Moody's Rating):

<TABLE>


                   -----------  -------------  -------------  ---------------  ---------------  --------------
<S>                    <C>             <C>           <C>            <C>              <C>            <C>
       S&P             A-
      Rating                         BBB+           BBB            BBB-              BB+          Below BB+
                    or higher

- -----------------  -----------  -------------  -------------  ---------------  ---------------  --------------
 Moody's Rating        A3           Baa1           Baa2            Baa3              Ba1          Below Ba1
                    or higher

- -----------------  -----------  -------------  -------------  ---------------  ---------------  --------------
 Commitment Fee      0.125%         0.15%         0.175%          0.225%            0.30%           0.40%
      Rate
- ------------------ ------------ -------------- -------------- ---------------- ---------------- ---------------
</TABLE>

                  If the rating system used to ascribe  either the S&P Rating or
         the Moody's  Rating  shall change prior to the  Termination  Date,  the
         Borrowers  and the Bank  shall  negotiate  in good  faith to amend  the
         references  to  specific  ratings in this  definition  to reflect  such
         changed rating system.

                                      -3-
<PAGE>

                  "Consolidated  Debt"  means  the  Debt  of  Pittston  and  its
         Restricted   Subsidiaries,   determined  on  a  consolidated  basis  in
         accordance  with GAAP after  giving  appropriate  effect to any outside
         minority interests in Restricted Subsidiaries.


                  "Consolidated  EBITDA" means,  for Pittston and its Restricted
         Subsidiaries  for  any  period,  an  amount  equal  to  the  sum of (a)
         Consolidated Net Income for such period plus (b) to the extent deducted
         in   determining   Consolidated   Net  Income  for  such  period,   (i)
         Consolidated   Interest  Expense,   (ii)  income  tax  expense,   (iii)
         depreciation,  depletion and amortization,  and (iv) all other non-cash
         charges,  determined on a  consolidated  basis in accordance  with GAAP
         after giving  appropriate  effect to any outside minority  interests in
         the Restricted Subsidiaries.


                  "Consolidated  Interest  Expense"  means,  for any period,  as
         applied to  Pittston  and its  Restricted  Subsidiaries,  all  interest
         expense (whether paid or accrued) and capitalized  interest,  including
         without  limitation (a) the  amortization of debt discount and premium,
         (b) the interest  component under Capital  Leases,  and (c) the implied
         interest  component,  discount  or other  similar  fees or  charges  in
         connection  with  any  asset   securitization   program  in  each  case
         determined on a consolidated basis in accordance with GAAP after giving
         appropriate  effect to any outside minority interests in the Restricted
         Subsidiaries.


                  "Consolidated  Lease  Rentals" means Lease Rentals of Pittston
         and its Restricted Subsidiaries,  determined on a consolidated basis in
         accordance  with GAAP after  giving  appropriate  effect to any outside
         minority interests in the Restricted Subsidiaries.


                  "Consolidated  Net  Income"  means,  for any  period,  the net
         income,  after taxes, of Pittston and its Restricted  Subsidiaries  for
         such period determined on a consolidated  basis in accordance with GAAP
         after giving  appropriate  effect to any outside minority  interests in
         the Restricted Subsidiaries,  but excluding, to the extent reflected in
         determining such net income, (a) any extraordinary gains and losses for
         such period, (b) for any period ending before January 1, 2003, any loss
         arising from or relating to the initial  classification  of any portion
         of the  Pittston  Minerals  Group as  discontinued  operations  and any
         subsequent   adjustments   associated  with  the  disposition  of  such
         discontinued operations, (c) any impairment, write-down or write-off in
         the book value of any assets  and (d) any loss in  connection  with the
         disposition of any assets.


                  "Consolidated  Net Worth" means, as of any date, as applied to
         Pittston and its Restricted  Subsidiaries,  shareholders' equity or net
         worth as determined and computed on a consolidated  basis in accordance
         with GAAP  after  giving  appropriate  effect to any  outside  minority
         interests in the Restricted Subsidiaries,  provided that in determining
         "Consolidated  Net Worth"  there shall be (a)  included any issuance of
         preferred  stock by Pittston  and (b)  excluded  (i) any  extraordinary
         gains and losses, (ii) any loss arising from or relating to the initial
         classification  of  any  portion  of the  Pittston  Minerals  Group  as
         discontinued  operations and any subsequent adjustments associated with
         the disposition of such discontinued operations, to the extent any such
         loss or adjustment occurs before

                                      -4-
<PAGE>

         January 1, 2003, (iii) any impairment,
         write-down or write-off in the book value of any assets  (including any
         reduction in shareholders' equity in connection with a reduction in the
         value of a prepaid  Pension Plan or Foreign  Pension Plan) and (iv) any
         loss in connection with the disposition of any assets.


                  "Consolidated  Total Assets" means, as of any date, the assets
         and properties of Pittston and its Restricted Subsidiaries,  determined
         on  a  consolidated   basis  in  accordance   with  GAAP  after  giving
         appropriate  effect to any outside minority interests in the Restricted
         Subsidiaries.


                  "Contaminant"  shall  mean  any  waste,   hazardous  material,
         hazardous substance,  toxic substance,  hazardous waste, special waste,
         petroleum or petroleum-derived  substance or waste,  including any such
         pollutant,   material,   substance   or  waste   regulated   under  any
         Environmental Law.


                  "Control",  "Controlling"  and  "Controlled"  means the power,
         direct or indirect,  of one Person to direct or cause the  direction of
         the  management and policies of another,  whether by contract,  through
         voting securities or otherwise.


                  "Covered  Subsidiaries"  means  the  Subsidiaries  of BAX  and
         Brink's  listed on Schedule  B-1, as the same may be  supplemented  and
         amended with the written consent of the Bank.


                  Debt" of any Person  means at any date,  without  duplication,
         the sum of the following  determined and calculated in accordance  with
         GAAP: (a) all  obligations of such Person for borrowed  money,  (b) all
         obligations  of such Person issued or assumed as the deferred  purchase
         price of  property  or services  purchased  by such Person  (other than
         trade debt  incurred in the ordinary  course of business and due within
         six months of the incurrence thereof) which would appear as liabilities
         on a balance  sheet of such Person,  (c) all Debt of others  secured by
         (or for which the holder of such Debt has an existing right, contingent
         or  otherwise,  to be secured  by) any Lien on, or  payable  out of the
         proceeds of production from, property owned or acquired by such Person,
         whether  or not the  obligations  secured  thereby  have been  assumed,
         provided  that for  purposes  hereof  the  amount of such Debt shall be
         calculated  at the  greater  of (i) the amount of such Debt as to which
         there is recourse to such Person and (ii) the fair market  value of the
         property which is subject to the Lien,  (d) all Support  Obligations of
         such Person with respect to Debt of others,  (e) the principal  portion
         of all obligations of such Person under Capital Leases, (f) the maximum
         amount of all drafts drawn under  standby  letters of credit  issued or
         bankers' acceptances  facilities created for the account of such Person
         (to  the  extend  unreimbursed),  and (g)  the  outstanding  attributed
         principal amount under any asset securitization program of such Person.
         The Debt of any Person  shall  include the Debt of any  partnership  or
         joint  venture  in which  such  Person is a general  partner or a joint
         venturer,  but only to the extent to which  there is  recourse  to such
         Person for payment of such Debt.

                                      -5-
<PAGE>


                  "Default"  means any  event or  circumstance  which,  with the
         giving of notice,  the lapse of time,  or both,  would (if not cured or
         otherwise remedied) constitute an Event of Default.


                  "Dollar  Equivalent"  means  (a)  in  relation  to  an  amount
         denominated  in Dollars,  the amount  thereof and (b) in relation to an
         amount  denominated in any Approved  Currency  other than Dollars,  the
         amount of Dollars that can be purchased with such Approved  Currency at
         the spot rate of exchange determined by the Bank in accordance with its
         customary practices on the date of determination.


                  "Dollars",  "dollars"  and "$" each mean  lawful  money of the
United States.


                  "Effective  Date"  means  the  date on  which  all  conditions
         precedent  set forth in  Section  5.01 are  satisfied  or waived by the
         Bank.


                  Environmental  Laws" means any and all federal,  state,  local
         and foreign statutes, laws, regulations, ordinances, rules, judgements,
         orders, decrees,  permits,  licenses,  agreements or other governmental
         restrictions relating to the environment or to emissions, discharges or
         releases of pollutants,  contaminants,  petroleum products, or toxic or
         hazardous substances or wastes into the environment,  including ambient
         air, surface water, groundwater,  or land, or otherwise relating to the
         manufacture,   processing,   distribution,   use,  treatment,  storage,
         disposal, transport or handling of pollutants,  contaminants, petroleum
         or petroleum  products,  or toxic or hazardous  substances or wastes or
         the clean-up or other remediation thereof.


                  "ERISA" means the Employee  Retirement  Income Security Act of
1974, as amended.


                  "ERISA  Affiliate"  means  any  entity  or trade or  business,
         whether or not  incorporated,  that,  together  with any  Borrower,  is
         treated as a single employer under Section 414 of the Code.


                  "Event of  Default"  means any of the events or  circumstances
specified in Section 8.01.


                  "Federal Funds Rate" means, for any day, the rate set forth in
         the  weekly  statistical  release  designated  as  H.15(519),   or  any
         successor   publication,   published  by  the  Federal   Reserve  Board
         (including any such successor,  "H.15(519)")  for such day opposite the
         caption "Federal Funds  (Effective)".  If on any relevant day such rate
         is not yet  published in  H.15(519),  the rate for such day will be the
         rate set  forth in the  daily  statistical  release  designated  as the
         Composite 3:30 p.m. Quotations for U.S. Government  Securities,  or any
         successor  publication,  published  by the Federal  Reserve Bank of New
         York   (including  any  such   successor,   the  "Composite  3:30  p.m.
         Quotation")  for such day

                                      -6-
<PAGE>

         under the caption  "Federal  Funds  Effective
         Rate".  If on any relevant day the  appropriate  rate for such previous
         day is not yet published in either H.15(519) or the Composite 3:30 p.m.
         Quotations,  the rate for such day will be the  arithmetic  mean of the
         rates for the last  transaction  in overnight  Federal  funds  arranged
         prior to 9:00 a.m. (New York time) on that day by each of three leading
         brokers of Federal funds  transactions in New York City selected by the
         Bank.


                  "Federal  Reserve  Board"  means the Board of Governors of the
         Federal Reserve System or any successor thereof.


                  "Financial  Letter of Credit" has the meaning assigned thereto
in Section 3.01(a).


                  "Fiscal  Year"  means the fiscal  year of  Pittston  ending on
December 31 in any year.


                  "Foreign  Pension  Plan"  means  any  plan,  fund  (including,
         without limitation,  any superannuation  fund) or other similar program
         established  or  maintained  outside  the  United  States of America by
         Pittston  or any  one or  more of its  Subsidiaries  primarily  for the
         benefit of employees of Pittston or such Subsidiaries  residing outside
         the United States of America, which plan, fund or other similar program
         provides,  or results in,  retirement  income,  a deferral of income in
         contemplation  of retirement or payments to be made upon termination of
         employment, and which plan is not subject to ERISA or the Code.


                  "GAAP" means generally accepted  accounting  principles in the
         United  States,  as recognized  by the American  Institute of Certified
         Public  Accountants  and  the  Financial  Accounting  Standards  Board,
         consistently  applied and maintained on a consistent  basis  throughout
         the period indicated, subject to Section 1.02(a).


                  "Governmental  Authority" means any nation or government,  any
         state or other  political  subdivision  thereof,  any central  bank (or
         similar  monetary  or  regulatory   authority)   thereof,   any  entity
         exercising   executive,    legislative,    judicial,    regulatory   or
         administrative  functions  of or  pertaining  to  government,  and  any
         corporation  or other  entity  owned or  controlled,  through  stock or
         capital ownership or otherwise, by any of the foregoing.


                  "Guaranties"  mean the Guaranty of Pittston,  substantially in
         the form of Exhibit A-1 hereto,  the Guaranty of BAX,  substantially in
         the  form  of  Exhibit  A-2  hereto,   and  the  Guaranty  of  Brink's,
         substantially in the form of Exhibit A-3 hereto.


                  "Hedging    Agreements"   means   interest   rate   protection
         agreements,  foreign currency  exchange  agreements,  other interest or
         exchange  rate  hedging,  cap or collar  arrangements  or  arrangements
         designed to protect the  Guarantor or any of its  Subsidiaries  against
         fluctuations in the prices of commodities.


                                      -7-
<PAGE>
                  "Insolvency   Proceeding"   means  (a)  any  case,  action  or
         proceeding before any court or other Governmental Authority relating to
         bankruptcy,  reorganization,   insolvency,  liquidation,  receivership,
         dissolution,  winding-up  or  relief  of  debtors,  or (b) any  general
         assignment  for the benefit of  creditors,  composition,  marshaling of
         assets for creditors or other,  similar  arrangement  in respect of its
         creditors generally or any substantial  portion of its creditors;  and,
         in each  case,  undertaken  under  United  States  federal  or State or
         foreign law, including the Bankruptcy Code.


                  "Interest  Coverage  Ratio"  means,  as of the last day of any
         fiscal  quarter,   the  ratio  of  (a)   Consolidated   EBITDA  to  (b)
         Consolidated  Interest Expense, in each case for the period of four (4)
         consecutive fiscal quarters ending as of such day.


                  "Interest  Payment Date" means (i) the Termination Date , (ii)
         with respect to LIBOR Rate Loans,  the last day of the Interest  Period
         applicable to each such Loan,  and, if any such Interest Period exceeds
         three months, interest shall also be paid on the date which falls three
         months after the  beginning  of such  Interest  Period,  and (iii) with
         respect to Base Rate  Loans,  the last  Business  Day of each  calendar
         quarter.


                  "Interest  Period" means, with respect to any LIBOR Rate Loan,
         the  period  commencing  on the  Business  Day such Loan is  disbursed,
         continued or converted to a Base Rate Loan,  and in each case ending on
         the date one, two, three or six months  thereafter,  as selected by the
         relevant Borrower in its notice of borrowing or notice of conversion or
         continuation, provided that:


     (i) if any  Interest  Period  would  otherwise  end on a day which is not a
Business  Day,  that  Interest  Period shall be extended to the next  succeeding
Business Day unless the result of such extension would be to carry such Interest
Period into another  calendar  month,  in which event such Interest Period shall
end on the immediately preceding Business Day;


     (ii) any Interest Period that begins on the last Business Day of a calendar
month (or on a day for which there is no  numerically  corresponding  day in the
calendar  month  at the end of  such  Interest  Period)  shall  end on the  last
Business Day of the calendar month at the end of such Interest Period; and


     (iii) no Interest  Period for any Loan shall extend beyond the  Termination
Date.

                  "Labor  Laws"  means  any and all  federal,  state,  local and
         foreign statutes, laws, regulations,  ordinances, rules, judgements and
         orders   relating  to   employment,   equal   employment   opportunity,
         nondiscrimination,  immigration,  wages,  hours,  benefits,  collective
         bargaining,   the  payment  of  social   security  and  similar  taxes,
         occupational safety and health, and plant closing.


                                      -8-
<PAGE>

                  "L/C  Application" has the meaning assigned thereto in Section
3.03(b).


                  Section 3.05(a).  "Lease" means a lease,  other than a Capital
                  Lease, of real or personal property.


                  "Lease Rentals" for any period means the sum of the rental and
         other  obligations  to be paid by the lessee  under a Lease  during the
         remaining  term of such  Lease  (excluding  any  extension  or  renewal
         thereof at the option of the lessor or the lessee  unless  such  option
         has been  exercised),  excluding any amount  required to be paid by the
         lessee  (whether  or not  therein  designated  as rental or  additional
         rental)  on account  of  maintenance  and  repairs,  insurance,  taxes,
         assessments, water rates and similar charges.


                  "Lending  Office" shall mean the particular  Chicago office of
         the Bank for Base Rate Loans, Letters of Credit or for LIBOR Rate Loans
         at its respective address set forth on Schedule 9.02 hereto.


                  "Letter of Credit" means any stand-by  letter of credit issued
         by a Lending  Office  pursuant  to Section  3.03 and may be a Financial
         Letter of Credit or a Performance Letter of Credit.


                  "Letter of Credit Obligations" means, in respect of any Letter
         of Credit as at any date of  determination,  the sum of (a) the maximum
         aggregate  amount which is then available to be drawn under such Letter
         of  Credit  plus  (b)  the  aggregate   amount  of  all   Reimbursement
         Obligations then outstanding with respect to such Letter of Credit.


                  "Leverage  Ratio" means, as of the date of any  determination,
         the ratio of (a) the sum of (i) Consolidated Debt as of such date, plus
         (ii) the amount by which (A) the aggregate  amount, as of the preceding
         December  31 (or as of such  date if such  date  is  December  31),  of
         Consolidated Lease Rentals under non-cancelable  Leases entered into by
         Pittston or any of its Subsidiaries, discounted to present value at 10%
         and  net  of  aggregate   minimum   non-cancelable   sublease  rentals,
         determined   on  a  basis   consistent   with  Note  12  to  Pittston's
         consolidated  financial statements at and for the period ended December
         31, 2001,  included in Pittston's  2001 Annual Report to  shareholders,
         exceeds (B)  $350,000,000,  to (b) the sum of (i) the amount determined
         pursuant to clause  (a),  plus (ii)  Consolidated  Net Worth as of such
         date.


                  "LIBOR Rate" means, for each Interest Period in respect of any
LIBOR Rate Loan:


                           (a) the  rate per  annum  (carried  out to the  fifth
                  decimal  place) equal to the rate  determined  by the relevant
                  Lending Office to be the offered rate that appears on the page
                  of the  Telerate  Screen  that  displays  an  average  British
                  Bankers

                                      -9-
<PAGE>

                  Association   Interest  Settlement  Rate  (such  page
                  currently being page number 3750) for deposits in dollars (for
                  delivery on the first day of such Interest Period) with a term
                  equivalent   to  such  Interest   Period,   determined  as  of
                  approximately 11:00 a.m. (London time) two Business Days prior
                  to the first day of such Interest Period, or


                           (b) in the event the rate referenced in the preceding
                  subsection (a) does not appear on such page or service or such
                  page or  service  shall  cease to be  available,  the rate per
                  annum  (carried to the fifth decimal  place) equal to the rate
                  determined  by the Bank to be the  offered  rate on such other
                  page or other service that displays an average British Bankers
                  Association  Interest  Settlement Rate for deposits in dollars
                  (for delivery on the first day of such Interest Period) with a
                  term  equivalent  to such  Interest  Period,  determined as of
                  approximately 11:00 a.m. (London time) two Business Days prior
                  to the first day of such Interest Period, or


                           (c)  in  the  event  the  rates   referenced  in  the
                  preceding subsections (a) and (b) are not available,  the rate
                  per annum  determined  by the Bank as the rate of  interest at
                  which dollar  deposits  (for delivery on the first day of such
                  Interest  Period) in same day funds in the approximate  amount
                  of the applicable  LIBOR Rate Loan and with a term  equivalent
                  to such Interest  Period would be offered by the Bank's London
                  Branch to major banks in the offshore  dollar  market at their
                  request at approximately 11:00 a.m. (London time) two Business
                  Days prior to the first day of such Interest Period.


                  "LIBOR  Rate Loan" means a Loan that bears  interest  based on
         the LIBOR Rate.


                  "Lien" means,  with respect to any asset, any mortgage,  lien,
         pledge, charge, security interest or encumbrance of any kind in respect
         of such asset.  For the purposes of this  Agreement,  a Person shall be
         deemed to own  subject  to a Lien any asset  which it has  acquired  or
         holds  subject  to  the  interest  of a  vendor  or  lessor  under  any
         conditional  sale  agreement,  Capital  Lease or other title  retention
         agreement relating to such asset.


                  "Loan"  means an  advance  of funds by a  Lending  Office to a
         Borrower  pursuant  to Section  2.03,  and may be a Base Rate Loan or a
         LIBOR Rate Loan.


                  "Loan  Documents"  means  this  Agreement  and  all  documents
         delivered  to the  Bank  or any  other  Lending  Office  in  connection
         herewith,  including without limitation,  the Notes, the Guaranty,  any
         L/C  Related  Documents  and any other  documentation  executed  at the
         request of any Lending Office.


                  "Long Term Debt" of any Person means all Debt which would,  in
         accordance with GAAP, be classified upon its balance sheet as long term
         debt,  excluding any portion  thereof which would,  in accordance  with
         GAAP, be classified  thereon as a current

                                      -10-
<PAGE>

         liability,  and in any event
         includes (a) any  obligation  for borrowed  money  outstanding  under a
         revolving  credit or similar  agreement  providing for  borrowing  (and
         renewals and  extensions  thereof)  over a period of more than one year
         after  the  creation  of  such  agreement   notwithstanding   that  any
         obligation thereunder may be payable on demand or within one year after
         the  creation  thereof,  (b) any  Capital  Lease  Obligation  and 8 any
         guarantee  or  equivalent  or similar  obligation  under any  agreement
         specified in subsection  (a) of the  definition of Debt with respect to
         Debt  of  another  Person  of the  kind  otherwise  described  in  this
         definition.



                  "Margin" means the applicable percentage set forth below based
         upon the higher of the S&P Rating or the Moody's Rating on the last day
         of the  calendar  quarter,  or other due date,  with  respect  to which
         interest is being  calculated,  provided,  that if on any such date the
         S&P Rating and the Moody's Rating do not fall into  contiguous  columns
         under the following  grid,  then the  applicable  percentage  set forth
         below based upon the lower of the S&P Rating or the Moody's Rating (but
         no lower than the applicable  percentage in the column  contiguous with
         the higher of the S&P Rating or the Moody's Rating) shall be used:


<TABLE>

- -----------------  -----------  -------------  -------------  ---------------  ---------------  --------------
<S>                    <C>            <C>            <C>            <C>              <C>            <C>
     bla               0              0              0              0                0              0
     S&P
                       A-            BBB+           BBB            BBB-              BB+          Below BB+
    Rating
- ----------------   or higher
                  -----------  -------------  -------------  ---------------  ---------------  --------------
    Moody's
    Rating            A3             Baa1           Baa2            Baa3              Ba1          Below Ba1
                   or higher

- ---------------- -------------  -------------  ---------------  ---------------  ------------- --------------
    Margin           0.625%         0.875%         1.125%          1.375%           1.625%           1.875%
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
</TABLE>


                  If the rating system used to ascribe  either the S&P Rating or
         the Moody's  Rating  shall change prior to the  Termination  Date,  the
         Borrowers  and the Bank  shall  negotiate  in good  faith to amend  the
         references  to  specific  ratings in this  definition  to reflect  such
         changed rating system.


                  "Margin  Stock"  shall  have the  meaning  given  such term in
         Regulation U promulgated by the Federal Reserve Board.


                  "Material  Adverse Effect" means a material adverse change in,
         or a material adverse effect upon the financial condition or results of
         operations of Pittston and its Subsidiaries taken as a whole that would
         impair  the  Borrowers'   and  Pittston's   ability  to  perform  their
         respective obligations under this Agreement and the Guaranties.

                                      -11-
<PAGE>


                  "Material   Domestic   Subsidiary"  means  any  Subsidiary  of
         Pittston  which (a) is organized  under the laws of the United  States,
         any state thereof or the District of Columbia and (b) together with its
         Subsidiaries,  (i) owns more than twenty percent (20%) of  Consolidated
         Total  Assets or (ii)  accounts for more than twenty  percent  (20%) of
         Consolidated EBITDA.


                  "Multiemployer  Plan" shall mean a  Multiemployer  plan within
         the meaning of Section  4001(a)  (3) of ERISA to which any  Borrower or
         any ERISA Affiliate is making,  has made, is accruing or has accrued an
         obligation to make, contributions within the preceding six years.


                  "Moody's  Rating"  means  the  rating  ascribed  by  Moody's
         Investors  Service,   Inc.  to  the Guarantor's  unsecured,  non
         credit-enhanced  long-term  debt  for  borrowed  money  (whether
         senior  or subordinated).

                  "Note"  means any  promissory  note  executed by a Borrower in
         favor of the Bank or any  other  Lending  Office  pursuant  to  Section
         2.01(e).


                  "Obligations"  means all Loans,  Letter of Credit  Obligations
         and other  indebtedness,  advances,  Debts,  liabilities,  obligations,
         covenants  and duties  owing by a  Borrower  to the Bank,  any  Lending
         Office or any other Person  required to be indemnified by that Borrower
         under any Loan  Document,  of any kind or  nature,  present  or future,
         whether or not  evidenced  by any note,  guaranty or other  instrument,
         arising under this  Agreement,  under any other Loan Document,  whether
         arising  under,  out of, or in  connection  with,  any  checks,  notes,
         drafts,  bills  of  exchange,   acceptances,   orders,  instruments  of
         guarantee and indemnity or other  instruments for the payment of money,
         or in any other  manner and also  including  any other  document  made,
         delivered or given in connection  therewith,  and each other obligation
         and liability,  whether direct or indirect, absolute or contingent, due
         or to  become  due,  or now  existing  or  hereafter  incurred,  of any
         Borrower to the Bank or any other Lending Office arising under any Loan
         Document,  whether  on account of  principal,  interest,  reimbursement
         obligations,  fees,  indemnities,  costs, expenses (including,  without
         limitation,  all  fees  and  disbursements  of  counsel  to  the  Bank,
         including,  without  limitation,  allocated  costs of staff counsel) or
         otherwise,  whether or not for the payment of money, whether arising by
         reason of an extension of credit, loan, guaranty, indemnification or in
         any other manner,  whether direct or indirect (including those acquired
         by  assignment),  absolute or  contingent,  due or to become  due,  now
         existing or hereafter arising and however acquired.


                  "PBGC" shall mean the Pension Benefit Guaranty Corporation and
         any entity succeeding to any or all of its functions under ERISA.


                  "Pension Plan" means any employee pension benefit plan (within
         the meaning of Section 3(2) of ERISA), other than a Multiemployer Plan,
         which is subject to the

                                      -12-
<PAGE>

         provisions of Title IV of ERISA or Section 412
         of the Code and is  maintained  for the employees of Pittston or any of
         its ERISA Affiliates.


                  "Person" means an individual,  partnership,  limited liability
         company,  corporation,  business  trust,  joint stock  company,  trust,
         unincorporated association, joint venture or Governmental Authority.


                  "Pittston Credit  Agreement"  means that certain  $350,000,000
         Credit  Agreement,  dated as of September 6, 2002,  among  Pittston (as
         borrower),  certain of its  subsidiaries,  as  guarantors,  the lenders
         party thereto, and JPMorganChase, as administrative agent, as it may be
         amended,   supplemented  or  otherwise   modified  from  time  to  time
         hereafter.


                  "Pittston Minerals Group" means Pittston Minerals Group, Inc.,
         and its Subsidiaries.

                  "Plan" shall mean a pension plan within the meaning of Section
         3 (2) of ERISA  subject to Title IV of ERISA which any  Borrower or any
         ERISA  Affiliate  maintains  or to  which  any  Borrower  or any  ERISA
         Affiliate contributes other than a Multiemployer Plan.


                  "Reimbursement  Obligation"  means in respect of any Letter of
         Credit  at any  date of  determination,  the  aggregate  amount  of all
         drawings  under such Letter of Credit  honored by the  issuing  Lending
         Office and not  theretofore  reimbursed by the relevant  Borrower or by
         the Guarantor.


                  "Reportable  Event" shall have the meaning  attributed thereto
         in Section  4043 of ERISA but shall not include any event for which the
         30-30  requirement  in  Section  4043 of ERISA  has been  waived  under
         regulations of the PBGC.


                  "Requirement  of  Law"  means,  as  to  any  Person,  any  law
         (statutory or common), treaty, rule or regulation or determination of a
         court or an arbitrator  or of a  Governmental  Authority,  in each case
         applicable  to or binding  upon the Person or any of its property or to
         which the Person or any of its property is subject.


                  "Responsible  Officer"  means  the  chief  executive  officer,
         president,  chief  financial  officer or treasurer of a Borrower or the
         Guarantor, or any other officer having substantially the same authority
         and responsibility.


                  "Restricted Subsidiary" means:

     (i) any Subsidiary of Pittston at the date of this  Agreement  other than a
Subsidiary  designated as an  Unrestricted  Subsidiary in Schedule 1.1(b) to the
Pittston Credit Agreement;

     (ii) any Material Domestic Subsidiary of the Borrower;
                                      -13-
<PAGE>

     (iii) any Subsidiary of Pittston that is a Guarantor;

     (iv) any Subsidiary of Pittston that owns,  directly or indirectly,  any of
the capital stock of any Guarantor; and

                           (v) any Person that becomes a Subsidiary  of Pittston
         after the date hereof unless prior to such Person becoming a Subsidiary
         the board of directors of Pittston  designates  such  Subsidiary  as an
         Unrestricted Subsidiary, in accordance with the following paragraph.


         A Restricted  Subsidiary (other than any Material Domestic  Subsidiary,
         any  Subsidiary  that  is a  Guarantor  or any  Subsidiary  that  owns,
         directly or indirectly,  any of the capital stock of any Guarantor) may
         be designated by the board of directors of Pittston as an  Unrestricted
         Subsidiary  by  written  notice  to the  Bank,  but  only  if  (a)  the
         Subsidiary owns no shares,  directly or indirectly,  of Pittston or any
         Restricted  Subsidiary and (b) immediately after such designation,  the
         Leverage  Ratio  is not  greater  than  0.55 to 1.00  and the  Interest
         Coverage Ratio is at least 3.00 to 1.00. An Unrestricted Subsidiary may
         be  designated  by the board of  directors  of Pittston as a Restricted
         Subsidiary by written notice to the Bank, but only if immediately after
         such  designation  (x) the Borrower shall be in compliance with Section
         7.02(b) and (y) the Leverage Ratio is not greater than 0.55 to 1.00 and
         the Interest Coverage Ratio is at least 3.00 to 1.00.


                  "Sale and Leaseback Transaction" means the sale by Pittston or
         a Restricted Subsidiary to any Person (other than the Borrowers) of any
         property  or asset and,  as part of the same  transaction  or series of
         transactions,  the  leasing  as lessee by  Pittston  or any  Restricted
         Subsidiary of the same or another property or asset which it intends to
         use for substantially the same purpose.


                  "S&P  Rating"  means the rating  ascribed by Standard & Poor's
         Corporation to the Guarantor's unsecured, non credit-enhanced long-term
         debt for borrowed money (whether senior or subordinated).


                  "Subsidiary"  means, with respect to any Person (the "parent")
         at any date, any corporation,  limited liability company,  partnership,
         association or other entity the accounts of which would be consolidated
         with  those  of the  parent  in  the  parent's  consolidated  financial
         statements  if such  financial  statements  were prepared in accordance
         with GAAP as of such date,  as well as any other  corporation,  limited
         liability  company,  partnership,  association  or other  entity (a) of
         which securities or other ownership  interests  representing  more than
         fifty  percent  (50%) of the equity or more than fifty percent (50%) of
         the ordinary  voting power or, in the case of a partnership,  more than
         fifty percent  (50%) of the general  partnership  interests  are, as of
         such date, owned,  controlled or held, or (b) that is, as of such date,
         otherwise controlled,  by the parent or one or more subsidiaries of the


                                      -14-
<PAGE>

         parent or by the parent  and one or more  subsidiaries  of the  parent.
         Unless   otherwise    qualified,    references   to   "Subsidiary"   or
         "Subsidiaries" herein shall refer to those of Pittston.


                  "Support Obligation" means, with respect to any person, at any
         date  without   duplication,   any  Debt  of  another  Person  that  is
         guaranteed,  directly or  indirectly  in any manner,  by such Person or
         endorsed  (otherwise  than for  collection  or deposit in the  ordinary
         course of business) or  discounted  with recourse by such Person or any
         Debt of another Person that has the substantially equivalent or similar
         economic  effect of being  guaranteed  by such  Person or of  otherwise
         making such Person contingently  liable therefor,  through an agreement
         or  otherwise,  including,  without  limitation,  an  agreement  (i) to
         purchase, or to advance or supply funds for the payment or purchase of,
         such Debt, or (ii) to make any loan, advance,  capital  contribution or
         other investment in such other Person to assure a minimum equity, asset
         base, working capital or other balance sheet condition for any date, or
         to provide  funds for the payment of any  liability,  dividend or stock
         liquidation  payment,  or otherwise to supply funds to or in any manner
         invest in such other  Person  (unless  such  investment  is expected to
         constitute a permitted investment under Section 7.02(j)).


     "Taxes" has the meaning assigned thereto in Section 4.01(a).


     "Termination  Date" has the  meaning  assigned  thereto  in  Section  2.01.
"United States" and "U.S." each means the United States of America.

     "Unrestricted  Subsidiary"  means any  Subsidiary  other than a  Restricted
Subsidiary.


     "Withholding Taxes" has the meaning assigned thereto in Section 4.01(a).


         1.02  Accounting   Principles.02  Accounting  Principles.02  Accounting
Principles.02  Accounting  Principles.  Except as otherwise  expressly  provided
herein, all accounting terms used herein shall be interpreted, and all financial
statements and certificates  and reports as to financial  matters required to be
delivered to the Bank  hereunder  shall be  prepared,  in  accordance  with GAAP
applied  on a  consistent  basis.  All  calculations  made for the  purposes  of
determining  compliance with this Agreement shall (except as otherwise expressly
provided  herein) be made by application  of GAAP applied on a basis  consistent
with the most recent annual or quarterly financial statements delivered pursuant
to  Section  7.03,  consistent  with the  annual  audited  financial  statements
referenced in Section 6.07); provided, however, if (a) the Borrower shall object
to  determining  such  compliance  on such basis at the time of delivery of such
financial  statements  due to any change in GAAP or the rules  promulgated  with
respect  thereto or (b) the Bank shall so object in writing within 60 days after
delivery of such financial statements, then such calculations shall be made on a
basis consistent with the most recent financial statements delivered by Pittston
to the Bank as to which no such objection shall have been made.

                                      -15-
<PAGE>

                                   ARTICLE
                             LOANS AND ALLOCATIONS

         2.01  Amounts  and  Terms  of   Commitment.01   Amounts  and  Terms  of
Commitment.01   Amounts  and  Terms  of  Commitment.01   Amounts  and  Terms  of
Commitment. Bank agrees to make available to the Borrowers,  including Pittston,
from the  Effective  Date until  December 20, 2005 or until such earlier date on
which the Bank  terminates  the Commitment  pursuant to Section  8.02(a) or BAX,
Brink's and Pittston  terminate the Commitment  pursuant to Section 2.05(a) (the
"Termination  Date"),  committed  funds in an  aggregate  amount of  $45,000,000
(subject to reduction pursuant to Section 2.05(a) and Section 7.01) on the terms
and conditions set forth in this Agreement, as follows:


                  (a)  Facility   Advances(a)   Facility   Advances(a)  Facility
         Advances(a)  Facility  Advances.  The Facility may be drawn upon by the
         Borrowers  for Loans or  Letters of Credit  (collectively,  "Advances")
         from the  Effective  Date until the  Termination  Date in an  aggregate
         principal  amount  not to  exceed  $45,000,000  (subject  to  reduction
         pursuant to Section 2.05(a)) at any time outstanding.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (b)  Facility   Allocations
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                           (i) The initial  allocations of the Commitment  among
         the Covered Subsidiaries on Schedule B-1 attached hereto in the amounts
         set forth  thereon.  The allocation of a portion of the Commitment to a
         Covered  Subsidiary  shall not affect the availability to the Borrowers
         of any unused and unallocated portion of the Commitment.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                           (ii) At any  time  and from  time to time  after  the
         Effective  Date,  BAX and  Brink's  may by  written  notice to the Bank
         request the  amendment of Schedule B-1 to modify the  allocation of the
         Commitment  among the Borrowers and Covered  Subsidiaries,  as Schedule
         B-1 may be amended or  supplemented by the Borrowers from time to time.
         Any such  request  shall  state the name and  address  of the  relevant
         Subsidiary and the country in which a credit extension is contemplated.
         The Bank,  after  consultation  with the relevant  branch or Affiliate,
         shall notify the requesting Borrower as soon as reasonably  practicable
         whether it accepts such re-allocation and shall advise the Borrowers in
         writing  of the  amount of such  re-allocation.  The Bank  shall not be
         obligated in any way to accept any requested amendment to Schedule B-1.
         The  determination by the Bank of the Dollar Equivalent with respect to
         any  credit  extensions  in a currency  other than US Dollars  shall be
         conclusive  and binding upon the  Borrowers;  the Bank may readjust the
         Dollar  Equivalent  periodically  as provided  in Section  2.04 (b) and
         Section  2.06(b)(provided  it agrees not to make any such  readjustment
         unless the Dollar Equivalent of Loans, Letter of Credit Obligations and
         allocations exceeds the Commitment by 3% or more and the Bank agrees to
         give the Borrowers prompt written notice of any such readjustment). The
         Bank's relevant branch or Affiliate and the relevant Covered Subsidiary
         shall  be free to  structure  each  individual  credit  transaction  in
         accordance with all relevant law, local custom and practice,  including
         pricing  and  collateral,  provided  the  Guaranties  of  the  relevant
         Guarantors  shall apply to all such

                                      -16-
<PAGE>

         extensions of credit.  Any portions
         of  the  Commitment   allocated  as   hereinabove   provided  shall  be
         unavailable for use by any of the Borrowers and for further  allocation
         until  such  time as the Bank  notifies  the  Borrowers  of  reinstated
         availability. The Bank shall be entitled to demand cash collateral from
         the relevant Guarantor with respect to the principal of any obligations
         of any Covered Subsidiaries (but not with respect to interest, fees and
         the like with respect to any such  obligations)  incurred in respect to
         credit  extensions  contemplated  by  this  Agreement  which  the  Bank
         reasonably determines may be outstanding beyond the Termination Date or
         outstanding  after any such Covered  Subsidiary  ceases to qualify as a
         Subsidiary (in the latter case, the providing of cash collateral  shall
         not be  required  until  30 days  after  the  Bank so  requests).  Cash
         collateral  shall be by means of a  deposit  of  immediately  available
         funds in an amount equal to the aggregate  principal amount of any such
         obligations  in a  non-interest  bearing  account  with the  Bank.  Any
         failure to provide  cash  collateral  in  accordance  with this Section
         2.01(b)(ii)  shall,  upon written  notice from the Bank, be an Event of
         Default hereunder.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------


<PAGE>



- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                     - 53 -

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (c)     Documentation     for      LoansDocumentation      for
         LoansDocumentation  for  LoansDocumentation for Loans. Each Loan may be
         evidenced  by (a) one or  more  master  promissory  notes  in form  and
         substance  acceptable  to the  relevant  Lending  Office or (b) by loan
         accounts  maintained by such Lending  Office.  The records  attached as
         grids to the promissory  notes and the loan account and account records
         shall be conclusive  evidence,  absent manifest error, of the amount of
         the Loans and the interest and payments thereon.  Any failure to record
         or any  error  in  doing  so shall  not,  however,  increase,  limit or
         otherwise  affect the  obligation  hereunder of any Borrower to pay any
         amount owing with respect to the Loans.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
        2.02 Procedure for Incurring  Loans.02  Procedure for Incurring Loans.02
Procedure for Incurring  Loans.02 Procedure for Incurring Loans. Each Loan shall
be made upon the request of a Borrower to the  relevant  Lending  Office  (which
request must be received by such Lending Office not later than 11:00 a.m. (local
time),  unless  otherwise  agreed by such Lending  Office,  (a) on the requested
borrowing  date,  in the case of Base Rate Loans,  and (b) three  Business  Days
prior  to the  requested  borrowing  date,  in the  case of  LIBOR  Rate  Loans,
specifying (i) the principal  amount of the Loan,  (ii) the requested  borrowing
date, which shall be a Business Day; (iii) whether the Loan is to be a Base Rate
Loan or a LIBOR Rate Loan;  and (iv) if the requested Loan is a LIBOR Rate Loan,
the duration of the Interest  Period  applicable  to such Loan. If the notice of
borrowing  shall fail to specify  the  duration of the  Interest  Period for any
LIBOR Rate Loan, such Interest Period shall be one month.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
         2.03 Conversion and Continuation  Elections with Respect to Outstanding
Loans.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (a) Any Borrower may upon  irrevocable  written  notice to the
         applicable Lending Office in accordance with Section 2.03(b):

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (i) elect to convert,  on any Business Day, any Base Rate Loan
                  made to such Borrower into a LIBOR Rate Loan; or

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (ii) elect to convert,  on the last day of any Interest Period
                  therefor,  any LIBOR  Rate Loan made to such  Borrower  into a
                  Base Rate Loan; or

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (iii)  elect,  on the last  day of the  Interest  Period  with
                  respect  to any  LIBOR  Rate  Loan  made  to such  Person,  to
                  continue  such Loan as a LIBOR  Rate Loan  denominated  in the
                  same currency for an additional Interest Period.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (b) Any  Borrower  wishing to  convert  or  continue a Loan as
         described  in  Section  2.03(a)  shall  deliver  by fax,  a  notice  of
         conversion  or  continuation  (which  notice  must be  received  by the
         applicable  Lending  Office not later than  11:00  a.m.  (local  time),
         unless  otherwise  agreed by such  Lending  Office)  (i) on the date of
         conversion  of a LIBOR  Rate  Loan  into a Base  Rate  Loan,  (ii) four
         Business Days prior to the date of conversion of a LIBOR Rate Loan; and
         (iii) four Business Days prior to the date of  continuation  of a LIBOR
         Rate Loan, specifying:

- -----------------------------------------------------------------
- -----------------------------------------------------------------
            (A)  the proposed date of conversion or continuation;
- -----------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
            (B)  the aggregate amount of Loans to be converted or continued;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
            (C)  the nature of the proposed conversion or continuation; and
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
            (D) the duration of any requested Interest Period. If
   the notice of conversion or continuation shall fail to specify
   the duration of the  Interest  Period for any LIBOR Rate Loan,
   such Interest Period shall be one month.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
           (c) During the  existence  of a Default or Event of  Default,
         the Bank may demand that any or all of the then-outstanding  LIBOR Rate
         Loans be converted  upon their  expiration  into Base Rate Loans.  Such
         conversion  shall  continue to be in effect so long as such  Default or
         Event of Default continues to exist.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
         2.04  Termination  or Reduction  of the  Commitment.04  Termination  or
Reduction of the  Commitment.04  Termination  or Reduction of the  Commitment.04
Termination or Reduction of the Commitment.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (a) The Borrowers may, upon not less than three Business Days'
         prior  notice  to the Bank  (i)  terminate  the  Commitment  upon  full
         prepayment of all outstanding  Advances and upon the termination of all
         allocations  theretofore  accepted by the Bank or the providing of cash
         collateral in all respects  satisfactory  to the Bank in order to fully
         collateralize the obligations of the Guarantors under the Guaranties or
         (ii)  permanently  reduce the Commitment to an amount not less than the
         Dollar  Equivalent of the principal amount of all Advances  outstanding
         on the reduction date and all allocations of Commitment not theretofore
         terminated.  If the Commitment is terminated in its entirety under this
         Section  2.04(a),  all accrued and unpaid  commitment  fees to, but not
         including,  the effective date of such termination  shall be payable on
         the effective date of such termination without any premium or penalty.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (b) For the  purpose of ensuring  compliance  with the maximum
         amount available under the Commitment, the Bank shall on each date of a
         voluntary  reduction of the Commitment under Section 2.04(a) and on the
         last  Business  Day of each  calendar  quarter,  determine  the  Dollar
         Equivalent  of the  principal  amount of all existing  allocations  and
         then-outstanding Advances.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
         2.05   Optional   Prepayments.05   Optional   Prepayments.05   Optional
Prepayments.05 Optional Prepayments.  Subject to Section 4.04, any Borrower may,
at any time or from time to time,  upon at least three  Business Days' notice to
the applicable Lending Office, prepay Loans made to it in whole or in part. Such
notice of prepayment  shall specify the date and amount of such  prepayment  and
whether  such  prepayment  is of  Base  Rate  Loans,  LIBOR  Rate  Loans  or any
combination  thereof.  No such notice shall be  revocable by any Borrower  after
being given. Once such notice is given by any Borrower, such Borrower shall make
such  prepayment,  and the payment amount  specified in such notice shall be due
and  payable,  on the  date  specified  therein,  together  (only in the case of
prepayments of LIBOR Rate Loans) with accrued  interest to each such date on the
amount prepaid and the amounts, if any, required pursuant to Section 4.04.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
         2.06  Repayment  of  Principa
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (a) Each  Borrower  shall  repay on the  Termination  Date the
         principal amount of the Loans made to it.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (b) In the  event  that  the  Bank  determines,  based  on its
         computation  made in  accordance  with Section  2.04(b) or at any other
         time that the Dollar Equivalent of the  then-outstanding  Loans, Letter
         of Credit Obligations and allocations exceeds the Commitment,  the Bank
         shall give  notice to the  Borrowers  of such fact and of the amount of
         such excess (provided that the Bank agrees that no such notice shall be
         given  unless the  Dollar  Equivalent  of the  Loans,  Letter of Credit
         Obligations  and  allocations  exceeds the  Commitment  by 3% or more).
         Within  30 days  after  the date on which the  Borrowers  receive  such
         notice,  they shall prepay Loans or collateralize  the Letter of Credit
         Obligations  or  allocations  with  cash (as set forth  below),  in the
         aggregate  amount of such  excess.  Any such  prepayment  of LIBOR Rate
         Loans shall be made  together  with  interest on the  principal  amount
         thereof  and any amount  required  to be paid in  connection  therewith
         pursuant to Section  4.04.  Any  prepayments  pursuant to this  Section
         2.06(b)  shall  be  applied,   first,  to  any  Base  Rate  Loans  then
         outstanding, second, to LIBOR Rate Loans having Interest Periods ending
         on the date of such  prepayment,  and  third,  to the  extent  that the
         amounts  referred to in clauses "first" and "second" are not sufficient
         to satisfy the entire prepayment requirement under this Section 2.06(b)
         or there are no such  Loans  outstanding  on the date  such  prepayment
         would be required,  then the remaining amount that would be required to
         be prepaid  under this  Section  2.06(b)  shall be  deposited in a cash
         collateral  account  maintained by the Bank, to be held as security for
         the Obligations hereunder pursuant to a cash collateral agreement to be
         entered into in form and substance reasonably  satisfactory to the Bank
         and the  Borrowers,  and to be applied to the  prepayment of LIBOR Rate
         Loans at the end of the respective Interest Periods therefor and to the
         payment of Reimbursement Obligations as the same become due.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
         2.07  Interest.07  Interest.07  Interest.07  Interest.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (a)  Subject  to Section  2.07(c),  each Loan made by the Bank
         shall bear interest on the  outstanding  principal  amount thereof from
         the date when made  until it becomes  due at a rate per annum  equal to
         the LIBOR Rate plus the applicable Margin or the Base Rate per annum.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                   (b) Interest on each Loan shall be payable in arrears on each
         Interest  Payment Date.  Interest  shall also be payable on the date of
         any  prepayment  of LIBOR Rate Loans  pursuant to Section  2.05 for the
         portion  of  such  Loans  so  prepaid  and  upon   payment   (including
         prepayment)  in full of  LIBOR  Rate  Loans;  provided,  however,  that
         interest  payable  pursuant  to  Section  2.07(c)  shall be  payable on
         demand.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (c) While there shall be any default  hereunder in the payment
         of  principal,  interest,  fees or any other amount owing  hereunder or
         after acceleration,  each Borrower shall pay interest (after as well as
         before entry of judgment thereon to the extent permitted by law) on the
         principal  amount of all  Obligations  of such  Person that are due and
         unpaid,  at a rate per annum  determined  by adding 2% per annum to the
         interest rate then in effect for the applicable type of Loan and in the
         case of Obligations  other than Loans, at a rate per annum equal to the
         Base Rate plus 2%; provided, however, that, on and after the expiration
         of any Interest Period applicable to any LIBOR Rate Loan outstanding on
         the date of  occurrence of such Event of Default or  acceleration,  the
         principal  amount of such Loan shall,  during the  continuation of such
         Event of Default or after  acceleration,  bear  interest  at a rate per
         annum equal to the Base Rate plus 2%.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (d)  Anything  herein  to the  contrary  notwithstanding,  the
         obligations  of  the  Borrowers  hereunder  shall  be  subject  to  the
         limitation  that  payments of interest  shall not be required,  for any
         period for which  interest  is computed  hereunder,  to the extent (but
         only to the extent) that  contracting  for or receiving such payment by
         the relevant  Lending Office would be contrary to the provisions of any
         applicable  law  limiting  the highest  rate of  interest  which may be
         lawfully  contracted for,  charged or received by the relevant  Lending
         Office,  and in such event the Borrowers shall pay the relevant Lending
         Office interest at the highest rate permitted by applicable law.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
         2.08  Fees.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (a) Commitment  Fee(a)  Commitment  Fee(a)  Commitment  Fee(a)
         Commitment  Fee.  Pittston  shall pay to the Bank a  commitment  fee in
         Dollars  computed at a rate per annum equal to the  Commitment Fee Rate
         on the average daily unused and unallocated  portion of the Commitment,
         computed  on a  quarterly  basis  in  arrears  on the  last day of each
         calendar quarter.  Such commitment fees shall accrue from the Effective
         Date to the Termination Date and shall be due and payable  quarterly in
         arrears on the fifth Business Day following  receipt of an invoice from
         the Bank,  with the final payment to be made on the  Termination  Date.
         The commitment fee shall accrue at all times after the Effective  Date,
         including at any time during which one or more  conditions in Article V
         are not met. For purposes of computing  utilization  and allocations of
         the Commitment, the Dollar Equivalent of any outstanding amount that is
         not  denominated  in Dollars  shall be determined as of the last day of
         each calendar quarter.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (b)  Letter  of  Credit  Fees
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                           (i) Each  Borrower  shall pay to the Bank a letter of
                  credit fee equal to (A) in the case of a Performance Letter of
                  Credit issued by the Bank for the account of such Borrower, an
                  amount equal to one half of the Margin per annum on the amount
                  from time to time available to be drawn under such Performance
                  Letter of Credit, and (B) in the case of a Financial Letter of
                  Credit  issued by the Bank for the  account of such  Borrower,
                  equal to the Margin per annum on the amount  from time to time
                  available to be drawn under such  Financial  Letter of Credit.
                  Such fee shall accrue on such amount from the date of issuance
                  of each Letter of Credit (with such issuance date being deemed
                  to be the  Effective  Date  in  the  case  of the  Outstanding
                  Letters  of  Credit  that  are to be  continued  hereunder  as
                  Performance  Letters of Credit or Financial Letters of Credit)
                  until its expiration date,  taking into account any extensions
                  of the  expiration  date beyond the initial  expiration  date.
                  Such fee shall be payable quarterly in arrears on the last day
                  of each calendar quarter and on the date each Letter of Credit
                  expires or is fully drawn.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                           (ii) In addition to the letter of credit fees due the
                  Bank hereunder,  each Borrower shall pay to any Lending Office
                  issuing a Letter of Credit any standard amendment, negotiation
                  or other fees as such  Lending  Office may request at the time
                  such Letter of Credit is issued or amended.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                    (c)  Arrangement  Fee. The Borrowers shall pay
         to the Bank an arrangement fee in the amount of $115,000 on the
         Effective Date.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (d)  Administrative   Fee.  In  the  event  the  Bank  permits
         Obligations  of any of the  Guarantors  to be  cash  collateralized  as
         contemplated  in  Section  2.01(b) or to permit any Letter of Credit to
         expire after the Termination  Date as contemplated in Section  3.02(b),
         the Bank may in its  discretion  notify  Pittston  in  writing  that it
         elects to  collect an  administrative  fee of up to $5000 for each such
         collateralized  Obligation  and each  extension  of a Letter  of Credit
         beyond the  Termination  Date.  All such  administrative  fees shall be
         payable  upon  demand  and  prior  to the  Bank's  acceptance  of  cash
         collateral or any such extension.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  2.09  Computation  of Fees and  Interest.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (a) All  computations  of interest  payable in respect of Base
         Rate  Loans at all times as the Base Rate is  determined  by the Bank's
         "reference" or "prime" rate shall be made on the basis of a year of 365
         or 366 days,  as the case may be, and actual  days  elapsed.  All other
         computations of fees and interest under this Agreement shall be made on
         the basis of a 360-day year and actual days elapsed.  Interest and fees
         shall accrue during each period during which  interest or such fees are
         computed  from and including the first day thereof to but excluding the
         last day thereof.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (b)  Each  determination  of an  interest  rate  by  the  Bank
         pursuant to any provision of this  Agreement  shall be  conclusive  and
         binding on the Borrowers in the absence of manifest error.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
         2.10 Payments by the  Borrowers.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (a) All  payments  (including  prepayments)  to be made by any
         Borrower on account of  Obligations  shall be made  without  set-off or
         counterclaim and shall,  except as otherwise expressly provided herein,
         be made to the relevant  Lending  Office,  in the currency in which the
         relevant  type  of  Obligation  was   denominated  and  in  immediately
         available funds, no later than 12:00 noon (local time) unless otherwise
         agreed, on the date specified herein.  Any payment which is received by
         a Lending  Office later than 12:00 noon (local time) shall be deemed to
         have been received on the immediately  succeeding  Business Day and any
         applicable interest or fee shall continue to accrue.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (b) Whenever any payment  hereunder  shall be stated to be due
         on a day other than a Business  Day,  such payment shall be made on the
         next succeeding  Business Day, and such extension of time shall in such
         case be included in the  computation  of interest or fees,  as the case
         may be,  subject  to the  provisions  set  forth in the  definition  of
         "Interest Period" herein.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
         2.11  Certain   Obligations   Guaranteed.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                   ARTICLE III

                                LETTERS OF CREDIT
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
         3.01 The  Letters of Credit  Commitment.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (a)  Letters  of Credit  denominated  in  Dollars or any other
         Approved  Currency may be issued under the Commitment for the following
         purposes: (i) "Financial Letters of Credit" may be issued to any Person
         other  than an  Affiliate  to secure  the  payment by any Person of its
         financial obligations, or to provide counter or "back-up" guarantees in
         support  of  bank  guarantees,   Letters  of  Credit  or  other  credit
         facilities  afforded  to a  Borrower,  or  to  support  local  currency
         borrowings outside the United States, and (ii) "Performance  Letters of
         Credit"  may be issued to secure the  performance  by any Person of its
         obligations,   or  to  guaranty  or   otherwise   secure  any  Person's
         obligations  relating to a bid,  advance  payment or security  deposit,
         retention release, custom and duty deferment guaranty or bond, warranty
         or  performance  bond or other  guaranty and shall  include  Commercial
         Letters of Credit.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (b) The Letter of Credit Obligations set forth on Schedule B-2
         hereto are  outstanding  under the 1999  Revolving  Facility.  All such
         Letter of Credit Obligations shall be deemed outstanding hereunder upon
         the  Effective  Date.  With  respect  to  any  such  Letter  of  Credit
         Obligations  that are not  Letter of Credit  Obligations  of a Borrower
         hereunder, they shall, upon the effectiveness of this Agreement, become
         joint and several  obligations  of BAX or Brink's,  as the case may be,
         upon the terms and conditions  hereof and as particularly  set forth on
         Schedule  B-2. It is  understood  and agreed by the Bank and by Brink's
         and BAX, respectively, that Brink's shall only be jointly and severally
         liable with the entities set opposite its name on Schedule B-2 and that
         BAX shall only be jointly and  severally  liable with the  entities set
         opposite  its name on Schedule  B-2;  Brink's  shall not be jointly and
         severally  liable with any entity set opposite BAX's name and BAX shall
         not be jointly  and  severally  liable  with any  entity  set  opposite
         Brink's  name;  nor shall BAX be  jointly  and  severally  liable  with
         Brink's.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
         3.02  Terms  of the  Letters  of  Credit.02  Terms  of the  Letters  of
Credit.02 Terms of the Letters of Credit.02 Terms of the Letters of Credit.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (a)  Performance  Letters of Credit issued after the Effective
         Date shall not have a term exceeding one year.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (b) No Letter of Credit  may expire  (including  all rights of
         renewal) later than the Termination Date, provided,  however,  that the
         Bank in its  discretion  may elect to,  issue  Letters  of Credit  that
         expire after the Termination Date, upon terms and conditions acceptable
         to the Bank, including without limitation,  cash collateral provisions,
         it being understood and agreed that this Agreement shall remain in full
         force and effect with  respect to all such Letters of Credit until they
         have  expired and all related  Letter of Credit  Obligations  have been
         paid in full.  Without  limiting the generality of the  foregoing,  the
         applicable  Borrower will cash collateralize each Letter of Credit that
         remains  outstanding and undrawn as of the Termination  Date by deposit
         of immediately available funds in an amount equal to the undrawn amount
         of such Letter of Credit in a  non-interest-bearing  account maintained
         with the Bank;  provided,  however,  that  subject  to the  proviso  in
         Section 8.02,  the  obligation to so cash  collateralize  any Letter of
         Credit having a stated expiry date occurring after the Termination Date
         shall arise only upon the Bank's request to the applicable Borrower. If
         any Letter of Credit that is to be cash  collateralized  is denominated
         in an Approved  Currency  other than  Dollars,  the amount so deposited
         shall,  if  requested  by the Bank,  be the  Dollar  Equivalent  of the
         undrawn amount of such Letter of Credit as of the Termination Date. The
         Bank may, at any time and from time to time after the  initial  deposit
         of cash collateral, require that additional cash collateral be provided
         in order to protect against the results of exchange rate fluctuations.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
         3.03  Procedure for Issuance of the Letters of Credit.03  Procedure for
Issuance of the Letters of  Credit.03  Procedure  for Issuance of the Letters of
Credit.03 Procedure for Issuance of the Letters of Credit.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (a) Each  Letter of Credit  to be issued  after the  Effective
         Date shall be issued  upon the  request of a Borrower  received  by the
         Bank and any other  relevant  Lending  Office not later than 12:00 noon
         (local time),  three (3) Business  Days prior to the requested  date of
         issuance.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (b) Each  request for  issuance of a Letter of Credit shall be
         made in  writing  by fax and  confirmed  by  delivery  of the  original
         executed  Letter of Credit  Application  and  Agreement,  in the Bank's
         standard form or a similar form if the relevant  Lending  Office uses a
         different  form (each,  an "L/C  Application"),  not later than one (1)
         Business  Day  thereafter.  Each  request  for  issuance of a Letter of
         Credit and each L/C Application shall specify,  among other things: (i)
         the proposed date of issuance (which shall be a Business Day); (ii) the
         face amount of the Letter of Credit;  (iii) the date of  expiration  of
         the Letter of  Credit;  (iv) the name and  address  of the  beneficiary
         thereof;  (v) the documents to be presented by the  beneficiary  of the
         Letter of Credit in case of any drawing thereunder;  (vi) the full text
         of any  certificate  to be presented by the  beneficiary in case of any
         drawing  thereunder;  and (vii) whether the Letter of Credit is to be a
         Financial Letter of Credit or a Performance Letter of Credit.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (c)Any  request  for an  amendment  to  any  previously-issued
         Letter of Credit  shall be received by the Lending  Office which issued
         the Letter of Credit not later than  12:00 noon  (local  time),  unless
         otherwise agreed by the Lending Office,  two (2) Business Days prior to
         the date of the  proposed  amendment  in writing by fax.  Each  written
         request for an amendment to a  previously-issued  Letter of Credit made
         by fax shall be in the form of the relevant L/C  Application  signed by
         the  relevant  Borrower  and,  unless  otherwise  agreed by the Lending
         Office  which  issued  the  Letter  of Credit  in  accordance  with the
         provisions of Section  3.02(b),  shall not request an extension  beyond
         the relevant Termination Date described in said Section. Amendments and
         extensions  shall be at the sole discretion of the Lending Office which
         issued the Letter of Credit.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (d)  Notwithstanding  any provision of any L/C  Application to
         the  contrary,  in the event of any  conflict  between the terms of any
         such L/C Application and the terms of this Agreement, the terms of this
         Agreement shall control with respect to payment obligations,  events of
         default,  representations  and warranties,  and covenants,  except that
         such L/C  Application  may  provide  for  further  warranties  relating
         specifically  to the  transaction or affairs  underlying such Letter of
         Credit.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
         3.04 Drawings and  Reimbursements..04  Drawings and  Reimbursements..04
Drawings and  Reimbursements..04  Drawings  and  Reimbursements.  Each  Borrower
hereby  unconditionally and irrevocably agrees to reimburse the relevant Lending
Office for each payment  made by such Lending  Office under any Letter of Credit
issued for the account of such  Borrower;  such  reimbursement  shall be due and
payable on the date the relevant  Lending  Office makes such payment  under such
Letter of  Credit.  If such  reimbursement  payment  is not made  when due,  the
Borrower  shall be deemed to have  timely  made a request to the Bank for a Base
Rate Loan on such date in an amount equal to the Dollar Equivalent of the amount
of such draft paid, together with any fees owing to the Bank pursuant to Section
2.08(b)  (to the extent such drawn  amount and fees,  when  aggregated  with the
principal  amount of all other Advances then  outstanding and  allocations  then
existing,  do not exceed the Commitment)  and,  regardless of whether or not the
conditions   precedent  specified  in  Article  V  (except  5.02(c))  have  been
satisfied,  the Bank  shall be  deemed  to have  made a Base  Rate  Loan in such
amount,  the  proceeds  of which shall be deemed to have  satisfied  the related
Reimbursement Obligations.  Interest shall be payable on any such Base Rate Loan
at the Base Rate.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
         3.05 Reimbursement  Obligations Absolute.05  Reimbursement  Obligations
Absolute.05  Reimbursement  Obligations  Absolute.05  Reimbursement  Obligations
Absolute.  The  obligations of the Borrowers to reimburse the Lending Office for
payments  made by such  Lending  Office  under any  Letter of Credit  honoring a
demand for payment by the beneficiary thereunder shall be irrevocable,  absolute
and  unconditional  under any and all  circumstances,  including  the  following
circumstances:

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     (a) any lack of validity or enforceability of this Agreement, any Letter of
Credit,  any L/C  Application  or any other  agreement  or  instrument  relating
thereto (collectively, the "L/C Related Documents");
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     (b) any change in the time,  manner or place of payment of, or in any other
term of, all or any of the  obligations of any Borrower in respect of any Letter
of Credit or any other  amendment  or waiver of or any  consent to or  departure
from all or any of the L/C Related Documents;

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     (c) the  existence of any claim,  set-off,  defense or other right that any
Borrower may have at any time against any  beneficiary  or any transferee of any
Letter  of  Credit  (or any  Person  for whom any such  beneficiary  or any such
transferee  may be acting),  the Bank,  any Lending  Office or any other Person,
whether in connection with this Agreement, the transactions  contemplated by the
L/C Related Documents or any unrelated transaction;

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     (d) any draft, certificate, statement or other document presented under any
Letter of Credit proving to be forged,  fraudulent,  invalid or  insufficient in
any respect or any  statement  therein being untrue or inaccurate in any respect
other  than if such  payment  resulted  from the  gross  negligence  or  willful
misconduct of the relevant Lending Office;

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     (e)  payment  by the  relevant  Lending  Office  under any Letter of Credit
against  presentation  of a draft or  certificate  that does not comply with the
terms of the Letter of Credit other than if such payment resulted from the gross
negligence or willful misconduct of the relevant Lending Office;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     (f) any release or amendment or waiver of or consent to departure  from any
guaranty,  for all or any of the  obligations  of any Borrower in respect of any
Letter of Credit; or
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     (g) any other circumstance or happening whatsoever,  whether or not similar
to any of the foregoing,  including any other  circumstance that might otherwise
constitute  a defense  available  to, or a  discharge  of, any  Borrower  or any
account party other than a circumstance constituting gross negligence or willful
misconduct on the part of the relevant Lending Office.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------


<PAGE>


                                   ARTICLE IV

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                    TAXES, YIELD PROTECTION AND ILLEGALITY

         4.01  Taxes.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (a) Payments made hereunder and under any instrument  executed
         hereunder  shall be made free and clear of, and without  deduction for,
         any  and  all  present  or  future  taxes,  levies,  imposts,   duties,
         deductions, withholding and similar charges ("Taxes") excluding, in the
         case  of the  Bank,  each  Lending  Office  and  each  Assignee,  Taxes
         (including franchise or receipts taxes) imposed on or in respect of its
         net income, capital, or receipts, by the jurisdiction (or any political
         subdivision  thereof)  under the laws of which the Bank or such Lending
         Office or Assignee (as the case may be) (A) is  organized,  (B) has its
         principal  place of  business,  or (C) is,  through  an office or other
         fixed place of business,  deemed to be doing  business or maintaining a
         permanent  establishment  under any applicable  income tax treaty (such
         non-excluded Taxes being "Withholding Taxes"). If any Borrower shall be
         required by law to deduct any  Withholding  Taxes from or in respect of
         any sum payable hereunder or under any instrument  executed  hereunder,
         such Borrower:

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     (i) shall pay to the Bank,  Lending Office or Assignee an additional amount
so that the net amount  received  and  retained by the Bank,  Lending  Office or
Assignee  after taking into account such  Withholding  Taxes (and any additional
Withholding  Taxes payable on account of any  additional  payment  called for by
this  sentence)  will equal the full amount  which would have been  received and
retained by the Bank, Lending Office or Assignee as if no such Withholding Taxes
been paid, deducted, or withheld;

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     (ii) shall make such deductions; and
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     (iii) shall pay the full amount deducted to the relevant  taxing  authority
or other authority in accordance with applicable law.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (b) Each  Borrower  will furnish the Bank,  Lending  Office or
         Assignee  original  Withholding  Tax  receipts,   notarized  copies  of
         Withholding  Tax receipts or such other  appropriate  documentation  as
         will prove payment of tax in a court of law applying U.S. Federal Rules
         of  Evidence  for all Taxes paid by such  Borrower  pursuant to Section
         4.01(a).  The relevant  Borrower  will deliver such  receipts  within a
         reasonable  period after payment of any  Withholding  Taxes,  but in no
         event later than 60 days after the due date for the related Withholding
         Tax.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (c) If the Bank,  Lending  Office or Assignee is entitled to a
         refund or credit of Withholding Tax, it shall use reasonable efforts to
         pursue such refund  (and  interest  with  respect  thereto),  and if it
         receives such refund or credit,  shall pay to the relevant Borrower the
         amount of the refund or credit  (and  interest  with  respect  thereto)
         actually received.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (d) The Bank,  Lending Office or Assignee shall use reasonable
         efforts   (consistent  with  its  internal  policies,   and  legal  and
         regulatory  restrictions)  to change the  jurisdiction  of its relevant
         Lending  Office if such change  would  avoid or reduce any  Withholding
         Tax; provided that no such change of jurisdiction  shall be made if, in
         the  reasonable  judgment  of the  Bank,  such  Lending  Office or such
         Assignee,  such  change  would be  disadvantageous  to the  Bank,  such
         Lending Office or such Assignee, as the case may be.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (e) The Bank  agrees  that it will  deliver to the  Borrowers,
         within  30  days  after  the  execution  of  this   Agreement   (unless
         theretofore so delivered)  and as may be reasonably  required from time
         to time by applicable law or regulation, United States Internal Revenue
         Service Forms W-8BEN  and/or W-8EC1 (or successor  Forms) or such other
         form,  if  any,  as from  time to time  may  permit  the  Borrowers  to
         demonstrate  that payments made by the Borrowers to the Bank under this
         Agreement  either are exempt from  United  States  Federal  Withholding
         Taxes or are  payable  at a  reduced  rate (if  any)  specified  in any
         applicable tax treaty or convention.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
         4.02  Illegality.02  Illegality.02  Illegality.02  Illegality.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     (a) If the Bank shall determine that the introduction of any Requirement of
Law,  or any  change  in any  Requirement  of  Law or in the  interpretation  or
administration  thereof, has made it unlawful, or that any central bank or other
Governmental  Authority  has asserted  that it is unlawful,  for the Bank or any
other  relevant  Lending  Office to make LIBOR Rate Loans or to issue Letters of
Credit, then, on notice thereof by the Bank to the Borrowers,  the obligation of
the Bank to make LIBOR Rate Loans or to issue Letters of Credit, as the case may
be, shall be suspended until the Bank shall have notified the Borrowers that the
circumstances giving rise to such determination no longer exist.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     (b) If the Bank shall  determine  that it is unlawful to maintain any LIBOR
Rate Loan, the affected Borrowers shall prepay in full all LIBOR Rate Loans then
outstanding,  together with interest accrued thereon,  either on the last day of
the Interest  Period thereof if the Bank may lawfully  continue to maintain such
LIBOR  Rate  Loans to such day,  or  immediately,  if the Bank may not  lawfully
continue to maintain such LIBOR Rate Loans,  together with any amounts  required
to be paid in connection therewith pursuant to Section 4.04.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     (c) The Bank shall immediately  notify the Borrowers of any event described
in (a) or (b) above.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
         4.03 Increased  Costs and Reduction of Return;  Additional  Interest on
LIBOR Rate Loans.03 Increased Costs and Reduction of Return; Additional Interest
on LIBOR Rate  Loans.03  Increased  Costs and  Reduction  of Return;  Additional
Interest  on LIBOR  Rate  Loans.03  Increased  Costs and  Reduction  of  Return;
Additional Interest on LIBOR Rate Loans.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (a) If the Bank shall  determine  that,  due to either (i) the
         introduction   of  any  Requirement  of  Law,  or  any  change  in  any
         Requirement of Law or in the  interpretation or administration  thereof
         or (ii) the  compliance  with any guideline or request from any central
         bank or other  Governmental  Authority (whether or not having the force
         of law),  there  shall be any  increase  in the cost to the Bank or any
         Lending  Office of agreeing to make or making,  funding or  maintaining
         any LIBOR Rate Loans, then the relevant  Borrowers shall be liable for,
         and shall from time to time, upon written request therefor by the Bank,
         pay to the Bank additional  amounts as are sufficient to compensate the
         Bank or such Lending Office for such increased costs.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (b)  If  the  Bank   shall  have   determined   that  (i)  the
         introduction of any Capital Adequacy Regulation, (ii) any change in any
         Capital Adequacy Regulation,  (iii) any change in the interpretation or
         administration  of any Capital Adequacy  Regulation by any central bank
         or other  Governmental  Authority  charged with the  interpretation  or
         administration  thereof,  or (iv)  compliance  by the  Bank  (or  other
         relevant Lending Office) or any corporation  controlling the Bank, with
         any Capital Adequacy  Regulation  affects or would affect the amount of
         capital  required or expected to be maintained by the Bank, any Lending
         Office  or any  corporation  controlling  the  Bank  and  (taking  into
         consideration  the Bank's and such controlling  corporation's  policies
         with  respect to capital  adequacy  and the  Bank's  desired  return on
         capital) and determines that the amount of such capital is increased as
         a consequence  of Advances  under this  Agreement,  then,  upon written
         request of the Bank, the Borrowers shall immediately pay to the Bank or
         the  relevant  Lending  Office,  from time to time as  specified by the
         Bank,  additional  amounts  sufficient to  compensate  the Bank or such
         Lending Office for such increase.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (c) Each  Borrower  shall pay to the Bank, as long as the Bank
         shall be required under Federal  Reserve Board  regulations to maintain
         reserves  with  respect  to  liabilities  or  assets  consisting  of or
         including   Eurocurrency   funds  or  deposits   (currently   known  as
         "Eurocurrency  liabilities"),  additional costs on the unpaid principal
         amount of all LIBOR Rate Loans made by the Bank to such Borrower  equal
         to the actual costs of such reserves allocated to each such Loan by the
         Bank (as  determined  by the Bank in good  faith,  which  determination
         shall be conclusive  absent manifest  error),  payable on each Interest
         Payment  Date  with  respect  to each  such  Loan,  provided  that such
         Borrower  shall have received at least 15 days' prior written notice of
         such  additional  costs from the Bank. If the Bank fails to give notice
         15 days prior to the relevant  Interest  Payment Date,  such additional
         interest  shall  accrue  and be  payable  15 days from  receipt of such
         notice.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (d) The Bank will notify each Borrower of any event  occurring
         after the date hereof which will entitle the Bank or any Lending Office
         to  compensation  from such  Borrower  pursuant to this Section 4.03 as
         promptly  as  practicable   after  it  obtains  knowledge  thereof  and
         determines to request such compensation, and will designate a different
         Lending Office if such  designation  will avoid the need for, or reduce
         the amount of, such  compensation.  If the Bank  requests  compensation
         under this Section 4.03,  the relevant  Borrowers may, by notice to the
         Bank,  require that:  (x) the Bank furnish to the relevant  Borrowers a
         statement  setting forth the basis for requesting such compensation and
         the method for  determining  the amount thereof or (y) the Loans of the
         type with  respect to which such  compensation  is  requested be either
         prepaid or converted into another type.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
         4.04 Funding  Losses.04  Funding  Losses.04  Funding  Losses.04 Funding
Losses.  Each Borrower agrees to reimburse the Bank and to hold the Bank and any
relevant  Lending  Office  harmless  from any loss or expense which the Bank may
sustain or incur as a consequence of:

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     (a) the  failure by such  Borrower  to make any  payment or  prepayment  of
principal  of any LIBOR Rate Loan when due  (including  payments  made after any
acceleration thereof);

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     (b) the  failure by such  Borrower  to borrow,  continue  or convert a Loan
after such Borrower has given (or is deemed to have given) a notice of borrowing
or a notice of conversion or continuation;

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     (c) the failure by such Borrower to make any prepayment after such Borrower
has given a notice in accordance with Section 2.05;

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     (d) the  prepayment of a LIBOR Rate Loan on a day which is not the last day
of the Interest Period with respect thereto; or
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     (e) the  conversion  pursuant  to Section  2.03 of any LIBOR Rate Loan to a
Base Rate  Loan on a day that is not the last day of the  Interest  Period  with
respect to the LIBOR Rate Loan;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
including any such loss or expense  arising from the liquidation or reemployment
of funds  obtained  by any  Lending  Office to  maintain  its LIBOR  Rate  Loans
hereunder or from fees payable to terminate  the deposits  from which such funds
were obtained.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
         4.05 Inability to Determine  Rates.05  Inability to Determine  Rates.05
Inability to Determine  Rates.05 Inability to Determine Rates. If the Bank shall
have determined  that for any reason adequate and reasonable  means do not exist
for ascertaining  the LIBOR Rate for any requested  Interest Period with respect
to a LIBOR Rate Loan or that the LIBOR Rate for any  requested  Interest  Period
with respect thereto does not adequately and fairly reflect the cost to the Bank
or any relevant  Lending  Office of funding such Loan,  the Bank will  forthwith
give notice of such  determination to the relevant  Borrowers.  Thereafter,  the
obligation of the Bank or any relevant  Lending Office to make or continue LIBOR
Rate Loans or to convert Base Rate Loans to LIBOR Rate Loans  hereunder,  as the
case may be, shall be  suspended  until the Bank revokes such notice in writing.
Upon  receipt of such  notice,  the  relevant  Borrower may revoke any notice of
borrowing or notice of conversion or  continuation  then submitted by it. If the
relevant Borrower does not revoke such notice with respect to a LIBOR Rate Loan,
the Bank shall make, convert or continue the Loan, as proposed by such Borrower,
in the amount specified in the applicable notice submitted by such Borrower, but
such Loan shall be made, converted or continued as a Base Rate Loan instead of a
LIBOR Rate Loan.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
         4.06 Certificate of the Bank.06  Certificate of the Bank.06 Certificate
of  the  Bank.06   Certificate  of  the  Bank.  If  claiming   reimbursement  or
compensation  pursuant  to this  Article  IV,  the Bank  shall  deliver  to each
relevant  Borrower a certificate  setting forth in reasonable  detail the amount
payable  to  the  Bank  or any  relevant  Lending  Office  hereunder,  and  such
certificate  shall be conclusive and binding on each  recipient  Borrower in the
absence of manifest error.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
         4.07  Survival.

     The  agreements  and  obligations of the Borrowers in this Article IV shall
survive the payment of all other Obligations.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------


<PAGE>


                                    ARTICLE V

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                               CONDITIONS PRECEDENT
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
         5.01 Conditions to  Effectiveness  of this  Agreement.01  Conditions to
Effectiveness  of  this   Agreement.01   Conditions  to  Effectiveness  of  this
Agreement.01 Conditions to Effectiveness of this Agreement. The effectiveness of
this  Agreement is subject to the condition that the Bank shall have received on
or  before  the  Effective  Date all of the  following,  in form  and  substance
satisfactory to the Bank and its counsel:

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (a)  Credit  Agreement
     This Agreement shall be duly executed and delivered by each Borrower ;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (b)   Resolutions; Incumbency
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                           (i)  Copies  of  the  resolutions  of  the  board  of
                  directors  of  BAX,   Brink's  and  Pittston   approving   and
                  authorizing  the execution,  delivery and  performance of this
                  Agreement,   its  respective   Guaranty  and  the  other  Loan
                  Documents to be delivered by it hereunder, certified as of the
                  Effective  Date by the Secretary or an Assistant  Secretary of
                  such Borrower or the Guarantor, as the case may be; and

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                           (ii) A  certificate  of the  Secretary  or  Assistant
                  Secretary  of BAX,  Brink's and  Pittston as of the  Effective
                  Date  certifying the names and true signatures of the officers
                  of such  Borrower  authorized  to  execute  and  deliver  this
                  Agreement,   its  respective   Guaranty  and  all  other  Loan
                  Documents to be delivered by it hereunder.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (c) 1999 Revolving Facility. The 1999 Revolving Facility shall
         have terminated or expired in accordance with its terms.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (d)  Guaranties.
     The Guaranties duly executed and delivered by BAX, Brink's and Pittston.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (e) Legal  Opinions(e)  Legal  Opinions(e)  Legal  Opinions(e)
         Legal Opinions.  Opinions in form and substance reasonably satisfactory
         to the Bank of the general  counsel of Pittston (and in such  capacity,
         acting as counsel for Borrowers) and, as to matters of New York law, of
         Hunton & Williams.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (f) Payment of Costs and Fees(f)  Payment of Costs and Fees(f)
         Payment of Costs and Fees(f)  Payment of Costs and Fees.  The Borrowers
         shall have paid (i) all costs,  accrued  and unpaid  fees and  expenses
         incurred by the Bank,  to the extent due and  payable on the  Effective
         Date,  including the fees and expenses of outside  counsel to the Bank,
         and (ii) the arrangement fee of $115,000.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (g)  Certificates.
     A certificate signed by a Responsible Officer of each Borrower, dated as of
the Effective Date, stating that:
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     (i) the  representations  and warranties made by such Person in Article VI,
and the representations and warranties made in the respective Guaranty, are true
and correct on and as of such date, as though made on and as of such date;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     (ii) no Default or Event of Default exists as of the Effective Date; and
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     (iii) since December 31, 2001,  there has occurred no event or circumstance
that could reasonably be expected to result in a Material Adverse Effect.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (h) Financial  Statements(h) Financial Statements(h) Financial
         Statements(h) Financial Statements. A copy of the audited and unaudited
         financial statements of the Guarantor and its Subsidiaries  referred to
         in Section 6.07, accompanied by a copy of the related auditor's report,
         in the case of the audited financial statements, and a certificate of a
         Responsible  Officer  of the  Guarantor,  in the case of the  unaudited
         financial statements.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
         5.02 Conditions to Subsequent Advances and Allocations.02 Conditions to
Subsequent  Advances and  Allocations.02  Conditions to Subsequent  Advances and
Allocations.02 Conditions to Subsequent Advances and Allocations. The obligation
of the Bank to make any  Advance  and accept any  allocation  request  after the
Effective  Date is  subject  to the  satisfaction  of the  following  conditions
precedent on the date of the relevant extension of credit:

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (a) Notice of  Advance or  Allocation.
     The Bank shall  have  received a notice of  borrowing  pursuant  to Section
2.02, an allocation  request  pursuant to Section  2.01(b) or an L/C Application
pursuant to Section 3.03;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (b)   Continuation  of   Representations   and   Warranties(b)
         Continuation  of  Representations  and  Warranties(b)  Continuation  of
         Representations  and Warranties(b)  Continuation of Representations and
         Warranties. The representations and warranties made by the Borrowers in
         Article  VI  and  the  representations  and  warranties  made  by  each
         Guarantor  in its  Guaranty  shall be true and correct on and as of the
         date of such extension of credit with the same effect as if made on and
         as of such date;

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (c)  No  Existing  Default  No  Existing   DefaultNo  Existing
         DefaultNo Existing Default.  No Default or Event of Default shall exist
         on the date of such Advance or acceptance of any allocation  request or
         shall result from such Advance or acceptance of any allocation request;
         and

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (d)  Additional   Documentation.
     The relevant  Borrower  shall have  delivered any Note or other document as
the relevant Lending Office may reasonably require.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
         Each  request  for  an  Advance  or  allocation   shall   constitute  a
representation  and warranty by the requesting  Borrower that, as of the date of
such  request  and as of the date  that the  Advance  is made or  allocation  is
accepted by the Bank, the conditions in this Section 5.02 are satisfied.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                   ARTICLE VI

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                         REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES


- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
         Each Borrower (or, as  specifically  provided  below,  Pittston  only),
represents and warrants to the Bank, as follows:

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
         6.01   Corporate   Existence6.01   Corporate   Existence.01   Corporate
Existence.01  Corporate Existence.  (a) The Borrower is duly organized,  validly
existing  and  in  good  standing  under  the  laws  of  its   jurisdiction   of
incorporation; (b) the Borrower (i) has the requisite power and authority to own
its property and assets and to carry on its business as now  conducted  and (ii)
is qualified to do business in every  jurisdiction  where such  qualification is
required,  except  where the  failure  so to  qualify  would not have a Material
Adverse Effect.  The Borrower has the corporate power to execute and deliver and
to perform its obligations  under the Loan Documents to which it is party and to
borrow hereunder and to provide its Guaranty.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
         6.02  Non-Contravention6.02  Non-Contravention.02  Non-Contravention.02
Non-Contravention.  The execution,  delivery and  performance by the Borrower of
the Loan  Documents  to  which it is party  have  been  duly  authorized  by all
necessary  corporate  action and do not and will not (i)  require any consent or
approval of the shareholders of the Borrower,  (ii) violate any provision of any
law, rule, regulation  (including,  without limitation,  Regulation G, U or X of
the  Federal  Reserve  Board),  order,  writ,  judgment,   injunction,   decree,
determination, or award presently in effect having applicability to the Borrower
or of the charter or by-laws of the Borrower,  (iii) result in a material breach
of or  constitute  a  material  default  under any  indenture  or loan or credit
agreement or any other agreement,  lease, or instrument to which the Borrower is
a party or by  which it or its  properties  may be  bound or  affected,  or (iv)
result in the  creation of a Lien of any nature  upon or with  respect to any of
the properties now owned or hereafter acquired by the Borrower; and the Borrower
is not in default  under any such order,  writ,  judgment,  injunction,  decree,
determination,  or award or any such indenture,  agreement, lease, or instrument
or in default under any such law, rule, or regulation,  which default would have
a Material Adverse Effect.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
         6.03  No  Consent6.03  No  Consent.03  No  Consent.03  No  Consent.  No
authorization,   consent,   approval,   license,  exemption  of,  or  filing  or
registration with, or any other action in respect of any Governmental  Authority
is or will be necessary for the valid execution,  delivery or performance by the
Borrower of the Loan Documents to which it is party.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
         6.04   Binding    Obligations6.04    Binding   Obligations.04   Binding
Obligations.04  Binding  Obligations..  Each of the Loan  Documents to which the
Borrower  is party  constitute  legal,  valid,  and binding  obligations  of the
Borrower  enforceable  against the Borrower in accordance with their  respective
terms,  except  as  enforceability  may be  limited  by  applicable  bankruptcy,
insolvency  or similar laws  affecting  the  enforcement  of  creditors'  rights
generally or by equitable principles relating to enforceability.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
         6.05  Title  to   Properties6.05   Title  to  Properties.05   Title  to
Properties.05 Title to Properties. The Borrower has good and marketable title to
all of the material assets and properties  purported to be owned by it, free and
clear of all liens except those permitted by the Pittston Credit Agreement.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
         6.06 Subsidiaries6.06  Subsidiaries.06 Subsidiaries.06 Subsidiaries. As
of  the  Effective  Date,  each  BAX  Subsidiary  listed  on  Schedule  A-1 is a
Subsidiary  of  BAX,  each  Brink's  Subsidiary  listed  on  Schedule  A-2  is a
Subsidiary  of Brink's,  and all of such  Subsidiaries'  shares which are owned,
directly or indirectly,  by BAX or Brink's have been duly authorized and validly
issued,  are fully  paid and  nonassessable  and are free and clear of any Lien.
Pittston  represents and warrants that no member of the Pittston  Minerals Group
is direct or indirect  Subsidiary  of BAX or Brink's and agrees that it will not
request that any be added as a Covered Subsidiary on Schedule B-1.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
         6.07 Financial  Statements.
     Pittston hereby represents and warrants that:
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (a)  The  consolidated  balance  sheet  of  Pittston  and  its
         Subsidiaries  as at December  31,  2001,  and the related  consolidated
         statements of operations,  shareholders'  equity and cash flows for the
         year then ended,  certified by KPMG Peat  Marwick,  independent  public
         accountants,  copies  of  which  will be  delivered  to the Bank on the
         Effective   Date,   fairly   present  in  all  material   respects  the
         consolidated financial condition of Pittston and its Subsidiaries as at
         such date and the consolidated results of their operations for the year
         then  ended,  all  prepared  in  accordance  with  GAAP  applied  on  a
         consistent basis.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (b) The unaudited  consolidated  balance sheet of Pittston and
         its  Subsidiaries  as at  September  30,  2002,  the related  unaudited
         consolidated  statement of operations of Pittston and its  Subsidiaries
         for the fiscal  quarter  year then  ended,  and the  related  unaudited
         consolidated  statement of cash flows of Pittston and its  Subsidiaries
         for the fiscal quarter then ended, copies of which will be delivered to
         the Bank on the Effective Date, fairly present in all material respects
         the consolidated  financial  condition of Pittston and its Subsidiaries
         as at such date and their  consolidated  results of operations  for the
         quarter then ended,  all prepared in  accordance  with GAAP (except for
         the omission of notes and subject to year-end adjustments) applied on a
         consistent basis; and there has been no material adverse change in such
         condition or operations since September 30, 2002.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
         6.08 Litigation6.08  Litigation.08 Litigation.08 Litigation.  Except as
otherwise  disclosed in writing to the Bank,  including  through the delivery to
the  Bank of  copies  of  reports  and  statements  filed by  Pittston  with the
Securities and Exchange  Commission,  there are no material  actions,  suits, or
proceedings pending or, to the knowledge of the Borrower,  threatened against or
affecting the Borrower or the properties of the Borrower before any Governmental
Authority  or  arbitrator,  and the  Borrower  is not in default (in any respect
which might have a material  adverse  effect on the  ability of the  Borrower to
perform  its  obligations  under the Loan  Documents  to which it is party) with
respect to any law, rule, regulation, order, writ, judgment, injunction, decree,
determination or award presently in effect and applicable to the Borrower.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
         6.09  Taxes6.09  Taxes.09  Taxes.09  Taxes.  The Borrower has filed all
material tax returns  (federal,  state, and local) required to be filed and paid
all taxes shown thereon to be due, including interest and penalties, or provided
adequate reserves, in accordance with GAAP, for the payment thereof.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
         6.10 ERISA6.10 ERISA.10 ERISA.10 ERISA. Each Plan has complied with and
has been administered in all material respects in accordance with the applicable
provisions of ERISA and the Code.  No Plan has  terminated  under  circumstances
giving rise to  liability  of the  Borrower of any ERISA  Affiliate  to the PBGC
under Section 4062,  4063 or 4064 of ERISA,  which  liability  remains unpaid in
whole or in part, and no lien under Section 4068 of ERISA exists with respect to
the assets of the Borrower. No Reportable Event has occurred with respect to any
Plan, except for Reportable  Events previously  disclosed in writing to the Bank
that would not have a Material Adverse Effect. No accumulated funding deficiency
within the meaning of Section  302 of ERISA or Section 412 of the Code  (whether
or not waived)  exists with respect to any Plan, nor does any lien under Section
302 of ERISA or Section 412 of the Code exist with respect to any Plan.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
         Neither  the  Borrower  nor  any  ERISA  Affiliate  has  completely  or
partially withdrawn from any one or more Multiemployer Plans under circumstances
which would give rise to withdrawal  liability  which,  in the aggregate,  could
have a Material  Adverse Effect and which has not been fully paid as of the date
hereof.  Neither the Borrower nor any ERISA  Affiliate has received  notice that
any Multiemployer Plan is in reorganization  (within the meaning of Section 4241
of ERISA),  is insolvent  (within the meaning of Section 4245 of ERISA),  or has
terminated under Title IV of ERISA,  nor, to the best knowledge of the Borrower,
is any such  reorganization,  insolvency  or  termination  reasonably  likely to
occur, where such reorganization,  insolvency or termination has resulted or can
reasonably be expected to result in an increase in the contributions required to
be made to such  Multiemployer  Plan in an amount  that  would  have a  Material
Adverse Effect.  Neither the Borrower nor any ERISA Affiliate has failed to make
any  contribution  to a  Multiemployer  Plan which is required under ERISA or an
applicable collective bargaining agreement in an amount which is material in the
aggregate  (except to the extent there is a good faith dispute as to whether any
contribution  is owed, the amount owed or the existence of facts that would give
rise to a withdrawal).

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
         6.11 No  Default
     The  Borrower  represents  and  warrants  that no  Default  and no Event of
Default has occurred and is continuing.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
         6.12 Federal  Reserve  Regulations.

     (a) The  Borrower is not engaged  principally,  or as one of its  important
activities, in the business of extending credit for the purpose of purchasing or
carrying Margin Stock.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     (b) No part of the proceeds of any Advances will be used,  whether directly
or indirectly,  and whether  immediately,  incidentally  or ultimately,  for any
purpose  which  entails a  violation  of,  or which is  inconsistent  with,  the
provisions  of  the  Regulations  promulgated  by  the  Federal  Reserve  Board,
including, without limitation, Regulations G, U or X.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
         6.13 Investment  Company Act6.13  Investment  Company Act.13 Investment
Company Act.13  Investment  Company Act. None of the Borrowers is an "investment
company" as defined in, or subject to regulation  under, the Investment  Company
Act of 1940.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
         6.14 Environmental  Matters6.14  Environmental Matters.14 Environmental
Matters.14  Environmental  Matters.  In the  ordinary  course  of its  business,
Pittston conducts an ongoing review of the effect of Environmental Laws and laws
relating  to  occupational  safety and health on the  business,  operations  and
properties  of  Pittston  and  its  Subsidiaries,  in the  course  of  which  it
identifies and evaluates associated liabilities and costs (including any capital
or operating  expenditures  required for  clean-up,  closure or  restoration  of
properties presently or previously owned, any capital or operating  expenditures
required to achieve or maintain  compliance  with  environmental  protection and
occupational health and safety standards imposed by law or as a condition of any
license,  permit or contact,  any related  constraints on operating  activities,
including any periodic or permanent shutdown of any facility or reduction in the
level of or change in the nature of operations  conducted thereat and any actual
or potential liabilities to third parties,  including employees, and any related
costs and expenses).  On the basis of this review,  each Borrower represents and
warrants that  applicable  Environmental  Laws and laws relating to occupational
health  and  safety  do not have a  material  adverse  effect  on its  business,
financial condition or results of operations,  and it has obtained and holds all
material permits, licenses and approvals required under Environmental Laws which
are  necessary  for  the  conduct  of its  business  and  the  operation  of its
facilities,  and it has not received any written  notice of any failure to be in
compliance  with  the  terms  and  conditions  of  such  permits,  licenses  and
approvals, which failure could reasonably be expected to have a material adverse
effect on it.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
         6.15  Priority  of  Debt6.15  Priority  of Debt.15  Priority of Debt.15
Priority of Debt.  Each Borrower  hereby  represents  and warrants that all Debt
created  under this  Agreement for which it is or may be liable ranks pari passu
with all other Debt for  borrowed  money which such person owes or may be liable
for to any Person other than the Bank.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------





                                   ARTICLE VII

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                    COVENANTS

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
         7.01 Affirmative  Covenants7.01  Affirmative  Covenants.01  Affirmative
Covenants.01  Affirmative Covenants. For the benefit of the Bank, so long as any
Advance remains outstanding  hereunder or the Commitment remains in effect, each
Borrower shall, unless the Bank otherwise consents in writing:

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (a)  Payment  of Taxes,  etc.(a)  Payment  of  Taxes,  etc.(a)
         Payment of Taxes,  etc.(a) Payment of Taxes, etc. Pay and discharge all
         taxes,  assessments and governmental  charges or levies imposed upon it
         or upon its income or profits, or upon any properties  belonging to it,
         prior to the date on which  penalties  attach  thereto,  and all lawful
         claims which, if unpaid,  might become a lien or charge upon any of its
         properties; provided, however, that neither it shall not be required to
         pay any such  tax,  assessment,  charge,  levy or claim  which is being
         contested in good faith and by proper  proceedings and against which it
         is maintaining adequate reserves in accordance with GAAP.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (b)  Maintenance of  Insurance(b)  Maintenance of Insurance(b)
         Maintenance of  Insurance(b)  Maintenance of Insurance.  Maintain,  and
         cause  each   Restricted   Subsidiary  to  maintain,   insurance   with
         responsible and reputable  insurance  companies or associations (or, to
         the extent consistent with prudent business  practice,  through its own
         program of  self-insurance)  in such amounts and covering such risks as
         is usually  carried by  companies  engaged  in similar  businesses  and
         owning  similar  properties  in the  same  general  areas  in  which it
         operates.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (c) Preservation of Corporate Existence, etc.8 Preservation of
         Corporate   Existence,   etc.   Preservation  of  Corporate  Existence,
         etc.Preservation of Corporate Existence, etc. Preserve and maintain its
         corporate   existence,   rights,   franchises  and  privileges  in  the
         jurisdiction  of its  incorporation;  provided,  however,  that nothing
         herein contained shall prevent any merger or consolidation permitted by
         Section 7.03(ii).

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (d)  Compliance  with  Laws,  etc.(d)  Compliance  with  Laws,
         etc.(d) Compliance with Laws, etc.(d) Compliance with Laws, etc. Comply
         with the  requirements of all applicable laws,  rules,  regulations and
         orders (other than laws, rules,  regulations,  and orders which are not
         final and are being  contested in good faith by proper  proceedings) of
         any  Governmental  Authority  (including  Labor Laws and  Environmental
         Laws)  applicable to or binding upon it or its property,  noncompliance
         with which would materially adversely affect its business or credit.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (e)  Compliance   with  ERISA(e)   Compliance   with  ERISA(e)
         Compliance with ERISA(e) Compliance with ERISA. Comply with the minimum
         funding  standards  under  ERISA with  respect to its Plans and use its
         best  efforts  to  comply  in all  material  respects  with  all  other
         applicable  provisions of ERISA and the regulations and interpretations
         promulgated thereunder.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (f) Access to Properties(f)  Access to Properties(f) Access to
         Properties(f)   Access  to  Properties.   Permit  any   representatives
         designated by the Bank,  upon  reasonable  prior notice to it, to visit
         its  properties  at  reasonable   times  and  as  often  as  reasonably
         requested.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (g) Use of Proceeds(g)  Use of Proceeds(g)  Use of Proceeds(g)
         Use of  Proceeds.  Use the  Advances,  and any  proceeds  thereof,  for
         working   capital  and  other   general   corporate   purposes  not  in
         contravention  of any  Requirement  of Law or the provisions of Section
         6.12(b).

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
         7.02 Negative  Covenants.02 Negative Covenants.02 Negative Covenants.02
Negative Covenants.  So long as any Advance remains outstanding hereunder or any
of the  Commitment  remains  in  effect,  Pittston  will  not,  unless  the Bank
otherwise consents in writing:

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (a)  Financial Covenants.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     (i) Maximum  Leverage  Ratio.  Commencing  with the end of the first fiscal
quarter ending after the date hereof, permit the Leverage Ratio as of the end of
each fiscal quarter to be greater than 55%.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     (ii) Minimum Interest Coverage Ratio.  Commencing with the end of the first
fiscal quarter ending after the date hereof,  permit the Interest Coverage Ratio
as of the end of each fiscal quarter to be less than 3.00 to 1.00.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (b)  Limitations on Liens.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  Create,  incur,  assume  or suffer  to  exist,  or permit  any
         Restricted  Subsidiary to create, incur, assume or suffer to exist, any
         Lien  on,  or with  respect  to,  any of  their  assets  or  properties
         (including   without  limitation  shares  of  capital  stock  or  other
         ownership interests),  real or personal, whether now owned or hereafter
         acquired, except:

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     (i) Liens  existing on the date hereof and set forth on Schedule 9.2 to the
Pittston Agreement;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     (ii) Liens for taxes,  assessments and other governmental charges or levies
not yet due or as to which the period of grace, if any,  related thereto has not
expired  or  which  are  being  contested  in  good  faith  and  by  appropriate
proceedings if adequate reserves are maintained to the extent required by GAAP;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     (iii)  The  claims  of  materialmen,   mechanics,  carriers,  warehousemen,
processors or landlords for labor,  materials,  supplies or rentals  incurred in
the ordinary course of business,  (A) which are not overdue for a period of more
than  thirty  (30) days or (B) which are being  contested  in good  faith and by
appropriate  proceedings  if  adequate  reserves  are  maintained  to the extent
required by GAAP;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     (iv) Liens consisting of deposits or pledges made in the ordinary course of
business (A) in connection  with,  or to secure  payment of,  obligations  under
workers'   compensation,   unemployment  insurance  or  similar  legislation  or
obligations  under customer  service  contracts,  or (B) to secure (or to obtain
letters  of  credit  that  secure)  the   performance   of  tenders,   statutory
obligations,  surety  bonds,  appeal  bonds,  bids,  leases  (other than Capital
Leases), performance bonds, purchase,  construction or sales contracts and other
similar  obligations,  in each case not incurred or made in connection  with the
borrowing  of money,  the  obtaining of advances or credit or the payment of the
deferred purchase price of property.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (v) Liens  constituting  encumbrances  in the nature of zoning
         restrictions, easements and rights or restrictions of record on the use
         of real property,  which in the aggregate are not substantial in amount
         and which do not, in any case,  detract  from the value of any material
         parcel of real  property  or impair  the use  thereof  in the  ordinary
         conduct of business.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (vi)  Liens in favor of the Bank;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (vii)  Liens  on the  property  or  assets  of any  Restricted
         Subsidiary  existing at the time such Restricted  Subsidiary  becomes a
         Subsidiary of a Borrower and not incurred in contemplation  thereof, as
         long as the outstanding principal amount of the Debt secured thereby is
         not voluntarily  increased by such Restricted Subsidiary after the date
         such Restricted Subsidiary becomes a Subsidiary of Borrower;

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (viii) Liens on the property or assets of the Borrowers or any
         Restricted  Subsidiary  securing  Debt which is incurred to finance the
         acquisition  of such  property or assets,  provided  that (A) each such
         Lien shall be created  simultaneously  with,  or within  twelve  months
         after, the acquisition of the related property or assets; (B) each such
         Lien does not at any time encumber any property  other than the related
         property or assets  financed by such Debt; (C) the principal  amount of
         Debt secured by each such Lien is not increased;  and (D) the principal
         amount of Debt  secured by each such Lien shall at no time  exceed 100%
         of the original  purchase  price of such related  property or assets at
         the time acquired.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     (ix) Liens consisting of judgment or judicial  attachment  Liens,  provided
that (A) the claims giving rise to such Liens are being diligently  contested in
good faith by appropriate proceedings, (B) adequate reserves for the obligations
secured by such Liens have been  established  and (C)  enforcement of such Liens
has been stayed;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     (x)  Liens  created  or  deemed  to exist  in  connection  with  any  asset
securitization   program   (including  any  related  filings  of  any  financing
statements),  but only to the  extent  that  such  Liens  attach  to the  assets
actually  sold,  contributed,  financed  or  otherwise  conveyed  or  pledged in
connection with such securitization program;

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     (xi)  Liens  on  property  or  assets  of any  Borrower  or any  Restricted
Subsidiary     securing      indebtedness     owing     to     any     Borrower;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(xii)  Liens  on coal  reserves  leased  by any  Borrower  or by any  Restricted
Subsidiary as lessee, securing Debt to the lessors thereof,  arising out of such
leases; (xiii) Liens on any Margin Stock purchased or carried by Pittston or any
of its Subsidiaries;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (xiv)  The  extension,  renewal  or  replacement  of any  Lien
         permitted  by  clauses  (i),  (vii),  (viii) or (xii),  but only if the
         principal amount of Debt secured by the Lien immediately  prior thereto
         is not increased and the Lien is not extended to other property; and

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (xv) In addition to any Lien  permitted by clauses (i) through
         (xiv),  immediately after giving effect to any concurrent  repayment of
         secured  Debt,  Liens  securing  Debt  of  Pittston  or any  Restricted
         Subsidiary so long as the sum of (A) the aggregate  principal amount of
         all such secured  Debt plus (B) the  aggregate  amount of  Consolidated
         Lease  Rentals  (excluding  Consolidated  Lease Rentals under Leases in
         effect  as of  December  31,  2001  (and  any  renewal,  extension,  or
         replacement  thereof)  and Leases with respect to property not owned by
         the Borrower on such date),  discounted to present value at ten percent
         (10%),  compounded  annually,  arising  out of all Sale  and  Leaseback
         Transactions to which Pittston or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries is
         then a  party  (including  Sale  and  Leaseback  Transactions,  if any,
         entered  into  pursuant  to  Section  7.02(i)),  does not exceed 10% of
         Consolidated Net Worth; provided that the sale or transfer of (x) coal,
         oil, gas or other  minerals in place for a period of time until,  or in
         an amount such that, the transferee will realize  therefrom a specified
         amount of money (however determined) or a specified amount of such coal
         or  other  minerals  or (y)  any  other  interest  in  property  of the
         character  commonly referred to as a "production  payment" shall not be
         deemed to constitute Debt secured by a Lien.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     (c) Disposition of Debt and Shares of Restricted Subsidiaries;  Issuance of
Shares by  Restricted  Subsidiaries;  Consolidation,  Merger or  Disposition  of
Assets.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (i) Sell or  otherwise  dispose  of, or permit any  Restricted
         Subsidiary  to sell or otherwise  dispose of, any capital  stock or any
         Debt of any Restricted  Subsidiary,  other than the sale of the capital
         stock of any member of the Pittston Minerals Group, (ii) in the case of
         any Restricted  Subsidiary,  issue, sell or otherwise dispose of any of
         such  Restricted  Subsidiary's  capital  stock  (other than  directors'
         qualifying shares, to satisfy preemptive rights or in connection with a
         split or  combination  of shares or a dividend in shares) except to the
         Borrower or another Restricted Subsidiary,  (iii) liquidate, wind-up or
         dissolve  itself (or suffer any  liquidation or  dissolution) or permit
         any Restricted Subsidiary to liquidate,  wind-up or dissolve itself (or
         suffer any liquidation or dissolution), or (iv) directly or indirectly,
         or  permit  any  Restricted   Subsidiary  to  directly  or  indirectly,
         consolidate  with or  merge  with or into or sell,  lease or  otherwise
         dispose of all or substantially  all of its assets (other than the sale
         of all or any part of the assets of any member of the Pittston Minerals
         Group) to any Person,  unless,  after giving effect thereto, all of the
         following conditions shall be met:

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                           (A) the Leverage  Ratio shall not be greater than .55
                  to 1.00 and the Interest Coverage Ratio shall not be less than
                  3.00 to 1.00;

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                           (B) in the case of a merger or  consolidation  (x) if
                  Pittston is a party  thereto,  Pittston shall be the surviving
                  corporation,  (y) if  Pittston  is  not a  party  thereto  and
                  another  Borrower is a party thereto,  a Borrower shall be the
                  surviving  corporation  and  (z)  if no  Borrower  is a  party
                  thereto,  a  Restricted  Subsidiary  shall  be  the  surviving
                  corporation;

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                           (C) in  the  case  of a  liquidation,  winding-up  or
                  dissolution,   any  Borrower  (other  than  Pittston)  or  any
                  Restricted  Subsidiary  may  liquidate,  wind-up  or  dissolve
                  itself into a Borrower or a Restricted Subsidiary; and

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                           (D) no Default or Event of Default has  occurred  and
is continuing.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
         Provided  that the  conditions of this Section  7.02(c) are  satisfied,
         none of the foregoing  provisions shall be deemed to prohibit  Pittston
         or  any of  its  Restricted  Subsidiaries  from  selling,  transferring
         assigning or otherwise  disposing of Margin Stock for fair market value
         or selling, contributing,  financing or otherwise conveying or pledging
         assets in connection with any asset securitization program permitted by
         Section 7.02(b)(x).

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (d)  Transactions with Affiliates.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  Engage,  or  permit  any  Restricted   Subsidiary  to  engage,
         directly or indirectly,  in any  transaction  with an Affiliate  (other
         than a Borrower) on terms more  favorable to the  Affiliate  than would
         have been obtainable in arm's-length dealing.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (e)  Compliance with Regulations T, U and X.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  In the case of Pittston and any  Subsidiary  of the  Borrower,
         purchase  or carry  any  Margin  Stock or incur,  create or assume  any
         obligation  for  borrowed   money  or  other   liability  or  make  any
         investment, capital contribution,  loan, advance or extension of credit
         or sell or otherwise  dispose of any assets or pay any dividend or make
         any  other  distribution  to its  shareholders  or take or permit to be
         taken  any  other  action  or  permit  to occur or exist  any  event or
         condition  if such  action,  event or  condition  would  result in this
         Agreement,  the  Loans,  the use of the  proceeds  thereof or the other
         transactions contemplated hereby violating Regulation T, U or X.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (f)  Hedging Agreements.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  Enter into or permit any  Restricted  Subsidiary to enter into
         or permit to exist,  Hedging  Agreements for the purpose of speculation
         and not for the purpose of hedging risks associated with the businesses
         of Pittston and its Restricted Subsidiaries.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (g)  ERISA.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (i)  Terminate,  or  permit  any of its  ERISA  Affiliates  to
         terminate any Pension Plan under  circumstances  which would reasonably
         result in a material  liability of the Borrower or any ERISA  Affiliate
         to the PBGC, or permit to exist the occurrence of any Reportable  Event
         or any other event or condition  which presents a material risk of such
         a  termination  by  the  PBGC;  (ii)  engage,  or  permit  any  of  its
         Subsidiaries   or  any  Pension  Plan  to  engage,   in  a  "prohibited
         transaction"  (within  the  meaning of Section  406 of ERISA or Section
         4975 of the Code) that would reasonably result in material liability of
         the  Borrower or any of its  Restricted  Subsidiaries;  (iii) fail,  or
         permit  any of  its  Restricted  Subsidiaries  to  fail,  to  make  any
         contribution to a  Multiemployer  Plan which is required by ERISA or an
         applicable  collective  bargaining  agreement  in an  amount  which  is
         material  (except  to the extent  there is a good  faith  dispute as to
         whether any  contribution  is owed, the amount owed or the existence of
         facts that  would give rise to a  withdrawal);  or (iv)  completely  or
         partially withdraw, or permit any of its ERISA Affiliates to completely
         or partially  withdraw from a  Multiemployer  Plan, if such complete or
         partial  withdrawal  will result in any material  withdrawal  liability
         under  Title IV of ERISA;  or (v) enter into any new Plan or modify any
         existing Plan so as to increase its obligations  thereunder which could
         result  in  any  material  liability  to  the  Borrower  or  any  ERISA
         Affiliate.  For purposes of this Section 7.02(g), an amount is material
         if it would have a Material  Adverse Effect after  aggregation with all
         other liabilities described in this Section 7.02(g).

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (h)  Limitations on Acquisitions.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  Acquire, or permit any Restricted  Subsidiary to acquire,  all
         or any portion of the capital stock or other ownership  interest in any
         Person  which  is  not  then a  Restricted  Subsidiary  or  any  assets
         collectively constituting a business unit of a Person which is not then
         a Restricted Subsidiary, unless:

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (i) the aggregate  consideration  paid by the acquiror in such
         transaction does not exceed 20% of Consolidated  Total Assets as of the
         end of the Fiscal Year most recently ended; or

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (ii) in the event that the aggregate  consideration to be paid
         by the acquiror in such transaction  exceeds 20% of Consolidated  Total
         Assets  as of the end of the  Fiscal  Year  most  recently  ended,  (A)
         Pittston shall have notified the Bank at least five Business Days prior
         to the  consummation  thereof  that  such  an  acquisition  is  pending
         (furnishing  with such  information  reasonably  acceptable to the Bank
         demonstrating  pro forma  compliance  with the financial  covenants set
         forth  in  Section  7.02(a)),  and  (B)  after  giving  effect  to such
         acquisition on a pro forma basis,  no Default or Event of Default would
         exist under Section 7.02(a).  Any notice delivered to the Bank pursuant
         to this  Section  7.02(h)  shall  be kept  confidential  by the Bank in
         accordance with Section 9.08 below.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (i)  Sale Leaseback Transactions.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  Sell or transfer,  or permit any  Restricted  Subsidiaries  to
         sell or transfer,  any material property or assets owned by Pittston or
         any Restricted  Subsidiary on the date hereof to any Person (other than
         any  Borrower)  with  the  intention  of  taking  back a lease  of such
         property or assets or any similar property or assets, if the sum of (A)
         the amount of Consolidated  Lease Rentals,  discounted to present value
         at 10%,  compounded  annually,  which would arise out of such  proposed
         Sale and  Leaseback  Transaction,  plus  (B) the  aggregate  amount  of
         Consolidated Lease Rentals (excluding  Consolidated Lease Rentals under
         Leases in effect as of December 31, 2001 (and any renewal, extension or
         replacement  thereof)  and Leases with respect to property not owned by
         the Borrower on such date),  discounted to present value at ten percent
         (10%), compounded annually, arising out of all other Sale and Leaseback
         Transactions to which Pittston or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries is
         then a party,  plus (C) the aggregate  principal  amount of all Debt of
         Pittston  or any  Restricted  Subsidiary  secured by Liens  incurred in
         reliance on Section  7.02(b)(o),  would exceed 15% of Consolidated  Net
         Worth.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
         7.03 Reporting  Requirements of PittstonSell or transfer, or permit any
Restricted  Subsidiaries  to sell or transfer,  any material  property or assets
owned by Pittston or any Restricted  Subsidiary on the date hereof to any Person
(other  than any  Borrower)  with the  intention  of taking back a lease of such
property  or assets or any  similar  property  or assets,  if the sum of (A) the
amount of  Consolidated  Lease  Rentals,  discounted  to  present  value at 10%,
compounded  annually,  which would arise out of such proposed Sale and Leaseback
Transaction,  plus  (B) the  aggregate  amount  of  Consolidated  Lease  Rentals
(excluding  Consolidated Lease Rentals under Leases in effect as of December 31,
2001 (and any renewal, extension or replacement thereof) and Leases with respect
to property not owned by the Borrower on such date), discounted to present value
at ten percent  (10%),  compounded  annually,  arising out of all other Sale and
Leaseback  Transactions to which Pittston or any of its Restricted  Subsidiaries
is then a party,  plus 8 the aggregate  principal amount of all Debt of Pittston
or any  Restricted  Subsidiary  secured by Liens incurred in reliance on Section
7.02(b)(o),  would  exceed 15% of  Consolidated  Net  Worth.(j)  Limitations  on
Investments.Make or permit to exist, or permit any Restricted Subsidiary to make
or permit to exist, any Investment,  other than  Investments  which are:(i) cash
and Cash  Equivalents;(ii)  current assets  generated in the ordinary  course of
business;(iii)  accounts  receivable  created,  acquired or made in the ordinary
course of business and payable or  dischargeable  in accordance  with  customary
trade  terms;(iv)   Investments   consisting  of  capital  stock,   obligations,
securities  or other  property  received in  settlement  of accounts  receivable
(created in the ordinary course of business) from bankrupt obligors;(v) advances
to  employees  for moving and travel  expenses,  drawing  accounts  and  similar
expenditures  in the  ordinary  course  of  business;(vi)  advances  or loans to
directors,  officers  and  employees  that  do  not  exceed  $25,000,000  in the
aggregate at any one time  outstanding;(vii)  advances or loans to customers and
suppliers in the ordinary course of business in an aggregate  amount  consistent
with the past practice of the Person making such advance or loan;(viii) loans to
shareholders  intended to constitute dividends on, or payment on account of, any
capital  stock;(ix)  Investments  or Support  Obligations  by  Pittston  and its
Restricted  Subsidiaries existing on the date hereof;(x) Investments by Pittston
or its Restricted Subsidiaries in any Borrower or any other Subsidiary (provided
that  such  Investment  would  not  otherwise  constitute  a breach  of  Section
7.02(h));(xi) Support Obligations of Pittston or its Restricted Subsidiaries for
the benefit of any Borrower or any other Subsidiary;(xii) acquisitions permitted
by Section  7.02(h) and  Investments  consisting of capital stock,  obligations,
securities  or other  property  received in  connection  with any merger or sale
permitted  by  Section   7.02(o);(xiii)   Investments  in  connection  with  the
management  of  Pension  Plans  and  other  benefit  plans of  Pittston  and its
Subsidiaries (including without limitation The Pittston Company Employee Welfare
Benefit Trust);(xiv)  Hedging Agreements  permitted by Section 7.02(b);  and(xv)
Investments  of a nature not  contemplated  in the foregoing  subsections  in an
amount not to exceed 15% of Consolidated Net Worth.7.03  Reporting  Requirements
of  PittstonSell or transfer,  or permit any Restricted  Subsidiaries to sell or
transfer,  any material  property or assets owned by Pittston or any  Restricted
Subsidiary on the date hereof to any Person  (other than any Borrower)  with the
intention  of taking  back a lease of such  property  or  assets or any  similar
property or assets, if the sum of (A) the amount of Consolidated  Lease Rentals,
discounted to present value at 10%, compounded  annually,  which would arise out
of such proposed Sale and Leaseback  Transaction,  plus (B) the aggregate amount
of Consolidated Lease Rentals (excluding Consolidated Lease Rentals under Leases
in effect as of December  31, 2001 (and any renewal,  extension  or  replacement
thereof)  and Leases with  respect to property not owned by the Borrower on such
date),  discounted to present value at ten percent (10%),  compounded  annually,
arising out of all other Sale and Leaseback  Transactions  to which  Pittston or
any  of its  Restricted  Subsidiaries  is  then a  party,  plus 8 the  aggregate
principal amount of all Debt of Pittston or any Restricted Subsidiary secured by
Liens  incurred  in  reliance  on  Section  7.02(b)(o),   would  exceed  15%  of
Consolidated Net Worth.(j)  Limitations on  Investments.Make or permit to exist,
or permit any Restricted  Subsidiary to make or permit to exist, any Investment,
other than  Investments  which  are:(i) cash and Cash  Equivalents;(ii)  current
assets generated in the ordinary course of  business;(iii)  accounts  receivable
created,  acquired or made in the  ordinary  course of  business  and payable or
dischargeable  in  accordance  with  customary  trade   terms;(iv)   Investments
consisting of capital stock, obligations,  securities or other property received
in  settlement  of  accounts  receivable  (created  in the  ordinary  course  of
business) from bankrupt obligors;(v) advances to employees for moving and travel
expenses,  drawing  accounts and similar  expenditures in the ordinary course of
business;(vi) advances or loans to directors, officers and employees that do not
exceed $25,000,000 in the aggregate at any one time  outstanding;(vii)  advances
or loans to customers  and  suppliers  in the ordinary  course of business in an
aggregate  amount  consistent  with the past  practice of the Person making such
advance or loan;(viii)  loans to shareholders  intended to constitute  dividends
on, or payment on account  of, any  capital  stock;(ix)  Investments  or Support
Obligations  by Pittston and its  Restricted  Subsidiaries  existing on the date
hereof;(x)  Investments  by  Pittston  or  its  Restricted  Subsidiaries  in any
Borrower  or any  other  Subsidiary  (provided  that such  Investment  would not
otherwise  constitute a breach of Section  7.02(h));(xi)  Support Obligations of
Pittston or its Restricted  Subsidiaries  for the benefit of any Borrower or any
other Subsidiary;(xii) acquisitions permitted by Section 7.02(h) and Investments
consisting of capital stock, obligations,  securities or other property received
in  connection  with any  merger or sale  permitted  by  Section  7.02(o);(xiii)
Investments in connection with the management of Pension Plans and other benefit
plans  of  Pittston  and its  Subsidiaries  (including  without  limitation  The
Pittston  Company  Employee  Welfare  Benefit  Trust);(xiv)  Hedging  Agreements
permitted by Section 7.02(b);  and(xv)  Investments of a nature not contemplated
in the foregoing  subsections in an amount not to exceed 15% of Consolidated Net
Worth.7.03  Reporting  Requirements of  PittstonSell or transfer,  or permit any
Restricted  Subsidiaries  to sell or transfer,  any material  property or assets
owned by Pittston or any Restricted  Subsidiary on the date hereof to any Person
(other  than any  Borrower)  with the  intention  of taking back a lease of such
property  or assets or any  similar  property  or assets,  if the sum of (A) the
amount of  Consolidated  Lease  Rentals,  discounted  to  present  value at 10%,
compounded  annually,  which would arise out of such proposed Sale and Leaseback
Transaction,  plus  (B) the  aggregate  amount  of  Consolidated  Lease  Rentals
(excluding  Consolidated Lease Rentals under Leases in effect as of December 31,
2001 (and any renewal, extension or replacement thereof) and Leases with respect
to property not owned by the Borrower on such date), discounted to present value
at ten percent  (10%),  compounded  annually,  arising out of all other Sale and
Leaseback  Transactions to which Pittston or any of its Restricted  Subsidiaries
is then a party,  plus 8 the aggregate  principal amount of all Debt of Pittston
or any  Restricted  Subsidiary  secured by Liens incurred in reliance on Section
7.02(b)(o),  would  exceed 15% of  Consolidated  Net  Worth.(j)  Limitations  on
Investments.Make or permit to exist, or permit any Restricted Subsidiary to make
or permit to exist, any Investment,  other than  Investments  which are:(i) cash
and Cash  Equivalents;(ii)  current assets  generated in the ordinary  course of
business;(iii)  accounts  receivable  created,  acquired or made in the ordinary
course of business and payable or  dischargeable  in accordance  with  customary
trade  terms;(iv)   Investments   consisting  of  capital  stock,   obligations,
securities  or other  property  received in  settlement  of accounts  receivable
(created in the ordinary course of business) from bankrupt obligors;(v) advances
to  employees  for moving and travel  expenses,  drawing  accounts  and  similar
expenditures  in the  ordinary  course  of  business;(vi)  advances  or loans to
directors,  officers  and  employees  that  do  not  exceed  $25,000,000  in the
aggregate at any one time  outstanding;(vii)  advances or loans to customers and
suppliers in the ordinary course of business in an aggregate  amount  consistent
with the past practice of the Person making such advance or loan;(viii) loans to
shareholders  intended to constitute dividends on, or payment on account of, any
capital  stock;(ix)  Investments  or Support  Obligations  by  Pittston  and its
Restricted  Subsidiaries existing on the date hereof;(x) Investments by Pittston
or its Restricted Subsidiaries in any Borrower or any other Subsidiary (provided
that  such  Investment  would  not  otherwise  constitute  a breach  of  Section
7.02(h));(xi) Support Obligations of Pittston or its Restricted Subsidiaries for
the benefit of any Borrower or any other Subsidiary;(xii) acquisitions permitted
by Section  7.02(h) and  Investments  consisting of capital stock,  obligations,
securities  or other  property  received in  connection  with any merger or sale
permitted  by  Section   7.02(o);(xiii)   Investments  in  connection  with  the
management  of  Pension  Plans  and  other  benefit  plans of  Pittston  and its
Subsidiaries (including without limitation The Pittston Company Employee Welfare
Benefit Trust);(xiv)  Hedging Agreements  permitted by Section 7.02(b);  and(xv)
Investments  of a nature not  contemplated  in the foregoing  subsections  in an
amount not to exceed 15% of Consolidated Net Worth.7.03  Reporting  Requirements
of  Pittston.  For the  benefit  of the  Bank,  so long as any  Advance  remains
outstanding hereunder or the Commitment remains in effect, Pittston will, unless
the Bank otherwise consents in writing:

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (a) furnish to the Bank:
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     (i) annually, as soon as available,  but in any event within 120 days after
the last day of each of Pittston's fiscal years,  consolidated balance sheets of
Pittston and its  Subsidiaries  as at the last day of such fiscal year,  and the
related  consolidated  statements of operations,  shareholders'  equity and cash
flows for the fiscal  year then  ended,  prepared in  accordance  with GAAP,  in
reasonable detail,  and setting forth in comparative form corresponding  figures
from  the  preceding  annual  financial  statements,  certified  by  independent
certified  public   accountants  of  recognized   national  standing  as  fairly
presenting in all material  respects the  consolidated  financial  condition and
results of operations for Pittston and its Subsidiaries;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     (ii) as soon as available, but in any event within 60 days after the end of
each of the first three  fiscal  quarters of each of  Pittston's  fiscal  years,
consolidated  balance  sheets as at the last day of such quarter and the related
consolidated statements of operations and cash flows for the quarter then ended,
and for the  then-current  fiscal  year  through  the end of such  quarter,  for
Pittston  and its  Subsidiaries,  prepared in  accordance  with GAAP (except for
omission  of notes and  subject to year-end  adjustments)  and setting  forth in
comparative form figures for the corresponding  period in the prior fiscal year,
and certified by a Responsible  Officer of Pittston as fairly  presenting in all
material respects the consolidated financial condition and results of operations
for Pittston and its Subsidiaries;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     (iii) at the same time as it delivers  the  financial  statements  required
under the provisions of clause (i) above, a certificate  signed by a Responsible
Officer of  Pittston  to the effect  that such  Officer has made due inquiry and
that to the best of the  knowledge of such Officer  except as stated  therein no
Default or Event of Default has  occurred  hereunder  and that such  officer has
made due inquiry and that to the best of the knowledge of such Officer except as
stated  therein no  default  has  occurred  under any other  agreement  to which
Pittston or any Borrower is a party or by which it is bound,  or by which any of
its  properties or assets may be affected,  which could have a Material  Adverse
Effect and  specifying  in  reasonable  detail the  exceptions,  if any, to such
statements;

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     (iv) at the same time as it  delivers  the  financial  statements  required
under the provisions of clauses (i) and (ii) above, a statement of a Responsible
Officer of Pittston showing the Leverage Ratio and Interest Coverage Ratio as of
the last day of the fiscal period to which such financial statements relate;

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     (v) at the same time as it delivers the financial statements required under
the  provisions  of clause (ii) above,  a  certificate  signed by a  Responsible
Officer of Pittston  and stating that such Officer has made due inquiry and that
to the best of his knowledge no Default has occurred and is  continuing,  or, if
such  Default  has  occurred  and is  continuing,  specify the nature and extent
thereof; and

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     (vi) forthwith  upon the  occurrence of any Default or Event of Default,  a
certificate  of a  Responsible  Officer of  Pittston  setting  forth the details
thereof and the action which  Pittston or any  Borrower,  as the case may be, is
taking or proposes to take with respect thereto;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (b)  furnish  to  the  Bank,   promptly  after  the  same  are
         available, copies of all current reports on Form 8-K, quarterly reports
         on Form 10-Q,  annual  reports on Form 10-K (or  similar  corresponding
         reports) and  registration  statements or statements  which Pittston or
         any  Restricted  Subsidiary may be required to file with the Securities
         and  Exchange  Commission  (excluding   registration  statements  filed
         pursuant to employee stock option or benefit plans); and

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (c)  furnish to the Bank,  as soon as  reasonably  practicable
         after  receipt by  Pittston or any of its  Subsidiaries,  a copy of any
         written  notice  or claim to the  effect  that  Pittston  or any of its
         Subsidiaries  is liable to any  Person as a result of the  presence  or
         release of any Contaminant  which claim could reasonably be expected to
         have a Material Adverse Effect.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
         7.04  Additional  Requirements  of the Guarantor and the  Borrowers7.04
Additional  Requirements  of  the  Guarantor  and  the  Borrowers.04  Additional
Requirements of the Guarantor and the  Borrowers.04  Additional  Requirements of
the  Guarantor  and the  Borrowers.  For the benefit of the Bank, so long as any
Advance  remains  outstanding  hereunder  or the  Commitment  remains in effect,
Pittston and each Borrower will, unless the Bank otherwise consents in writing:

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (a) keep  proper  books of record and  accounts in which full,
         true and correct  entries in accordance  with GAAP shall be made of all
         dealings or  transactions  in relation to its business and  activities;
         and

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (b) furnish with  reasonable  promptness  such other financial
         information  as the  Bank  may  reasonably  request,  provided  that no
         Borrower shall be required to furnish any information that would result
         in violation of any confidentiality agreement by which it is bound but,
         at the request of the Bank,  shall use its  reasonable  best efforts to
         obtain  a  waiver  of  such  agreement  to  permit  furnishing  of such
         information under this provision.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------






- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                  ARTICLE VIII

                               EVENTS OF DEFAULT
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
         8.01  Event  of  Default
     Any of the following shall constitute an "Event of Default":
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  (a)  Non-Payment.
     Any Borrower  fails to pay (i) when and as required to be paid herein,  any
amount of principal of any Loan, any  Reimbursement  Obligation,  or (ii) within
three (3) business  days after the same shall become due, any  interest,  fee or
any other amount  payable  hereunder  or pursuant to any other Loan  Document to
which such Borrower is a party;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     (b) Breach of Representation or Warranty. Any representation or warranty by
any  Borrower or any  Guarantor  made or deemed made herein or in any other Loan
Document,  or which is  contained in any  certificate,  document or financial or
other  statement  by  any  Borrower  or  any  Guarantor,   or  their  respective
Responsible Officers, furnished at any time under this Agreement, or in or under
any other Loan  Document,  shall prove to have been  incorrect  in any  material
respect on or as of the date made or deemed made;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     (c) Other  Defaults.  Any  Borrower  or any  Guarantor  fails to perform or
observe any other term or covenant contained in this Agreement or any other Loan
Document,  and such default shall  continue  unremedied  for a period of 30 days
after the  earlier  of (i) the date upon  which a  Responsible  Officer  of such
Borrower or any Guarantor  gives  written  notice of such failure to the Bank or
(ii) the date upon which written notice thereof is given to such Borrower or any
Guarantor by the Bank;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     (d) Insolvency;  Voluntary  Proceedings.  Any Guarantor or any Borrower (i)
ceases or fails to be solvent,  or generally  fails to pay, or admits in writing
its inability to pay, its debts as they become due,  subject to applicable grace
periods,  if any,  whether at stated  maturity or  otherwise;  (ii)  voluntarily
ceases operations as a going concern;  (iii) commences any Insolvency Proceeding
with respect to itself;  or (iv) takes any action to effectuate or authorize any
of the foregoing;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     (e) Involuntary  Proceedings.  (i) Any involuntary Insolvency Proceeding is
commenced or filed against any Guarantor or any Borrower, or any writ, judgment,
warrant of attachment, execution or similar process, is issued or levied against
a  substantial  part of the  property of any  Guarantor,  any Borrower or any of
their respective Subsidiaries,  and any such proceeding or petition shall not be
dismissed, or such writ, judgment,  warrant of attachment,  execution or similar
process  shall not be  released,  vacated or fully  bonded  within 60 days after
commencement,  filing or levy; (ii) any Guarantor,  any Borrower or any of their
respective Subsidiaries admits the material allegations of a petition against it
in any Insolvency Proceeding, or an order for relief (or similar order under the
laws of any jurisdiction  other than the United States of America or a political
subdivision  thereof)  is ordered  in any  Insolvency  Proceeding;  or (iii) any
Guarantor,  any Borrower or any of their respective  Subsidiaries  acquiesces in
the  appointment of a receiver,  trustee,  custodian,  conservator,  liquidator,
mortgagee in possession (or agent therefor),  or other similar Person for itself
or a substantial portion of its property or business;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     (f)  Monetary  Judgments.   One  or  more  final   (non-interlocutory)  and
nonappealable  judgments,  orders  or  decrees  shall  be  entered  against  any
Borrower, any Guarantor or any of their respective Subsidiaries involving in the
aggregate  a  liability  (not fully  covered by  insurance)  as to any single or
related series of  transactions,  incidents or conditions that have a reasonable
likelihood of having a Material  Adverse Effect (which,  solely for the purposes
hereof, shall be deemed to mean at least $25,000,000 ) and the same shall remain
undischarged,  unvacated  and  unstayed  pending  appeal for a period of 30 days
after the entry thereof;

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     (g) Guarantor Defaults. Any Guarantor shall fail in any material respect to
perform or observe any term, covenant or agreement herein or in its Guaranty; or
any Guaranty shall for any reason be partially (including with respect to future
advances) or wholly  revoked or  invalidated,  or otherwise  cease to be in full
force and effect,  or any  Guarantor or any other  Person  shall  contest in any
manner the  validity or  enforceability  thereof or deny that it has any further
liability or obligation thereunder; or

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     (h)  Guarantor  Cross-Acceleration.  There shall be any  default  under any
agreement  or  instrument  evidencing  or securing  Debt of any  Borrower or any
Guarantor  (including,  without  limitation,  Debt  incurred  under the Pittston
Credit  Agreement),  if the  effect of such  default  is to permit the holder or
holders  of such Debt (or a trustee on its or their  behalf) to cause,  and such
holder or holders (or  trustee)  do cause,  such Debt to become due prior to its
stated maturity,  and the aggregate amount of such Debt so accelerated equals or
exceeds $25,000,000 (or the equivalent thereof).

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     (i) Payment Cross-Defaults.  Any Borrower or the Guarantor shall default in
the payment when due,  after giving